b
b
1
'
i
w -
e'
I
\
t provides in an
I
I
Free lockour: assistance
3ne of the f
rehicle is adit
zither be able
The 1998 Chevrolet C/K Full-Size Pickup Owner’s Manual
111
Seats and Restraint Systems
This section tells you how to use your seats and safety belts properly. It also explains the air bag system.
2- 1
Features and Controls
This section explains how to start and operate your vehicle.
3- 1
Comfort Controls and Audio Systems
This section tells you how to adjust the ventilation and comfort controls and how to operate your audio system.
4-1
Your Driving and the Road
Here you‘ll find helpful information and tips about the road andhow to drive under different conditions.
5-1
Problems on the Road
This section tells what to do if you have a problem while driving, such as a flat tire or overheated engine, etc.
6-1
Service and Appearance Care
Here the manual tells you how to keep your vehicle running properly and lookinggood.
7-1
Maintenance Schedule
This section tells you when to perform vehicle maintenance and what fluids and lubricants to use.
8-1
Customer Assistance Information
This section tells you how to contact Chevrolet for assistance and how to get service and owner publications.
It also gives you information on “Reporting Safety Defects” on page 8- 10.
9- 1
Index
Here’s an alphabetical listing of almost every subject in this manual. You can use it to quickly find
something you want to read.
i
1-
CHEVROLET
GM
GENERAL MOTORS, GM, the GM Emblem,
CHEVROLET andthe CHEVROLET Emblem are
registered trademarks of General Motors Corporation.
This manual includes the latest information at the time it
was printed. We reserve theright to make changes in the
product after that time without further notice. For
vehicles first sold in Canada, substitute the name
“General Motors of Canada Limited” for Chevrolet
Motor Division whenever it appears in this manual.
Please keep this manual in your vehicle, so it will be
there if you ever need it when you’re on the road. If you
sell the vehicle, please leave this manual in it so the new
owner can use it.
We support voluntary
technician certification.
i
WE SUPPORT
VOLUNTARY TECHNICIAN
CERTIFICATION THROUGH
National Institute for
AUTOMOTIVE
SERVICE
EXCELLENCE
For Canadian OwnersWho Prefer a
French Language Manual:
Aux propriktaires canadiens: Vous pouvez vous
procurer un exemplaire dece guide en frangais chez
votre concessionaire ou au:
DGN Marketing Services Ltd.
1500 Bonhill Rd.
Mississauga, OntarioL5T IC7
Litho in U.S.A.
C9804 B First Edition
ii
@CopyrightGeneral Motors Corporation 1997
All Rights Reserved
How to Use this Manual
Safety Warnings and Symbols
Many people read their owner’s manual from beginning
If you
to end whenthey first receive their new vehicle.
do this,it will help you learn about the features and
controls for your vehicle. In this manual, you’ll find
that pictures and words work together to explain
things quickly.
You will find a number of safety cautionsin this book.
We use a box and the word CAUTIONto tell you
about things that could hurt you
if you were to ignore
the warning.
Index
A good place tolook for what you need is the Index in
back of the manual. It’s an alphabetical list of what’s in
it.
the manual, and the page number where you’ll find
L CAUTION:
r
These mean thereis something that could hurt
you or other people.
In the caution area,we tell you what the hazardis. Then
we tell you what to do to help avoid or reduce the
If you don’t, you or
hazard. Please read these cautions.
others could be hurt.
iii
In the notice area, we tell you about somethingthat can
damage your vehicle. Many times, this damage would
not be covered by your warranty, and it could be costly.
But the notice will tell you what to do to help avoid
the damage.
You will also find a circle
with a slash through it in
this book. This safety
symbol means “Don’t,”
“Don’t do this” or “Don’t
let this happen.”
When you read other manuals, you might see
CAUTION and NOTICE warnings in different colors or
in different words.
You’ll also see warning labels on your vehicle. They use
the same words, CAUTION or NOTICE.
Vehicle Damage Warnings
Also, in this book you will find these notices:
I NOTICE:
These mean there is something that could
damage your vehicle.
iv
I
Vehicle Symbols
These are someof the symbols you may find on your vehicle.
For example,
these symbols
are used on an
original battery:
CAUTION
POSSIBLE
INJURY
A
These symbols
are important
for you and
your passengers
whenever your
vehicle is
driven:
DOOR LOCK
UNLOCK
PROTECT
EYES BY
SHIELDING
These symbols
have to do with
your lamps:
These symbols
are on some of
your controls:
These symbols
are used on
warning and
indicator lights:
WINDSHIELD
WIPER
COOLANT
TEMP
e e3
TURN
SIGNALS
BATTERY
CHARGING
SYSTEM
CAUSTIC
BRAKE
BURNS
COOLANT
SPARK OR
FLAME
COULD
EXPLODE
BATTERY
POWER
WINDOW
,\I/,
-
FUSE
I-1
LIGHTER
DAYTIME
RUNNING *
LAMPS
FOG LAMPS
.
-0
$0
VENTILATING
FAN
ENGINE OIL
PRESSURE
ANTI-LOCK
BRAKES
*
4h*yI
I
(0)
)a(
a
b
B
HORN
FASTEN
SEAT
BELTS
AVOID
SPARKS OR
FLAMES
Here are some
other symbols
you may see:
w,
SPEAKER
FUEL
(@)
V
Model Reference
Crew Cab
This manual covers these models:
Regular Cab Pickup
Chassis Cab
I
Extended Cab Pickup
1$
vi
3500 HD Chassis Cab
Section 1 Seats and Restraint Systems
Here you’ll find information about the seats in your vehicle and how to use your safety belts properly.
You can also
learn about some things you shouldnot do with air bags and safety belts.
1-2
1-9
1-13
1-14
1- 14
1-22
1-23
1-23
1-32
Seats and Seat Controls
Safety Belts: They’re for Everyone
Here Are Questions Many People Ask About
Safety Belts -- and the Answers
How to Wear Safety Belts Properly
Driver Position
Safety Belt Use During Pregnancy
Right Front Passenger Position
Air Bag System
Center Passenger Position
1-34
1-40
1-42
1-45
1-67
1-70
1-70
1-70
Rear Seat Passengers
Rear Safety Belt Comfort Guides for
Children and Small Adults
Children
Child Restraints
Larger Children
Safety Belt Extender
Checking Your Restraint Systems
Replacing Restraint System Parts After
a Crash
1-1
Seats and Seat Controls
This section tells you about the seats -- how to adjust
them, and fold them up and down. It also tells you about
reclining front seatbacks and head restraints.
If your vehicle has a manual
bucket, split bench or full
bench seat, you can adjust it
with this lever at the front
of the seat.
Manual Front Seat
You can lose control of the vehicle if you try to
adjust a manual driver’s seat while the vehicle
is
moving. The sudden movement could startle and
confuse you, or make you push a pedal when
you
don’t want to. Adjust the driver’s seat only when
the vehicleis not moving.
Slide the lever at the front of the seat toward the
passenger’s side to unlock it. Using your body, slide the
seat to where you want it. Then, release the lever and try
to move the seat with your body in order to make sure
the seat is locked into place.
Power Driver’s Seat (Option)
The switch located at the front
of this control panel
is for the power lumbar adjustment, which is
explained next.
Power Lumbar Control(If Equipped)
If you have power lumbar
adjustment, you can
increase or decrease
lumbar support in an
area of the lower seatback.
If your vehicle hasa power seat on the driver’s side, you can
adjust it with these controls at the outside edge of the seat.
You can use the round center knob to move the seat to
where you want it. To raise the seat, move the knob up.
To lower the seat, move the knob down.
To move the
To increase support, pressand hold the frontof the
seat forward, move the knob toward
the front of the
rocker switch. Let goof the switch when the lower
vehicle. To move the seat rearward, move the knob
seatback reaches the desired level
of support.
toward the rearof the vehicle.
To decrease support, press and hold the rear
of the
You can also raise and lower thefront and rear of the seat.
rocker switch. Letgo of the switch when the lower
To raise the front of the seat, movethe front lever up. To
seatback reaches the desired level
of support.
lower the front of the seat, move thefront lever down. To
raise the rearof the seat, move the rear lever up.To lower
the rear of the seat, move the rear lever down.
1-3
Reclining Seatbacks
To adjust the front seatback, move the leverrearward.
Release the lever to lock the seatback where you want it.
Move the lever again rearward and the seatback will go
to an upright position.
1-4
But don’thave a seatback reclined if your vehicle
is moving.
--
Head Restraints
A CAUTION:
I
Sitting in a reclined position when your vehicle is
in motion can be dangerous. Even if you buckle
up, your safety belts can’t do their job
when
you’re reclined like this.
The shoulder belt can’t do its job
because it
won’t be against yourbody. Instead, itwill be in
front of you. In a crash you could go into it,
receiving neck or otherinjuries.
The lap belt can’t do its job either. In a crash the
belt could go up over your abdomen. The belt
forces would be there, not at your pelvic bones.
This could cause serious internal injuries.
For proper protection when the vehicle is in
motion, have theseatback upright. Then sitwell
back in the seat and wear your safety belt properly.
Slide the head restraint up or down so that the topof the
restraint is closest to the top of your ears. This position
reduces the chance of a neck injury in a crash.
Seatback Latches
The front seatbackof the base-level bench seat folds
forward to let you access the rear of the cab. Your
seatback will move back and forth freely, unless you
come to a sudden stop. Then it will lock into place.If
you have a Crew Cab, your front seatback is designed
not to fold forward. Access to the rear of the cab is
available by using the rear doors.
The front seatbackof the split bench seat and bucket
seats fold forward to letyou access the rearof the cab.
1-5
To fold a frontsplit bench
or bucket seatback forward,
pull this lever forwardand
fold the seatback forward.
Easy Entry Seat (ExtendedCab Only)
The manual driver and passenger front bucket seats
and the manual 60/40 split bench seat of your vehicle
have an easy entry feature. This makes it easy to get in
and out of the rear seat. On vehicles with the power
driver’s seat, only the front passenger’s seat has the
easy entry feature.
. . ...
To return the seatback to the upright position, just push
the seatback rearward until it latches. After returning the
seatback to its upright position, pull the seatback
forward to make sure it is locked.
If the seatback isn’t locked, it could move
forward in a sudden stop
or crash. That could
cause injuryto the person sitting there. Always
press rearwardon the seatbackto be sure it
is locked.
To operate the seat, pull
forward on the top of this
lever and tilt the back
forward toward the front of
the vehicle.
When you do, the seat bottom will release. Just pull or
push the seat forward until it stops.
To return the seat to its regular position, return the
seatback to its upright position, then push the whole seat
rearward until it latches.
After returning the seat to its regular position, try to
move the seat with your body in order to make sure the
seat is locked into place.
If any easy entry seatisn’t locked, it can move. In
a sudden stopor crash,the person sitting there
could be injured. And, even if there is no crash or
sudden stop, a driver sitting in an unlocked easy
entry seatcould be startled by the sudden
movement and hit thewrong control or pedal,
causing an accident. After you’ve used it, besure
to push rearward on any easy entry seatto be
sure itis locked.
Rear Seat (Extended Cab)
Folding the RearSeat
The Extended Cab may have a rear folding seat which
can be folded up to provide more cargo space.To fold
the seat:
1. Pull forward on the
RELEASE lever under
the seat cushion, behind
the passenger’s side
front seat. Fold the
seatback forwarduntil
it latches with the
seat cushion.
1-7
2. Lift the entire seat
and push it rearward
into place.
Rear Seat (CrewCab)
The rear seatback without a center armrest can be folded
forward to let you reach the area behind it. Your
seatback will move back and forth freely, unless you
come to a sudden stop. Then, it will lock into place.
The rear seatback with a centerarmrest folds forward to
let you access the area behind it.
3. Make sure the seat is secure.
The Extended Cab’s rear seat can alsobe folded open
for more seating space. To use the seat:
1. Pull the entire seat forward until it is flat.
2. Then pull forward on the RELEASE lever under the
seat cushion, on the passenger’s side of the rear seat.
Push the seatback rearward until it latches.
3. After pushing the seatback upright into position, pull
the seatback forwardto make sure it islocked.
1-8
To return the seatback to the upright position, just push
the seatback rearward until it latches. After returning the
seatback to its upright position, pull the seatback
forward to make sure it is locked.
Safety Belts: They’re for Everyone
This partof the manual tellsyou how to use safety belts
properly. It also tells you some thingsyou should notdo
with safety belts.
And it explains the air bag system.
Don’t let anyone ridewhere he or she can’t wear
a safety belt properly. If you are in a crash and
you’re not wearing a safety belt, your injuries
can be much worse. You can hit thingsinside the
vehicle or be ejected from it. You can be seriously
injured or killed. In the same crash,you might
not beif you are buckled up. Always fasten your
safety belt, and check that your passengers’ belts
are fastened properlytoo.
It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area,
inside or outside of a vehicle. In a collision,
people riding inthese areas aremore likely to be
seriously injured orkilled. Do not allow peopleto
ride in any area of your vehicle that is not
equipped with seats and safety belts. Be sure
everyone in yourvehicle is in a seat and using a
safety belt properly.
Your vehicle has a light
that comes on as a reminder
to buckle up. (See “Safety
Belt Reminder Light” in
the Index.)
In most states and Canadian provinces, the law says to
wear safety belts.Here’s why: They work.
1-9
You never know if you’ll be in a crash. If you do have a
crash, you don’t know if it will be a bad one.
A few crashes are mild, and some crashes can be so
serious that even buckled up a person wouldn’t survive.
But most crashes are in between. In many of them,
people who buckle up can survive and sometimes walk
away. Without belts they could havebeen badly hurt
or killed.
Why Safety Belts Work
When you ride in or on anything, you go as fast as
it goes.
After more than 30 years of safety belts in vehicles,
the facts areclear. In most crashes buckling up does
matter ... a lot!
Take the simplest vehicle, Suppose it’s just a seat
on wheels.
1-10
.,....,..,. .
Put someone on it.
,
.;..
Get it up to speed. Then stopthe vehicle. The rider
doesn't stop.
1-11
The person keeps going until stopped by something.
In a real vehicle, it could be the windshield ...
1-12
or the instrument panel
...
Here Are Questions Many PeopleAsk
About Safety Belts-- and the Answers
Won’t I be trapped in the vehicle after
an
accident if I’m wearing a safety belt?
or the safety belts!
With safety belts, you slow down as the vehicle does.
You get more time to stop. You stop over more distance,
and your strongest bonestake the forces. That’swhy
safety belts make such good sense.
A:
You could be -- whether you’re wearing a safety
belt or not. But you can unbuckle a safety belt,
even if you’re upside down. And your chance of
being conscious during and afteran accident, so
you can unbuckle and get out, is much greater if
you are belted.
Q:
If my vehicle has air bags, why should I have to
wear safety belts?
A:
Air bags are in many vehicles today and will
be in most of them in the future. But they are
supplemental systems only; so they work with
safety belts -- not instead of them. Every air bag
system ever offered for sale has required the use of
safety belts. Even if you’re in a vehicle that has air
bags, you still have to buckle up to get the most
protection. That’s true not only in frontal collisions,
but especially in side and other collisions.
1-13
@
If I’m a good driver, andI never drive far from
home, why should I wear safety belts?
A:
You may be an excellent driver, but if you’re in an
accident -- even one that isn’t your fault -- you and
your passengers can be hurt. Being a good driver
doesn’t protect you from things beyond your
control, such as bad drivers.
Most accidents occur within 25 miles (40 km) of
home..And the greatest number of serious injuries
and deaths occur at speeds of less than 40 mph
(65 k d h ) .
Safety belts are for everyone.
How to Wear Safety Belts Properly
Adults
This part is only for people of adult size.
Be aware that there are special things to know about
safety belts and children. And there are different
rules for smallerchildren and babies. If a child will be
riding in your vehicle, see the part of this manual
called “Children.’’ Follow those rules for
everyone’s protection.
First, you’ll want to know which restraint systems your
vehicle has.
We’ll start with the driver position.
Driver Position
This part describes the driver’s restraint system.
Lap-Shoulder Belt
The driver has a lap-shoulder belt. Here’s how to wear
it properly.
1. Close and lock the door.
2. Adjust the seat (to see how, see “Seats” in the Index)
so you can sit up straight.
1-14
” .
you.
3. Pick up the latch plate and pull the belt across
Don’t let it get twisted.
The lap part of the belt should beworn low and snug on
the hips,just touching the thighs.In a crash, this applies
force
to the strong pelvic bones. And you’d be less likely
4. Push the latch plate into the buckle until
it clicks.
to slide under thelap belt. If you slid under it, the belt
Pull up on the latch plate to make sure
it is secure.
would apply force at your abdomen. This could cause
If the belt isn’t long enough, see “Safety Belt
serious or evenfatal injuries. The shoulder belt should go
Extender’’ at the endof this section.
over the shoulder and across the chest.
These parts of the
Make sure the release button on the buckle is positioned body are best able to take belt restraining forces.
SO you would be able to unbuckle the safety belt quickly The safety belt locks
if you ever had to.
if there’s a sudden stop or a crash.
1-15
Shoulder Belt Height Adjuster
Before you begin to drive, move the shoulder belt
adjuster to the height that is right for you.
To move it down, push in at the word PRESS and move
the height adjuster tothe desired position. You can move
the adjuster up just by pushing up on the shoulder belt
guide. After you move the adjuster to where you want it,
try to move it down without pushing in to make sure it
has locked into position.
Adjust the height so that the shoulder portion of the
belt is centered on your shoulder. The belt should be
away from your face and neck, but not falling off
your shoulder.
1-16
&= What’s wrong with this?
-- -1
You can be seriously hurt if your shoulder belt
is
too loose. In a crash, you would move forward
too much, which could increase injury. The
shoulder belt
fit against
shouldyour
body
A:
The shoulder belt is too loose. It won’t give nearly
as much protection this way.
1-17
What’s wrong with this?
A CAUTI-N:
!
You can be seriously injured
if your belt is
buckled in the wrong place like this.a crash,
In
the belt wouldgo up over your abdomen. The
at the pelvic
belt forces would be there, not
bones. This could cause serious internal injuries.
Always buckle your belt intothe buckle
nearest you.
A:
The belt is buckled in the wrong place.
1-18
Q.'
What's wrong with this?
You can beseriously injured if your beltgoes
over an armrestlike this. The beltwould be much
too high.In a crash, you can slide under thebelt.
The belt force would then be appliedat the
abdomen, not at the pelvic bones,and thatcould
cause serious or fatalinjuries. Be sure thebelt
goes under the armrests.
A:
The belt is over an armrest.
1-19
What’s wrong with this?
You can be seriously injured if you wear the
shoulder belt under your arm. In a crash,your
body would move toofar forward, which would
increase the chance of head and neck injury.
Also, the belt would apply too much force to the
ribs, which aren’t as strongas shoulder bones.
You could also severely injure internal organs
like your liver or spleen.
L
A:
The shoulder belt is worn under the arm. It should
be worn over the shoulder at all times.
1-20
@
What’s wrong with this?
You can be seriously injured by a twisted belt.
In
a crash, you wouldn’t have the full width of the
belt to spread impact forces.
If a beltis twisted,
make it straightso it can work properly, or ask
your dealer tofix it.
L
A:
The belt is twisted across the body.
1-21
Safety BeltUse During Pregnancy
Safety belts work for everyone, including pregnant
women. Like all occupants, they are more likely to be
seriously injured if they don’t wear safety belts.
To unlatch the belt, just push the button on the buckle.
The belt should go back out of the way.
Before you close the door, be sure thebelt is out of the
way. If you slam the door on it, you can damage both the
belt and your vehicle.
A pregnant woman should wear a lap-shoulder belt, and
the lap portion should be worn as low as possible, below
the rounding, throughout the pregnancy.
1-22
The best way to protect the fetus is to protect the
mother. When a safetybelt is worn properly, it’s more
likely that the fetus won’t be hurt in a crash. For
pregnant women, as for anyone, the
key to making
safety belts effective is wearingthem properly.
Right Front Passenger Position
To learn how to wear the right front passenger’s
safety belt properly, see “Driver Position” earlierin
this section.
The right front passenger’s safety beltworks the same
way as the driver’s safety belt -- except for one thing. If
you ever pull the lap portion of the belt out all the way,
you will engage the child restraint lockingfeature. If
this happens,just let the belt go back all the way and
start again.
Air Bag System
This part explains the air bag system.
Your vehicle may have a
“Next Generation”
reduced-force frontal air
bag for the driver and
another “Next Generation”
reduced-force frontal air
bag for theright front
passenger. If it does, it will
say AIR BAG onthe middle
part of the steering wheel.
Reduced-force frontal air bags are designed
to help
reduce the risk of injury from the force of an inflating
air bag. But even these airbags must inflate very
quickly if they are to do their job and comply with
federal regulations.
1-23
Here are the most important things to know about the air
bag system:
You can be sc !rely injured or killed in a crash if
you aren’t wearing your safety belt even if you
have air bags. Wearing your safety belt during a
crash helps reduce your chance of hitting things
inside the vehicle or being ejected from it. Air
bags are “supplemental restraints’’ to thesafety
belts. All air bags even reduced-force air
bags are designed to work with safety belts,
but don’t replace them. Air bags are designed to
work only in moderate tosevere crashes where
the frontof your vehicle hits something. They
aren’t designed to inflateat all in rollover, rear,
side or low-speed frontal crashes. And, for
unrestrained occupants, reduced-force air bags
may provide less protection in frontal crashes
than more forceful air bags have provided in the
past. Everyone in your vehicle should wear a
safety belt properly whether or not there’s an
air bag for thatperson.
--
--
--
--
1-24
e
Air bags inflate with great force, faster than the
blink of an eye. If you’re too closeto an inflating
air bag, it could seriously injure you. This is true
even with reduced-force frontal air bags. Safety
belts help keep you in position before and during
a crash. Always wear your safety belt, even with
reduced-force air bags. The driver should sit as
far back as possible whilestill maintaining
control of the vehicle.
Children who are upagainst, or very close to, an
air bag when it inflates canbe seriously injured
or killed. This is true even though your vehicle
has reduced-force frontal air bags. Air bags plus
lap-shoulder belts offer thebest protection for
adults, but not for young children and infants.
Neither the vehicle’s safety belt system nor itsair
bag system is designed for them. Young children
and infants need the protection that a child
restraint system can provide. Always secure
children properly in your vehicle. To read how,
see the partof this manualcalled “Children” and
see the caution labels on the sunvisors and the
right front passenger’s safety belt.
AIR
BAG
There is an air bag
readiness light on the
instrument panel, which
shows AIR BAG.
The system checks the air bag electrical system for
malfunctions. The light tells you if there is an electrical
problem. See “Air Bag Readiness Light” in the Index
for more information.
1-25
How the Air Bag System Works
The right front passenger’s air bag is in the instrument
panel on the passenger’s side.
Where are the air bags?
The driver’s air bagis in the middle of the steering wheel.
1-26
If something is between an occupant andan air
bag, the bag might not inflate properly
or it
might force the object into that person. The path
of an inflating air bag must
be kept clear. Don’t
put anything betweenan occupant andan air
bag, and don’t attach or put anything on the
steering wheel hub oron or near any other air
bag covering.
When should anair bag inflate?
An air bag is designed to inflate in a moderateto severe
frontal or near-frontal crash. The air bag will inflate
only if the impact speed is above the system’s designed
“threshold level.” If your vehicle goesstraight into a
wall that doesn’t move or deform, the
threshold level is
about 9 to 16 mph (14 to 26 kmh). Thethreshold level
can vary, however, with specific vehicle design,so that
it canbe somewhat above or below this range. If your
vehicle strikes somethingthat will move or deform, such
as a parked car, the threshold level will be higher. The
air bag is not designed to inflatein rollovers, side
impacts or rear impacts, because inflation would not
help the occupant.
In any particular crash, no one can say whether an air
bag should have inflated simply because of the damage
to a vehicle or because of what the repair costs were.
Inflation is determinedby the angle of the impact and
how quickly the vehicle slows down in frontal or
near-frontal impacts.
The air bagsystem is designed to work properly under a
wide range of conditions, including off-road usage.
Observe safe driving speeds, especially onrough terrain.
As always, wear your safety belt. See “Off-Road
Driving” in the Index for more tips on off-road driving.
What makes an air bag inflate?
In an impact of sufficient severity, the air bag sensing
system detects that the vehicle is in a crash. The sensing
system triggers a release of gas from the inflator, which
inflates the air bag. The inflator, air bag and related
hardware are all part of the air bag modules inside the
steering wheel and in the instrument panel in front of the
right front passenger.
1-27
How does an air bag restrain?
In moderate to severe frontal or near-frontal collisions,
even belted occupants can contactthe steering wheel or the
instrument panel.Air bags supplement the protection
provided by safety belts. Air bags distribute the forceof
the impact more evenly over the occupant’s upper body,
stopping the occupant more gradually. But air bags would
not help you in many types of collisions, including
rollovers, rear impacts and side impacts, primarily because
an occupant’s motion is not toward thoseair bags. Air
bags should never be regardedas anything more than a
supplement to safety belts, and then only in moderate to
severe frontal or near-frontal collisions.
What will you see afteran air bag inflates?
After an air bag inflates, it quickly deflates, so quickly
that some people may not even realize the air bag
inflated. Some componentsof the air bag module -- the
steering wheel hub forthe driver’s air bag, or the
instrument panel for the right front passenger’s
bag -- will be hot for a short time. Theparts of the bag
that come into contact with you may be warm, but not
too hot to touch. There will be some smoke and dust
coming from vents in the deflated air bags. Air bag
inflation doesn’t prevent the driver from seeing or from
being able to steerthe vehicle, nor does it stop people
from leaving the vehicle.
I
W: n an air bag inflates, there is dust in the air.
This dust could cause breathing problems
for
people with a history of asthma
or other
breathing trouble.To avoid this, everyone in the
vehicle should get outas soon as it is safe todo so.
If you have breathing problems but can’t get out
of the vehicle afteran air bag inflates, then get
fresh air by opening a windowor door.
In many crashes severe enough to inflate an air bag,
windshields are broken by vehicle deformation.
Additional windshield breakage may also occur from the
right front passenger air bag.
0
Air bags are designed to inflate only once. After they
inflate, you’ll need some new parts for your air bag
system. If you don’t get them, the air bag system
won’t be there to help protect you in another crash.
A new system will include airbag modules and
possibly other parts. The service manual for your
vehicle covers the need to replace other parts.
0
0
Your vehicle is equipped with a crash sensing and
diagnostic module, which records information about
the air bag system. The module records information
about the readiness of the system, when the sensors are
activated and driver’s safety belt usage at deployment.
Unless you have a Crew Cab, your vehicle has a
switch on the instrument panel that you can use to
turn off the passenger’s air bag. But use this switch
only when you want to secure a rear-facing child
restraint at the right front passenger’s position. See
“Securing a Child Restraint in the Right Front Seat
Position” in the Index for more on this, including
important safety information.
I A CAUTION:
I
-
If the rightfront passenger’s air bag is turned
off, the person sitting there
won’t have the extra
protection of an airbag. In a crash, theair bag
wouldn’t be able to inflate and
help protect the
person sitting there. Make sure the
air bag is
turned on unless you are using a rear-facingchild
restraint in the rightfront seat position.
Let only qualified technicians work on your air bag
air bag
system. Improper service can mean that your
See your dealerfor service.
system won’t work properly.
1-29
I NOTICE:
If you damage the covering for thedriver’s or the
right frontpassenger’s air bag, the bag may not
work properly. You may have to replace the air
bag module in the steeringwheel or both the air
bag module and the instrumentpanel for the
right frontpassenger’s air bag. Do not open or
break the air bag coverings.
If your vehicle ever gets into a lotof water -- such as
water up to the carpeting or higher -- or if water enters
your vehicle and soaks the carpet, the air bag controller
can be soaked and ruined. If this ever happens, and then
you start your vehicle, the damage could make the air
bags inflate, even if there’s no crash, You would have to
replace the air bags as well as the sensors and related
parts. If your vehicle is ever in a flood, or if it’s exposed
to water that soaks the carpet, you can avoid needless
repair costs by turning off the vehicle immediately.
Don’t let anyone start the vehicle, even to tow it, unless
the battery cables are first disconnected.
Servicing Your Air Bag-Equipped Vehicle
Air bags affect how your vehicle should be serviced.
There areparts of the air bag system in several places
around your vehicle. You don’t want the system to
inflate while someone is working on your vehicle. Your
dealer and the service manual have information about
servicing your vehicle and the air bag system. To
purchase a service manual, see “Service and Owner
Publications” in the Index.
For up to10 minutes after theignition key is
turned off and the batteryis disconnected, an air
bag can still inflate during improper service. You
can be injured if you are close to an airbag when
it inflates. Avoid wires wrapped with yellow tape
or yellow connectors. They are probably part of
the air bag system. Be sure to follow proper
service procedures, and make sure the
person
performing work for you is qualified to doso.
The air bag system does not need regular maintenance.
1-30
Adding Equipment toYour Air
Bag-Equipped Vehicle
@
What if I add a snow plow? Will it keep the
air
bags from working properly?
@’
A:
We’ve designed our air bag systems towork
properly under a wide rangeof conditions,
including snow plowing with vehicles equipped
with the optional SnowPlow Prep Package (RPO
VYU). But don’t change or defeatthe snow plow’s
“tripping mechanism.” If you do, it can damage
your snowplow and your vehicle, and it may cause
an air bag inflation.
A:
@
A:
If I add a push bumper or a bicycle rack to the
front of my vehicle, will it keep the air bags
from working properly?
As long as the push bumper or bicycle rack is
attached to your vehicle so that the vehicle’s basic
structure isn’t changed, it’s not likely to keep the
air bags fromworking properly in a crash.
Is there anythingI might add to the front of the
vehicle that could keep the
air bags from
working properly?
Yes. If you add things that change your vehicle’s
frame, bumper system, front end sheet
metal or
height, they may keep the air bagsystem from
working properly. Also, the air bag system may not
work properly if you relocate any of the air bag
sensors. If you have any questions about this,you
should contact Customer Assistance before
you
modify your vehicle. (The phonenumbers and
addresses for CustomerAssistance are in Step Two
of the Customer Satisfaction Procedure
in this
manual. See “Customer Satisfaction Procedure”in
the Index.)
1-31
Center Passenger Position
Lap Belt
If your vehicle has front and rear ,bench seats, someone
can sit in the center positions.
i
1-32
'Rear(Extended and Crew Cab)
Front (All)
Rear (Extended and CrewCab)
When you sit ina center seating position,you have a lap
safety belt, which hasno retractor. To make the belt
longer, tilt the latch plateand pull it along the belt.
1-33
Rear Seat Passengers
It’s very important for rear seat passengers to buckle up!
Accident statistics show that unbelted people in the rear
seat are hurt more often in crashes than those who are
wearing safety belts.
Rear passengers who aren’t safety belted can be thrown
out of the vehicle in a crash. And they can strike others
in the vehicle who are wearing safety belts.
Rear Seat Outside Passenger Positions
(Extended Cab)
Front (All)
To make the belt shorter, pull its free end as shown until
the belt is snug.
Buckle, position and release it the same way as the lap
part of a lap-shoulder belt. If the belt isn’t long enough,
see “Safety Belt Extender” at the end of this section.
Make sure the release button on the buckle is positioned
so you would be able to unbuckle the safety belt quickly
if you ever had to.
1-34
If you have a Crew Cab,see “Rear Seat Outside
Passenger Positions (Crew Cab)’’ later in this section.
Lap-Shoulder Belt (Extended Cab)
The positions next to the windows have lap-shoulder
belts. Here’s how to wear one properly.
If the belt stops before
it reaches the buckle,tilt the
latch plate and keep pulling until
you can buckle it.
Pull up on the latch plate to make sure it is secure.
1. Pick up the latch plate and pull the belt across you.
Don’t letit get twisted.
If the beltis not long enough, see “Safety Belt
Extender” at the end of this section.
2. Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks.
is
Make sure the release button on the buckle
positioned so you would be able to unbuckle the
safety belt quicklyif you ever had to.
1-35
L
I
3. To make the lap part tight, pull down on the buckle
part.
end of the belt as you pull up on the shoulder
I
I
The lap part of the belt should be worn low and snug on
the hips, just touchingthe thighs. In a crash, this applies
And you'd be less likely
force to the strong pelvic bones.
to slide under the lap belt.If you slid under it, the belt
This could cause
would apply force at your abdomen.
serious or even fatal injuries. The shoulder belt should go
of the
over the shoulder and across the chest. These parts
body are best ableto take belt restraining forces.
The safety belt locksif there's a sudden stop
or a crash.
A CAUTION:
I
You can be seriously hurt if your shoulder belt
is
too loose. In a crash, you would move forward
too much, which could increase injury. The
shoulder belt shouldfit against your body.
To unlatch the belt, just push the button on the buckle.
1-37
Rear Seat Outside Passenger Positions
(Crew Cab)
If you have an Extended Cab, see “Rear Seat
Outside Passenger Positions (Extended Cab)” earlier
in this section.
Lap-Shoulder Belt (Crew Cab)
The positions next to the windows have lap-shoulder
belts. Here’s how to wear one properly.
1-38
1 . Pick up the latch plate and pull the belt across you.
Don’t let it get twisted.
2. Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks. Pull
up on the latch plate to makesure it is secure. When
the lap belt is pulled out all theway, it will lock. If it
does, let it go back all the way and start again.
If the belt is not long enough, see“Safety Belt
Extender’’ at the end of this section.
Make sure the release button on the buckle is
positioned so you would be able to unbuckle the
safety belt quickly if you ever had to.
likely to slide under the lap belt. If you slid under it, the
belt would apply force at your abdomen. This could
cause serious or even fatalinjuries. The shoulder belt
should go overthe shoulder and across the chest.
These parts of the body are best able to take belt
restraining forces.
The safety belt locks only if there’s a sudden stop or
a crash.
You can be seriously hurt if your shoulder belt
is
too loose. In a crash, you would move forward
too much, which could increase injury. The
shoulder belt should fit against your body.
The lap partof the belt should be worn low and snugon
the hips, just touching the thighs. Ina crash, this applies
force to the strong pelvic bones. And you’d be less
1-39
There is one guide for each outside passenger positionin
the rear seat. To provide added safety beltcomfort for
children who have outgrown child restraints and for
smaller adults, thecomfort guides-may be installed on
the shoulder belts. Here's how to install
a comfurt guide
and use the safety belt:
To unlatch the belt, just push the button on the buckle.
Rear Safety Belt Comfort Guides for
Children and Small Adults
If your vehicle has a rear seat, your vehicle may have
'
shoulder belt comfort guides. This feature will pravide
added safety beltcumhrt for children who have
outgrown child restraints and for small adults. When
installed on a shoulder belt, the camfort guide pulls the
belt away fmm the neck and head.
1-40
1. Remove the guide from its storageclip on the side of
the seatback.
2. Slide the guide under and past the belt. The elastic
cord mustbe under the belt. Then, place the guide
over the belt, and insert the two edges
of the belt into
the slotsof the guide.
3. Be sure that the belt isnot twisted and it lies flat.
The elastic cord mustbe under the belt and the guide
on top.
1-41
To remove and store the comfort guides, squeeze the
belt edges together so that you can take them out from
the guides. Slide the guide onto the storage clip.
Make sure you remove the comfort guide fromthe belt
before you fold a rear seat down or usean easy-entry
seat, if your vehicle has one.
Children
Everyone in a vehicle needs protection! That includes
infants and all children smaller than adult size. Neither
the distance traveled nor the age and size of the traveler
changes the need, for everyone, to use safety restraints.
In fact, the law in every state in the United States and in
every Canadian province says children up to some age
must be restrained while in a vehicle.
4. Buckle, position and release the safety belt as
described in “Rear Seat Outside Passenger Positions
(Extended Cab)” or “Rear SeatOutside Passenger
Positions (Crew Cab)” earlier in this section. Make
sure that the shoulder belt crosses the shoulder.
Smaller Children and Babies
Children who are upagainst, or very close to, any
air bag when it inflates can be seriously injured
or killed. This is true even though your vehicle
has reduced-force frontal airbags. Air bags plus
lap-shoulder belts offer the best protection for
adults, but not for young children and infants.
Neither the vehicle’s safety belt system nor its air
bag system is designed for them. Young children
and infants need the protection that a child
restraint system can provide. Always secure
children properly in your vehicle.
Smaller children and babies should always be
restrained in a child or infantrestraint. The
instructions for the restraintwill say whether it is
CAUTION: (Continued)
CAUTION: (Continued)
the right type and size for your child. A very
young child’s hip bones are so small that a
regular belt might not stay low on the hips, as it
should. Instead, thebelt will likely be over the
child’s abdomen. In a crash, the belt would apply
force right on the child’s abdomen, which could
cause serious or fatal injuries. So, be sure that
any child small enough for one is always properly
restrained in a child or infant restraint.
Infants need complete support, including support for the
head and neck. This is necessary because an infant’s neck
is weak and its head weighsso much compared with the
rest of its body. In a crash, an infant in a rear-facing
restraint settles into the restraint, so the crash forces can be
distributed across the strongest partof the infant’s body,
the back and shoulders. A baby should be secured in an
appropriate infant restraint. This isso important that many
hospitals today won’t release a newborn infant
to its
parents unless thereis an infant restraint available for the
baby’s first trip in a motor vehicle.
1-43
I
at only 25 mph (40 km/h), a 12-lb. (5.5 kg) baby
will suddenly become a 240-lb. (110 kg) force on
your arms. The baby would be almost impossible
to hold.
Secure the baby in an infant restraint.
Never hold a baby in your arms while riding in a
vehicle. A baby doesn’t weigh much until a
crash. During a crash a baby will becomeso
heavy you can’t hold it. For example, in a crash
CAUTION: (Continued)
--
1-44
Child Restraints
Every time infants and young children ride in
vehicles, they should have protection provided by
appropriate restraints.
e.''
What are the different typesof add-on
child restraints?
A:
Add-on child restraints are available in four basic
types. When selectinga child restraint, take into
consideration not only the child's weight and size,
but also whether or not the restraint will be
compatible with the motor vehiclein which it will
be used.
An infant car bed (A) is a special bed made for use
in a motor vehicle. It's an infant restraint system
designed to restrain or position a child on a
continuous flat surface.With an infant car bed,
make sure that the infant's head rests toward the
center of the vehicle.
1-45
A rear-facing infant restraint (B) positions an infant
to face the rear of the vehicle. Rear-facing infant
restraints are designed for infants of up to about
20 lbs. (9 kg) and about oneyear of age. This type
of restraint faces the rear so that the infant’s head,
neck and body can have the supportthey need in a
crash. Some infant seats come in twoparts -- the
base stays secured in the vehicle and the seat part
is removable.
1-46
A forward-facing child restraint(C-E) positions a
child upright to face forward in the vehicle. These
forward-facing restraints are designed to help protect
children who are from 20 to 40 lbs. (9 to 18 kg) and
about 26 to 40 inches (66 to 102 cm) in height, or up
to around four years of age. One type,a convertible
restraint, is designedto be used either as a rear-facing
infant seat or a forward-facing child seat.
1-47
A booster seat (F, G) is designed for children who
are about 40 to 60 lbs. ( 1 8 to 27 kg) and about
four to eight years of age. It’s designed to improve
the fit of the vehicle’s safety belt system. Booster
seats with shields use lap-only belts; however,
booster seats without shields use lap-shoulder belts.
Booster seats can also help a child to see out
the window.
1-48
When choosing a child restraint,be sure the child
restraint is designed to beused in a vehicle. If it is, it
will have a label saying that it meets Federal Motor
Vehicle Safety Standards.
Then follow the instructions for the restraint. You may
find these instructions on the restraint itself or in a
booklet, or both. These restraints use the belt system in
your vehicle, but the child also has to be securedwithin
the restraint to help reduce the chance of personal injury.
The instructions that come with the infant or child
restraint will show you how to do that. Both the owner’s
manual and the childrestraint instructions are important,
so if either one of these is not available, obtain a
replacement copy from the manufacturer.
Where to Put the Restraint (Except
Extended Cab and Crew Cab)
The child restraint must be secured properly in the
center or right front passenger seat. If your vehicle has
air bags and you want to secure arear-facing child
restraint in the right front passenger’s seat, you need to
turn off the passenger’s air bag. See “Securing a Child
Restraint in the Right Front Seat Position’’ in the Index
for more on this, including important safety information.
~
A CAUTION:
A child in a rear-facing child restraint can be
seriously injuredor killed if the right front
passenger’s air bag inflates, even though your
vehicle has reduced-force frontal
air bags.
CAUTION: (Continued)
1-49
m
CAT JTTON: (Continued)
This is because the back of the rear-facing child
restraint would be very close
to the inflatingair
bag. Be sureto turn off theair bag before using
a rear-facing child restraint in the right front
seat position.
Keep in mind that an unsecured child restraint can move
around in acollision or sudden stop andinjure people in
the vehicle. Be sure to properly secure any child
restraint in your vehicle -- even when no child is in it.
1-50
Where to Put the Restraint
(Extended Cab and Crew Cab)
Accident statistics show that children are saferif they
are restrained in the rear rather than the front seat. We at
General Motors therefore recommend that you put your
child restraint in the rear seat, if your vehicle has one.
If you have an Extended Cab, your vehicle has a switch
on the instrument panel that you can useto turn off the
passenger’s air bag. But use this switch only when you
want to secure arear-facing child restraint at the right
front passenger’s position. See “Securing aChild
Restraint in the Right Front Seat Position” in the Index
for more on this, including important safety information.
Top Strap
A child in a rewfacmg child restraint can be
seriously injured or killed if the right front
passenger’s air bag inflates, even though your
vehicle has reduced-forcefrontal air bags. This is
because the back of the rear-facing child restraint
would be very close to the inflating air bag. Be sure
to turn off the air bag before using a rearfacing
child restraint in the right front seat position.
Wherever you install it,
be sure to secure the child
restraint properly.
Keep in mind thatan unsecured child restraint can
move
or sudden stop and injure people in
around in a collision
the vehicle. Be sure to properly secure any child
If your child restrainthas a top strap,it should be
restraint in your vehicle -- even when no child is
in it.
anchored. If you need to havean anchor installed,you
can ask yourGM dealer to put it in for
you. If you want
to install an anchor yourself, your dealer can tell
you
how to do it.
1-51
Securing a Child Restraint in a Rear
Outside Seat Position (Extended Cab)
If you have a Crew Cab, see “Securing
a Child Restraint ina
Rear Outside Seat Position (Crew Cab)” later in this section.
You’ll be using the lap-shoulder belt. See the earlier part
about the top strap if the child restraint has one. Be sure
to followthe instructions that came with the child
restraint. Secure the child in the child restraint when and
as the instructions say.
1. Put the restraint on the seat.
2. Pick up the latch plate, and run the lap and shoulder
portions of the vehicle’s safety belt through or
around the restraint. The child restraint instructions
will show you how.
1-52
Tilt the latch plate to adjust the belt if needed. If the
shoulder belt goes in front of the child’s face or neck,
put it behind the child restraint.
3. Buckle the belt. Make sure the release button is
positioned so you would be able to unbuckle the
safety belt quickly if you ever hadto.
4. To tighten the belt, pull up on the shoulder belt while
you push down on the child restraint. If you’re using
a forward-facing child restraint, you may find it
helpful to use your knee to pushdown on the child
restraint as you tighten the belt.
Make sure thebuckle end of the belt is pulled out all
the way.
1-53
5. Push and pull :he child restraint in different
directions to be sure it is secure.
To remove the child restraint, just unbuckle the vehicle’s
safety belt and let it go back all the way. The safety belt
will move freely again and be ready to work for an adult
You’ll be using the lap-shoulder belt. See the earlier part
about the top strap if the child restraint has one. Be sure
to follow the instructions that came with the child
restraint. Secure the child in the child restraint when and
as the instructions say.
or larger child passenger.
1. Put the restraint on the seat.
Securing a Child Restraint in
a Rear
Outside Seat Position (Crew Cab)
2. Pick up the latch plate, and run the lap and shoulder
portions of the vehicle’s safety belt through or
around the restraint. The child restraint instructions
will show you how. If the shoulder belt goes in front
of the child’s face orneck, put it behind the
child restraint.
If you have an Extended Cab, see “Securing a Child
Restraint in a Rear Outside Seat Position (Extended
Cab)” earlier in this section.
1-54
3. Buckle the belt. Make sure the release button
is
positioned so you would be able to unbucklethe
safety belt quicklyif you ever had to.
4. Pull the restof the lap belt allthe way out of the
retractor to set the lock.
1-55
5. To tighten the belt, feed the lap belt back into the
retractor while you push down on the child restraint.
If you're using a forward-facingchild restraint, you
may find it helpful to use your knee to push down on
the child restraint as you tighten the belt.
6. Push and pull the child restraint in different
directions to be sure it is secure.
To remove the child restraint, just unbuckle the vehicle's
safety belt and let it go back all the way. The safety belt
will move freely again and be ready to work for an adult
or larger child passenger.
1-56
Securing a Child Restraint in a
Center Seat Position
You’ll be using the lap belt.Be sure to follow the
instructions that came with the child restraint. Secure
the child in the child restraint when and
as the
instructions say.
See the earlier part about the top strap
if the child
restraint has one.
Rear (Extended and Crew Cab)
1-57
Front (All)
1. Make the belt as long as possibleby tilting the latch
plate and pulling it along the belt.
2. Put the restraint on the seat.
3. Run the vehicle's safety belt
through or around the
restraint. The child restraint instructions will show
you how.
1-58
Rear (Extended and Crew Cab)
5. To tighten the belt, pull its free end while
you push
down on the child restraint.If you’re using a
forward-facing child restraint,you may find it
helpful to use your knee to push down on the child
restraint asyou tighten the belt.
6. Push and pull the child restraint in different
directions tobe sure it is secure.
To remove the child restraint, just unbuckle vehicle’s
the
safety belt.It will be ready towork for an adult or larger
child passenger.
r ront (All)
4. Buckle the belt. Make sure the release button is
positioned so you would be able to unbuckle the
safety belt quicklyif you ever hadto.
1-59
Securing a Child Restraintin the Right
Front Seat Position (CrewCab)
I:
You’ll be using the lap-shoulder belt. See the earlier part
about the top strap
if the child restraint has one. Be sure
to follow the instructions that came
with the child
restraint. Secure the child in the child restraint
when and
3. Buckle the belt. Make sure the release button is
as the instructionssay.
positioned so you would be able to unbuckle the
safety belt quicklyif you ever had to.
1. Put the restraint on the seat.
2. Pick up the latch plate, andrun the lap and shoulder
portions of the vehicle’s safety belt through or
around the restraint. The child restraint instructions
will show you how.
If the shoulder belt goes in front
of the child’s face or
neck, putit behind the child restraint.
1-60
4. Pull the restof the lap belt all the way out of the
retractor to set the lock.
5. To tighten the belt, feed the lap belt back into the
retractor while you push down on the child restraint.
You may find ithelpful to useyour knee to push
down on the child restraint as you tighten the belt.
6. Push and pull the child restraint in different
directions to be sureit issecure.
1-61
To remove thechild restraint, just unbuckle the
vehicle’s
safety belt and let go
it back all the way. The safety belt
will move freely again andbe ready towork for an adult
or larger childpassenger.
Securing a Child Restraint in the Right
Front Seat Position (Except Crew Cab)
If your vehicle has air bags, there
is a switch on the
instrument panel thatyou can use toturn off the right
front passenger’sair bag. But use this switch only when
you want to securea rear-facing child restraint at the
right front passenger’s position.
1-62
IA
CAUTION:
A child in a rear-facingchild restraint can be
seriously.injured or killed if the right front
passenger’s air bag inflates, even though your
vehicle has reducedlforce frontalair bags. This is
because the backof the rear-facingchild
restraint would be very close to the inflatingair
bag. Be sure to turn off the airbag before using a
rear-facing child restraint in the rightfront seat
position. If a forward-facing child restraint is
suitable for your child, always move the
passenger seat as far back as itwill go.
To turn off the right frontpassenger’s air bag, insert
your ignition key into the switch,push in, and move the
switch to AIR BAG OFF.
The AIR BAG OFF light will come on to let
you know
that the right front passenger’s air bag is off. The right
front passenger’s air bagwill remain off until you turn it
back on again, and the
AIR BAG OFF light will stay on
to remind you that the air bag is off.
1-63
If the air bag readiness light ever comes on when
you have turned off the air bag, it means that
something may be wrong with the air bag system.
The right frontpassenger’s air bag could inflate
even though the switch is off. If this ever
happens, don’t secure a rear-facing child
restraint in your vehicle until you have your
vehicle serviced.
3. Pick up the latch plate, and run the lap and shoulder
portions of the vehicle’s safety belt through or
around the restraint. The child restraint instructions
will show you how.
If the shoulder belt goes in front of the child’s face or
neck, put it behind the child restraint.
You’ll be using the lap-shoulder belt. See the earlier part
about the top strap if the child restraint has one. Be sure
to follow the instructions that came with the child
restraint. Secure the child in the child restraint when and
as the instructions say.
I. If your vehicle has air bags and you are using a
rear-facing child restraint in this seat, make sure the
air bag is turned off. If your child restraint is
forward-facing, always move the seat as far back as
it will go before securing it in this seat. (See “Seats”
in the Index.)
2. Put the restraint on the seat.
r
4. BIwkle the belt. Make sure the release button is
positioned so you would be able to unbuckle the
safety belt quickly if you ever had to.
5 . Pull the rest of the lap belt all the way out of the
retractor to set the lock.
6. To tighten the belt, feed the lap belt back into the
retractor while you push down on the child restraint.
If you’re using a forward-fxing child restraint, you
may find it helpful to use your knee to push down on
the child restraint as you tighten the belt.
7. Push and pull the child restraint in different
directions to be sure it is secure.
1-65
-~
.. .
~
To remove the child restraint, just unbuckle the vehicle’s
safety belt and let it go back all the way. The safety belt
will move freely again and be ready to work for an adult
or larger child passenger.
If your vehicle has air bags, turn on the right front
passenger’s air bag when you remove the rear-facing
child restraint.
r
To turn the air bag on again, insert your ignition key
into the
switch, push in, and move the switchto the ON position.
~
.
.
~~
.~
.. .
~
~~
~~~
~
~
~~
A CAUTION:
If the right frontpassenger’s air bag is turned
off, the person sitting there
won’t have the extra
protection of an airbag. In a crash, theair bag
wouldn’t beable to inflate andhelp protect the
person sitting there. Make sure theair bag is
turned on unless you are using a rear-facingchild
restraint in the right front seat
position.
Larger Children
Accident statistics showthat children are saferif they
are restrained in the rear seat. But they need to use the
safety beltsproperly.
0
Children who aren’t buckled up can be thrown out in
a crash.
0
Children who aren’t buckled up can strike other
people who are.
Children who have outgrown child restraints should
wear the vehicle’s safety belts.
If you have the choice, a child shouldsit next to a
window so the child can wear a lap-shoulder belt and
get the additional restraint a shoulderbelt can provide.
1-67
1
I
Never do this.
Here two children are wearing the same belt. The
belt can’t properly spread the impact
forces. In a
crash, thetwo children can be crushed together
and seriously injured. A belt must be used by
only oneperson at a time.
v
1-68
@’
What if a child iswearing a lap-shoulder belt,
but the child is so small that theshoulder belt is
very close to the child’s face or neck?
A:
Move the child toward the center of the vehicle, but
be sure that the shoulder belt still is onthe child’s
shoulder, so that in a crash the child’s upper body
would have the restraint that belts provide. If the
child is sitting in a rear seat outside position, see
“Rear Safety Belt Comfort Guides” in the Index.
If the child is so small that the shoulder belt is still
very close tothe child’s face orneck, you might
want to place the child in a seat that has a lap belt,
if your vehicle has one.
Never do this.
Here achild is sitting in a seat
that has a
lap-shoulder belt, but the shoulderpart is behind
the child. If the child wears the belt in this
way, in
a crash thechild might slide under thebelt. The
belt’s force would then be applied righton the
child’s abdomen. That could cause serious or
fatal injuries.
Wherever the child sits, the lap portion
of the belt
on the hips, just touching
should be worn low and snug
the child’s thighs. This applies belt force to the child’
pelvic bonesin a crash.
1-69
Safety Belt Extender
If the vehicle’s safety belt w6u fasten around you, you
should use it.
But if a safety belt isn’t long enough to fasten, your
dealer will order you an extender. It’s free. When you go
in to order it, take the heaviest coat you will wear, so the
extender will be long enough foryou. The extenderwill
be justfor you, and just for the seat in your vehicle that
you choose. Don’t let someone elseuse it, and use it
only for the seat it is made to fit. To wear it, justattach it
to the regular safety belt.
Checking Your Restraint Systems
Now and then, make sure the safety belt reminder light
and all your belts, buckles, latch plates, retractors and
anchorages areworking properly. Look for any other
loose or damagedsafety belt system parts. If you see
anything that might keep a safety belt system from
doing its job, have it repaired,
Torn or frayed safety belts may not protect you in a
crash. Theycan rip apart under impact forces. If a belt is
torn or frayed, get anew one right away.
Also look for any opened or broken air bag covers, and
have them repaired or replaced. (The airbag system
does not need regular maintenance.)
1-70
Replacing Restraint System Parts
After a Crash
If you’ve had a crash,do you need new belts?
After a very minor collision, nothing may be necessary.
But if the belts were stretched, as they would be if worn
during a more severe crash, then you need new belts.
If belts are cut or damaged, replace them. Collision
damage also may mean you will need to have safety belt
or seat parts repaired or replaced. New parts and repairs
may be necessary even if the belt wasn’t being used at
the time of the collision.
If an air bag inflates, you’ll need to replace airbag
system parts. See the part on the air bag system earlier in
this section.
b
NOTES
1-71
@bNOTES
1-72
Section 2 Features and Controls
Here you can learn about themany standard and optional features on
your vehicle, and information on starting,
shifting and braking. Also explained are the instrument panel and the warning systems that
you tell
if everything is
working properly-- and what todo if you have a problem.
2-2
2-3
2-4
2-5
2-6
2-9
2- 10
2- 10
2-1 1
2- 12
2- 14
2-15
2-18
2-2 1
2-25
2-26
2-29
Keys
Tailgate
Third Door(If Equipped)
Door Locks
Keyless Entry System(If Equipped)
Theft
Passlock”
New Vehicle “Break-In”
Ignition Positions
Starting Your Gasoline Engine
Engine Coolant Heater(If Equipped)
Automatic Transmission Operation
Manual Transmission Operation
Four-wheel Drive(If Equipped)
Parking Brake
Shifting Into Park(P) (Automatic
Transmission Models Only)
Shifting Out of Park (P)
(Automatic Transmission)
2-29
2-30
2-30
2-3 1
2-32
2-32
2-34
2-35
2-4 1
2-43
2-45
2-5 1
2- 60
2-62
2-64
Parking Your Vehicle (Manual Transmission
Models Only)
Parking Over Things That Burn
Engine Exhaust
Running Your Engine WhileYou’re Parked
(Automatic Transmission)
Locking Rear Axle(If Equipped)
Windows
Tilt Wheel(If Equipped)
Turn Signal/Multifunction Lever
Exterior Lamps
Interior Lamps
Mirrors
Storage Compartments
Instrument Panel
Instrument Panel Cluster
Warning Lights, Gages and Indicators
2-1
Keys
Leaving young children in a vehicle with the
ignition key is dangerous for many reasons.A child
or others could be badly injured or even killed.
They could operate power windows
or other
controls or even make the vehicle move. Don’t
leave the keys in a vehicle with young children.
2-2
Your vehicle has one
double-sided key for the
ignition and all door locks.
Tailgate
You can open the tailgateby lifting up on its handle
while pulling the tailgate toward
you.
To shut the tailgate, firmlypush it away from you into
the latch.
After you put the tailgate backup, pull it back toward
you, to be sure thatit latches securely.
Tailgate Removal
If you ever lose your keys, your dealer
will be able to
assist you with obtainingnew ones.
The tailgate on yourvehicle can beremoved to allow for
different loading situations. Although the tailgate can
be
removed without assistance,you may want someone to
assist you with the removal to avoidpossible damage to
the vehicle.
NOTICE:
Your vehicle has a number
of new features that
can help prevent theft.
You can have a lotof
trouble getting into your vehicle if you ever lock
your key inside.You may even have to damage
your vehicle to get in.
So be sure you havean
extra key.
2-3
Third Door (If Equipped)
To remove the tailgate:
Raise the tailgate
slightly and release both
retaining cable clips.To
release the retaining
cable clips,pull the
retaining cable clip away
from the cable end.Lift
the cable so it points
straight out and push the
cable clips forward.
2. With the tailgate at a
slight upward angle,
pull back on the tailgate
at the right edge and
then move the tailgate
to the right to release
the left edge.
Your vehicle may be equipped with a third door that
allows easier access to the rear area of an extended cab.
To open the third door, first open the passenger's side
front door. Then, use the handle located on the front
edge of the third door to open it.
Reverse the above procedure to reinstall. Make sure the
tailgate is secure.
You must close and latch the third door before you can
close the front passenger door.
To lock the door from the
Door Locks
inside, slide the lever on
your door down.
Unlocked doors canbe dangerous.
Passengers especially children can easily
open the doors and fall
out. When a door is
locked, the inside handle won’t open it.
Outsiders caneasily enter through an unlocked
door when you slow down or stop yourvehicle.
This may not be so obvious: You increase the
chance of being thrown outof the vehicle in a
crash if the doors aren’tlocked. Wear safety belts
properly, lock your doors, and you will be far
better off whenever you drive yourvehicle.
--
--
To unlock thedoor, slide the leverup.
There are several ways to lock and unlock your vehicle.
From the outside,use your key or the Keyless Entry
System, if your vehiclehas this option.
2-5
Power Door Locks (If Equipped)
Press the bottomof the
power door lock switch,
marked LOCK, on either
front doorto lock all the
doors at once. Press the
ribbed side of the switch to
unlock all the doors once.
at
Your interior lampswill be illuminated for a set period
of time when the transmitter signal isreceived by the
Keyless Entry System.In addition, your vehicle’s horn
will chirp if you press the LOCK button twice, to let you
know that the doors havelocked.
Your keyless entry system operates on a radio frequency
subject to Federal Communications Commission(FCC)
Rules and with Industry Canada.
This device complies with Part15 of the FCC Rules.
Operation is subject to the followingtwo conditions:
(1) this device may not cause harmful interference, and
(2) this device must accept any interference received,
including interference that may cause undesired operation.
Leaving Your Vehicle
If you are leaving the vehicle, take your keys,open your
door and set the locks from inside.Then get out and
close the door.
Keyless Entry System (If Equipped)
If your vehicle has this option, you can lock and unlock
your doors from about3 feet (1 m) up to 30 feet (9 m)
away using the remote keyless entry transmitter supplied
with your vehicle.
2-6
This device complieswith RSS-210 of Industry Canada.
Operation issubject to the following twoconditions:
(1) this device may not cause interference, and(2) this
device must accept any interference received, including
interference that may cause undesiredoperation of
the device.
Changes ormodifications to this system by other than an
authorized service facility could void authorization to
use this equipment.
This system has a range
of about 3 feet (1 m) up to
30 feet (9 m). At times you may notice a decrease in
range. This is normal for any remote keyless entry
system. If the transmitter does not work or if you have
to stand closerto your vehicle for the transmitter to
work, try this:
0
Check to determine if battery replacement or
transmitter resynchronizationis necessary. See the
instructions that follow.
0
Check the distance.You may be too far from your
vehicle. You may need to stand closer duringrainy
or snowy weather.
0
Check the location. Other vehicles or objectsmay be
blocking the signal. Fdke a few steps to the left or
right, hold the transmitter higher, and try again.
0
If you’re still having trouble, see your dealer aor
qualified technician for service.
Operation
To unlock the driver’s door,press the UNLOCK button.
The interior lampswill come on for 40 seconds or until
the ignition is turned on. If you press the UNLOCK
button again within five seconds, all the remaining doors
(except thethird door) will unlock.
Press the LOCK button to lock all the doors (except
the third door). The interior lampswill come on for
two seconds as soonas all the doors are closed.If you
press the LOCK button twice the horn will chirp to
confirm that the doors have locked.
If you do not want the horn to chirp as a confirmation
that the doors have locked or unlocked,
please consult
your dealer.
Matching Transmitter(s) To Your Vehicle
Each remote keyless entry transmitter is coded to
prevent another transmitter from unlocking
your vehicle.
If a transmitter is lost or stolen,a replacement can be
purchased through your dealer. Remember to bring any
remaining transmitterswith you when you go to your
dealer. When the dealer matches the replacement
transmitter to your vehicle, any remaining transmitters
must also be matched. Onceyour dealer has coded the
new transmitter, the lost transmitterwill not unlock your
vehicle. Eachvehicle can have only four transmitters
matched to it.
2-7
Battery Replacement
To replace the battery:
Under normal use, the battery in your remote keyless
entry transmitter should last about two years.
You can tell the battery is weak if the transmitter won’t
work at the normal range in any location. If you have to
get close toyour vehicle before thetransmitter works,
it’s probably time to changethe battery.
NOTICE:
When replacing the battery, use care not to
touch any of the circuitry. Static from your
body transferred to these surfaces may damage
the transmitter.
Use one threevolt, type CR2032, or equivalent battery.
1. Insert a small coin, or flathead screwdriver, to
separate the bottom of the transmitter from the top.
2. Remove the battery and replace it with a new one,
making sure the positive (+) side of the battery is
facing down.
3. Snap the top and bottom together.
4. Test the operation of the transmitter with your
vehicle. If the transmitter does not work, try
synchronizing the transmitter with the receiver.
2-8
Synchronization
Synchronization may be necessary due to the security
method used by this system. The transmitter does not
send the same signal twice to the receiver. The receiver
will not respond to a signalit has been sentpreviously.
This prevents anyone from recording and
playing back
the signal from the transmitter.
When you park your vehicle and open the driver’s door,
you’ll hear a tone reminding you to remove your key
from the ignition and take it with you. Always do this.
Your steering wheel will be locked, and so will your
ignition. If you have an automatic transmission, taking
your key out also locks your
transmission. And
remember to lock the doors.
To resynchronize your transmitter, stand close to your
vehicle and simultaneouslypress and hold the LOCK
and UNLOCK buttons on the transmitter forat least
to confirm
five seconds. The door locks should cycle
synchronization. If the locks do not cycle, see your
dealer for service.
Parking at Night
Theft
If you park in a lot where someone will be watching
your vehicle, it’s best to lock it up and take your keys.
But what if you have to leave your ignition key? What if
you have to leave something valuable in your vehicle?
Vehicle theft is big business, especially insome cities.
Although your vehicle has a number of theft-deterrent
features, we know that nothing we puton it can make it
impossible to steal. However, there are ways you can help.
Key in the Ignition
Park in a lighted spot, close all windows and lock your
vehicle. Remember to keep your valuables out of sight.
Put them in a storage area, or take them with you.
Parking Lots
Put your valuables in a storage area, like your
glove box.
Lock all the doors except the driver’s.
If you leave your vehicle with the keys inside, it’s an
easy target for joy riders orprofessional thieves -- so
don’t do it.
2-9
Passlock@
Your vehicle isequipped with the Passlock
theft-deterrent system.
Passlock is a passive theft-deterrent system. The system
is armed oncethe key is removed from the ignition.
Passlock enables fuel if the ignition lock cylinder is
turned with a valid key. If a correct key is not used, fuel
is disabled.
During normal operation, the SECURITY light will go
off after the engine is started.
If the engine stalls and the SECURITY light flashes,
wait until the light stops flashing before trying to restart
the engine. Remember to release the key from the
START position as soon as the engine starts.
If you are driving and theSECURITY light comes on, you
will be ableto restart the engine if youturn the engine off.
However, your Passlock system is not working properly
and must be serviced by your dealer. Your vehicle is not
protected by Passlock at this time.You may also want to
check the fuse (see “Fuses and Circuit Breakers” in the
Index). See your dealer for service.
If the SECURITY light comes on while the engine is
running, a problem has been detected and the system
may need service. See your dealer for service.
In an emergency, call the Roadside Assistance Center.
New Vehicle “Break-In”
NOTICE:
Your vehicledoesn’t need an elaborate
“break-in.” But it will perform better in the
long
run if you followthese guidelines:
Keep your speed at 55 mph (88 km/h) or
less for the first500 miles (805 km).
0 Don’t drive at any one speed
fast or
slow for the first500 miles (805 km).
Don’t make full-throttle starts.
Avoid making hard stops for the first
200 miles (322km) or so. During this time
your new brake linings aren’t yet broken
in. Hard stops with new linings can mean
premature wear and earlier replacement.
Follow this breaking-in guideline every
time you get new brake linings.
Don’t tow a trailer during break-in.
See “Towing a Trailer” in the Index for
more information.
--
--
LOCK (B): This position locks your ignition, steering
wheel and transmission.It’s a theft-deterrent feature.
Ignition Positions
You can use your key to turn your ignition switch to fiveYou will only be able to remove your key when the
different positions.
ignition is turned to LOCK.
C
OFF (C): This position letsyou turn off the engine but
still turn the steering wheel. It doesn’t lock the steerin
wheel like LOCK. UseOFF if you must haveyour
vehicle in motion while the engine
is off (for example,if
your vehicleis being pushed).
RUN (D): This is the position for driving.
START (E): This starts your engine.
ACCESSORY (A): ACCESSORY letsyou use things
like the radio, power windows and the windshield
wipers when the engine is off. Push in the key and turn
it toward you. Your steering wheel will remain locked,
just as it was before you inserted key.
the
I
On manualtransmission vehicles, turning thekey
to LOCKwill lockthe steeringcolumn and result
in a loss of ability to steer the
vehicle. This could
cause a collision. If you need to turn the engine
off while the vehicle is moving,turn the key only
to OFF. Don’t press the key release button while
the vehicle is moving.
2-11
NOTICE:
If your key seems stuck inLOCK and you can’t
turn it, be sure you are using the correctkey; if
so, is it all the way in? If it is, then turnthe
steering wheel left and right while you turn the
key hard. But turn the key only with your hand.
Using a tool to force it could break thekey or the
ignition switch. If none of this works, then your
vehicle needs service.
To remove the key on manual transmission vehicles,
turn the key to OFF, then press the button and turn the
key to LOCK. Do not hold the button in while turning
the key to OFF. Keeping your finger on the button, pull
the key straight out.
On automatic transmission vehicles, turn the key to
LOCK and pull it straight out.
Starting Your Gasoline Engine
If you have a diesel engine, see“Starting Your Diesel
Engine” in the Diesel Engine Supplement.
Automatic Transmission
Key Release Button (Manual Transmission)
The ignition key cannot be
removed from the ignition
of manual transmission
vehicles unless the key
release button is used.
Move your shift lever to PARK (P) or NEUTRAL (N).
Your engine won’t start in any other position -- that’s a
safety feature. To restart when you’re already moving,
use NEUTRAL (N) only.
NOTICE:
Don’t try to shiftto PARK (P) if your vehicle is
moving. If youdo, you could damage the
transmission. Shift to PARK (P) only whenyour
vehicle is stopped.
2-12
Manual Transmission
The gear selector shouldbe in NEUTRAL (N) and the
parking brake engaged.Hold the clutch pedal to the
floor and start the engine.Your vehicle won’t start if the
clutch pedal is not all the way down -- that’s a
safety feature.
How to Start the Engine
I. Without pushing the accelerator pedal, turn your
ignition key to START. When the engine starts,let
go of the key. The idle speedwill go down as your
engine gets warm.
NOTICE:
Holding your key in START for longer than
15 seconds at a time will cause your battery tobe
drained muchsooner. And the excessive heat can
damage yourstarter motor.
3. If your engine still won’t start (orstarts but then
stops), wait 15 seconds and startover.
When the engine starts,let go of the key and the
accelerator pedal.
NOTICE:
Your engine is designed to work with the
electronics in your vehicle. If you add electrical
parts oraccessories, you couldchange theway
the engine operates. Before adding electrical
equipment, check with your dealer. If you don’t,
your engine might not perform properly.
If you ever have tohave your vehicle towed, see
the part of this manualthat tells howto do it
without damaging yourvehicle. See “Towing
Your Vehicle” in theIndex.
2. If it doesn’t start rightaway, hold your key in
START. If it doesn’t start in 10 seconds, push the
accelerator pedal allthe way down for fivemore
seconds, unless it starts sooner.
2-13
Engine Coolant Heater (If Equipped)
W
In very cold weather, 0°F (- 18“C) or colder, the engine
coolant heater can help. You’ll get easier starting and
better fuel economy during engine warm-up. Usually,
the coolant heater should be plugged in a minimum of
four hours prior to starting your vehicle.
To Use the Engine Coolant Heater
1. Turn off the engine.
2, Open the hood and unwrap the electrical cord.
The engine coolantheater electrical cord is located
on the driver’s side of the engine compartment,near
the power steering reservoir.
2-14
3. Plug it into a normal, grounded 110-volt AC outlet.
Plugging the cord into an ungrounded outlet
could cause an electrical shock. Also, the wrong
kind of extension cord could overheat and cause
a fire.You could be seriously injured. Plug the
cord into a properly grounded three-prong
110-volt AC outlet. If the cord won’t reach, ause
heavy-duty three-prong extension cord rated for
at least 15 amps.
4. Before starting the engine,be sure to unplug and store
the cord as it was before to keep it away from moving
engine parts. If you don’t, it could be damaged.
How long should you keep the coolant heater plugged
in? The answer depends on
the outside temperature, the
kind of oil you have, and some other things. Instead of
trying to list everything here, we ask that you contact
your dealer in the area where you’ll be parking your
vehicle. The dealer can give you the best advice forthat
particular area.
4utomatic Transmission Operation
m.,>ep”
.
..
,
’
It is dangerous to get out
of your vehicle if the
shift lever is not fully inPARK (P) with the
There are severaldifferent positions for your shift lever.
If your vehicle is equipped with an automatic
transmission, it now features an electronic shift position
indicator within the instrument cluster. This display
must be powered anytime the shift lever is capable of
being moved out of PARK (P). This means that if your
key is in OFF, rather than LOCK, there will be a small
current drain on your battery which could discharge
your battery over a period of time. If you have to leave
your key in the ignition in OFF for an extended period,
it is recommended that you disconnect the battery cable
from the battery to prevent discharging yourbattery.
PARK (P): This locks your rear wheels. It’s the best
position to use when you start your engine because your
vehicle can‘t move easily.
parking brake firmly set. Your
vehicle can roll.
Don’t leave yourvehicle when the engineis
running unless you have
to. If you have left the
engine running, thevehicle can move suddenly.
You or otherscould be injured.To be sure your
vehicle won’t move, even when you’re on fairly
level ground, always set your parking brake and
(P).
move the shift lever PARK
to
If you have four-wheel drive, yourvehicle will be
free to roll even if your shift leveris in
PARK (P) if your transfercase is in
NEUTRAL (N). So, be sure the transfer case
is in
a drive gear, two-wheel high(2H) or four-wheel
high (4H) or four-wheel low (4L) not in
NEUTRAL (N). See “Shifting Into PARK (P)” in
the Index. If you’re pulling a trailer, see
“Towing
a Trailer” in the Index.
9-
--
--
REVERSE (R): Use thisgear to back up.
NOTICE:
Shifting to REVERSE (R) while your vehicle
is movingforward could damage your
transmission. Shift to REVERSE (R) only
after your vehicle isstopped.
To rock your vehicle back and forth to
get out of snow,
ice orsand without damaging your transmission, see
“Stuck: In Sand, Mud,Ice or Snow” in the Index.
NEUTRAL (N): In this position, your engine doesn’t
connect with the wheels. To restart when you’re already
moving, use NEUTRAL (N) only. Also, use
NEUTRAL (N) when your vehicle is being towed.
2-16
Shifting out of PA
,P) or NEUTRAL (N) while
your engine is “racing” (runningat high speed) is
dangerous. Unless your foot is firmly on the
brake pedal, your vehicle could move very
rapidly. You could losecontrol and hitpeople or
objects. Don’t shift out of PARK (P) or
NEUTRAL (N) while your engine is racing.
NOTICE:
Damage to your transmission caused by shifting
out of PARK (P) or NEUTRAL (N) with the
engine racing isn’t coveredby your warranty.
AUTOMATIC OVERDRIVE (GB): This position is
for normal driving.If you need more powerfor passing,
and you’re:
Going less than about 35 mph (56 km/h), push your
accelerator pedal about halfway down.
Going about 35 mph (56 k m h ) or more, push the
accelerator all theway down.
You’ll shift down to thenext gear and have more power.
can be used when
AUTOMATIC OVERDRIVE(0)
towing a trailer, carryinga heavy load, driving on steep
hills or for off-road driving.You may want to shift the
transmission to THIRD(3) or, if necessary,a lower gear
selection if the transmission shifts too often.
THIRD (3): This position is also used for normal
driving, however it offers more power and lower fuel
economy than AUTOMATIC OVERDRIVE(GO).
SECOND (2): This position gives you more power but
lower fuel economy.You can use SECOND (2) on hills.
It can help control your speed as you go down steep
to use
mountain roads, but then you would also want
your brakes off and on.
If you manually select SECOND (2),the transmission will
drive in second gear. You may use this feature for reducing
torque to the rear wheels when you are trying to start your
vehicle from a stop on slippery road surfaces.
FIRST (1): This position gives you even more power
(but lower fuel economy) thanSECOND ( 2 ) .You can
use it on very steep hills, or in deep snow or mud. If the
selector lever is put in FIRST
(1) while the vehicle is
moving forward, the transmission won’t shift into first
gear until the vehicleis going slowly enough.
NOTICE:
If your rear wheels can’t rotate, don’t try to
drive. This might happen if you were stuck in
very deep sand or mud or were
up against a solid
object. You could damage your transmission.
Also, if you stop when going uphill, don’t hold
your vehicle there with only the accelerator
pedal. This could overheat and damage the
transmission. Use your brakesor shift into
PARK (P) to hold your vehiclein position on
a hill.
2-17
Manual TransmissionOperation
5-Speed (MW3 Transmission with
Low Gear) (If Equipped)
Here’s how to operate
your transmission.
try to shift down into FIRST (1) at excessive vehicle
speeds, the shift lever will not move into the FIRST (1)
position until vehicle speed is reduced.
SECOND (2): Press the clutch pedal and shift into
SECOND ( 2 ) .Then, slowly let up on the clutch pedal as
you press the accelerator pedal.
You can shift into SECOND (2) when you’re going less
than 20 mph (32 km/h). If you’ve come to a complete stop
and it’s hard to shift into SECOND (2), put the shift lever
into NEUTRAL (N) and let up on the clutch. Press the
clutch pedal back down. Then shift into SECOND (2). If
you try to downshift into SECOND (2) at excessive
vehicle speeds, the shift lever will not move into the
SECOND ( 2 ) position until the vehicle speed is reduced.
FIRST (1) is intended only for heavy loads and is not
recommended for normal driving.
During the first 500 miles (805 km) of vehicle use, start
your vehiclemoving in FIRST (1). This allows clutch
components tobreak-in properly.
FIRST (1): Press the clutch pedal and shift into
FIRST (1). Then, slowly let up on the clutch pedal as
you press the accelerator pedal. Shift into FIRST(1)
only when the vehicle is below 5 mph (8 k m h ) . If you
2-18
THIRD (3): Press the clutch pedal and shift into
THIRD (3). Then,slowly let up on the clutch pedal as
you press the accelerator pedal.
FOURTH (4) and FIFTH (5): Shift intothe higher
forward gears the same way you do for THIRD (3).
Slowly let up on the clutch pedal as you press the
accelerator pedal.
To stop, let up on the accelerator pedal and press the brake
pedal. Just before the vehicle stops, press the clutch pedal
and the brake pedal, and shiftto NEUTRAL (N).
NEUTRAL (N): Use this position when you start or
idle your engine.
REVERSE (R):To back up, first press down the clutch
pedal. Wait about five seconds for the internal parts to stop
(R). Let up on the
spinning and then, shift into REVERSE
clutch pedal slowly while pressing the accelerator pedal.
You can shift into FIRST(1) when you’re going less
than 20 mph (32 kmh). If you’ve come toa complete
(l),put the shift
stop and it’s hard to shift into FIRST
lever into NEUTRAL(N) and let up on the clutch. Press
(1).
the clutch pedal back down. Then shift into FIRST
NOTICE:
SECOND (2):Press the clutch pedal as you let up on
(2). Then,
the accelerator pedal and shift into SECOND
slowly let up on the clutch pedal as you press the
accelerator pedal.
Shift to REVERSE (R)only after your vehicleis
stopped. Shifting to REVERSE (R) while your
vehicle is moving could damage your transmission.
THIRD (3), FOURTH (4) and FIFTH (5): Shift into
THIRD (3), FOURTH (4) and FIFTH (5) the same way
you do for SECOND(2). Slowly let up on the clutch
pedal as you press the accelerator pedal.
To stop, letup on the accelerator pedal and
Also, use REVERSE (R), along with the parking brake, press the brake pedal. Just before the vehicle stops,
when turningoff your engine and parking your vehicle. press the clutch pedal and the brake pedal, and shift t
NEUTRAL (N).
5-Speed (MG5M50 Transmission without
Low Gear) (If Equipped)
Here’s how to operate your transmission:
FIRST (1): Press the clutch pedal and shift into
FIRST (1). Then, slowly let up on the clutch pedal as
you press the accelerator pedal.
NEUTRAL (N): Use this position when you start or
idle your engine.
REVERSE (R): To back up, first press down the clutch
pedal. Wait about five seconds for the internal parts to stop
Let up on the
spinning and then, shift into REVERSE (R).
clutch pedal slowly while pressing the accelerator
pedal.
2-19
Up Shift Light
NOTICE:
Shift toREVERSE (R) only after your vehicle is
stopped. Shifting toREVERSE (R) while your
vehicle is moving could damage your transmission.
Also, use REVERSE (R), along with the parking brake,
when turning off your engine and parking your vehicle.
W f t Speeds
A CAUTION:
If you skip more than one gear when you
downshift, you could lose control
of your vehicle.
And you could injure yourselfor others. Don’t shift
down more than one gear when you downshift.
If your speed dropsbelow 20 mph (32 km/h), or if the
engine is not running smoothly, you should downshift to
the next lower gear. You may have to downshift two or
more gears to keepthe engine running smoothly or for
good performance.
2-20
If you have a manual
transmission, you may have
a SHIFT light. This light
SHIFT
will show you when to shift
to the next higher gear for
best fuel economy.
When this light comes on,you can shift to the next
higher gear if weather, road and traffic conditions let
you. For the best fuel economy, accelerate slowly and
shift when the light comes on.
While you accelerate, it is normal for thelight to goon
and off if you quickly change theposition of the
accelerator. Ignore the SHIFT lightwhen you downshift.
If your vehicle has four-wheel drive and is equipped
with a manual transmission, disregard the SHIFT light
when the transfer case is in 4-Wheel Low.
Four-wheel Drive (If Equipped)
Manual Transfer Case (If Equipped)
If your vehicle has four-wheel drive,you can send your
engine’s driving power to all four wheels for extra
traction. To get the most satisfaction out of four-wheel
drive, you must be familiar with its operation. Read the
part that follows before using four-wheel drive.You
should use 2-WHEEL HIGH (2H) for most normal
driving conditions.
.
NOTICE:
Driving in the 4-WHEEL HIGH (4H) or
4-WHEEL LOW (4L) positions for a long time
on dry or wet pavement could shorten the life
of
your vehicle’s drivetrain.
Front Axle Locking
Feature
The transfer case shift lever is on
the floor to the right of
the driver. Use this lever to shift into
and out of
four-wheel
drive.
The front axle locks and unlocks automatically when
you
shift the transfer case. Some delay for the axle to lockor
unlock is normal. If the outside temperature is very hot, or
the vehicle hasbeen used under hard driving conditions,
there may be a slight delay for the axle to unlock.
2-21
I
I
The front axleportion of the indicator diagramwill light
up when you shift intofour-wheel drive and the front
axle engages.
Some delay between shifting and the indicator’s lighting
is normal.If the front axle light does
not go out
immediately after you shift out of four-wheel drive,
have your dealer check your system.
An indicator near the lever shows you the transfer
case settings:
2-Wheel High (2H):This setting is for driving
in most
street and highway situations. Your front axleis not
engaged in two-wheel drive.
2-22
4-Wheel High (4H): This settingengages your front
axle to help driveyour vehicle. Use 4H when you need
extra traction and in most off-road situations.
Shifting the transfercase to NEUTRAL (N)can
cause your vehicle to roll even if the transmission
is in PARK (P), or if you have a manual
transmission, even if you are ingear. You or
someone else couldbe seriously injured. Be sure
to set the parkingbrake before placing the
transfer case in NEUTRAL(N). See “Parking
Brake” in the Index.
NEUTRAL (N):Shift to this setting only when your
vehicle needs to be towed or when using a powertake-off.
4-Wheel Low (4L): This setting also engages your front
axle to give you extra power andalso gives you a higher
driveline ratio. It shouldbe used only for off-road driving.
You can shift from 2-WHEEL HIGH(2H) to 4-WHEEL
When your neaaramps or parking lamps are on, rotate the
HIGH (4H) or from 4-WHEEL HIGH (4H) to
thumb wheel next to the headlamp switch up to brighten
or down to dim your transfer case indicator light.
2-WHEEL HIGH (2H) while the vehicle is moving.
if you take your foot
Your front axle will engage faster
off the accelerator for a few seconds after you shift. In Electronic Transfer Case (If Equipped)
extremely cold weather, it may be necessary to stop or
slow the vehicle to shift into 4-WHEEL HIGH (4H).
To shift into or out
of 4-WHEEL LOW (4L) or
NEUTRAL (N):
1. Slow the vehicle to a roll, about1 to 3 mph
(2 to 5 km/h)
and shiftan automatic transmission
into NEUTRAL (N),or with a manual transmission,
press the clutch pedal.
2. Shift the transfer case shift lever in one
continuous motion.
Don’t pause in NEUTRAL (N) as you shift the
transfer case into 4-WHEEL LOW (4L), or your
gears could clash.
Remember that driving in 4-WHEEL HIGH (4H) or
If your four-wheel-drive vehicle has the electronic
4-WHEEL LOW (4L) may reduce fuel economy.Also,
transfer case, the transfer case switches are below and
driving in four-wheel drive on dry pavement could
the leftof the climate control system.
cause your tires to wear faster and make your transfer
case harder to shift and run noisier.
2-23
Use these switches to shift into and out of four-wheel
drive. You can choose among three driving settings:
2HI: This setting is for driving in most street and
highway situations. Your front axle is not engaged in
two-wheel drive.
4HI: This setting engages your front axle to help
drive your vehicle. Use 4HI when you need extra
traction, such as on snowy or icy roads, or in most
off-road situations.
Shifting from 2HI to 4HI
Press and release the 4HI switch. This can be done at
any speed, and the front axle will lock automatically
with some delay.
Shifting from 4HI to 2HI
Press and release the 2HI switch. This can be done at
any speed, and the front axle will unlock automatically
with some delay.
4LO: This setting also engages your front axle to give Shifting from 2HI or 4HI 4LO
to
you extra traction.You may never need 4LO. It sends
To shift from 2HI or 4HI to
4L0, the vehicle must be
the maximum power to all four wheels.
You might
3 mph (4.8 km/h) with the
stopped or moving less than
choose 4LOif you were driving off-road in sand,mud
transmission in NEUTRAL (N). The preferred method
or deep snow and climbing or descending steep hills.
for shifting into4LO is to have your vehicle moving1 to
Indicator lights in the switches show you which setting
2 mph (1.6 to 3.2 km/h). Press and release the 4LO
you are in. The indicator lights will come on briefly when switch. You must wait for the 4LO indicator light to stop
you turn on the ignition and the last chosen setting will
flashing and remain illuminated before shifting your
stay on. If the lights do not come on, you should take your transmission into gear.
vehicle in for service.An indicator light will flash while
If the 4LO switch is pressed when your vehicle is in
is
shifting. It will remain illuminated when the shift
completed. If for some reason the transfer cannot make a gear and/or moving, the 4LO indicator light will flash
for 30 seconds and not complete the shift unless your
requested shift, it will return to the last chosen setting.
vehicle is moving slower than3 mph (4.8 km/h) and the
transmission is in NEUTRAL (N). After 30 seconds the
transfer case will return to 4HI.
2-24
-
Shifting from4LO to 4HI or 2HI
To shift from4LO to 4HI or 2H1, your vehiclemust be
stopped or moving less than3 mph (4.8 km/h) with the
transmission in NEUTRAL (N). The preferred method
for shifting outof 4LO is to have your vehicle moving
1 to 2 mph (1.6 to 3.2 km/h). Press andrelease the 4HI
switch. You must wait for the 4HI indicator light to stop
flashing and remain illuminated before shifting
your
transmission into gear.
If the 4HI switch is pressed when y6uf vehicle is ingear
andor moving, the4HI indicator lightwill flash for
30 seconds but will not complete the shift unless the
vehicle is moving slower than 3 mph (4.8 k m h ) and the
transmission is in NEUTRAL (N).
Parking Brake
To set the parking brake,hold the regular brakepedal
down with your right foot. Push down the parking brake
pedal with your left foot.
If the ignition is on,the brake system warning lightwill
come on.
To release the parking brake, holdthe regular brake
pedal down.
If the ignitionis on when the parkingbrake is released,
the brake system warning lightwill go off.
I NOTICE:
Driving with the parking brake
on can cause
your rear brakesto overheat. You may have to
replace them, and you could
also damage other
parts of your vehicle. Always check to be sure
your parking brakeis fully released before
you drive.
2-25
If you are towing a trailer and are parking on any hill,
see “Towing a Trailer” in the Index. That section shows
what to do first to keep the trailer from moving.
If you have a 3500HD model, it is recommended that
the propshaft mounted parking brake be burnished as
part of the new vehicle break-in.The parking brake
will work best after it has been burnished following
these instructions.
Make 10 stops, using the parking brake foot pedal, from
20 mph (32km/h) about 2 1/2 miles(4 km) apart. In
20 mph (32 kdh).
between stops, drive the vehicle at
Shifting Into PARK (P) (Automatic
Transmission Only)
It can be dangerous toget out of your vehicle if
the shiftlever is not fully in PARK (P) with the
parking brakefirmly set. Your vehiclecan roll.
If you have left the engine running,
the vehicle can
move suddenly. Youor others could be injured.To
be sure your vehicle won’t move, even when you’re
on fairly level ground, use the stepsthat follow. If
you have four-wheel driveand your transfer case is
in NEUTRAL (N), your vehicle will be free to roll,
even if your shift lever is PARK
in
So, be sure
the transfer case is in a drivegear not in
NEUTRAL (N). If you’re pulling a trailer, see
“Towing a Trailer” in the Index.
(P).
--
2-26
1. Hold the brake pedal down withyour right foot and
set the parkingbrake.
2. Move the shift lever into PARK (P) position like this:
0
Move the lever up as far as it will go.
3. If you have four-wheel drive,be sure the transfer
case is in a drive gear-- not in NEUTRAL (N).
Pull the lever toward you.
4. Turn the ignition key to LOCK.
5. Remove the key and take it with you. If you can
leave your vehiclewith the ignitionkey in your
hand, your vehicle is in PARK (P).
2-27
Leaving Your Vehicle With the Engine
Running (Automatic Transmission Only)
It can be dangerous leave
to your vehicle withthe
engine running. Your vehiclecould move
suddenly if the shift lever is not fully in PARK (P)
with the parking brakefirmly set. If you have
four-wheel drive with a mama1 transfer case
shift lever and your transfer case is in
NEUTRAL (N),your vehicle will be free to roll,
even if. your shift lever is m PARK (P). So be sure
--
the transfercase isin a drive gear not in
NEUTRAL (N). And, if you leave the vehicle with
the engine runnhg, it could overheat and even
catch fire. You or others could be injured.Don’t
leave yonr vehicle withthe engine running unless
you have to.
L
If you have to leave your vehicle with engine
the
running, be sure your vehicle
is in PARK (P) and the
parking brake isfirmly set before you leave it.
After yon
move the shift lever into PARK (P),hold the regular
brake pedal down. Then,see if yon can move the shift
lever awayfrom PARK (P) without first pulling it
toward you.If you can, it means that the shif’t lever
wasn’t fully lockedinto PARK (P).
Torque Lock(Automatic Transmission)
If you are parking ona hill and you don’t
shift your
transmission into PARK (P)properly, the weight of the
vehicle may put too much force on the parking inpawl
the transmission.You may find it difficult to pall the
shift lever outof PARK (P). This is called “torquelock.”
To prevent torque lock, set the
parlring brake and then
shift into PARK (P) properly before you leave the
driver’s seat.To find out how, see “ShiftingInto
PARK (P)”in the Index.
When you are ready to drive, move the
shift lever out of
PARK (P)before you releasethe parking brake.
If torque lockdoes occur, you may need to have another
vehicle push yoursa little uphill to take some
of the
pressure from the parking pawl in the transmission,
so
you can pull the shift lever
out of PARK (P).
Shifting Out ofPARK (P)
(Automatic Transmission)
Parking Your Vehicle
(Manual Transmission Models Only)
Your vehicle has a brake-transmission shift interlock
system. You have to fully apply your regular brakes
before you can shift fromPARK (P) when the ignition is
in RUN. See “Automatic Transmission” in the Index.
Before you get outof your vehicle, put yourmanual
transmission in REVERSE (R), turn off the engine, and
firmly apply the parkingbrake.
If you cannot shift outof PARK (P), ease pressure on
the shift lever and push the shift lever
all the way up
into PARK (P) as you maintain brake application. Then,
move the shift lever to any gear
you want.
If you have four-wheel drive, be sure your transfer case
is ina drive gear. Your vehicle could rollif it isn’t.
If you are parkingon a hill, or if you are pulling a
trailer, see “Towing a Trailer” in the Index.
If you ever hold the brake pedal down butstill can’t
shift outof PARK (P), try this:
1. Turn the key to OFF.
2. Apply and hold the brakeuntil the end of Step 4.
3. Shift to NEUTRAL (N).
4. Start the vehicle and shift to the drive gearyou want.
5. Have the brake-transmission shift interlock system
fixed as soon as you can.
2-29
Parking Over Things That Burn
Things that can burn could touch hot exhaust
parts under your vehicle and ignite. Don’t park
over papers, leaves, dry grass or other things that
can burn.
2-30
Engi--e Exhaust
Engine exhaust cankill. It contains thegas
carbon monoxide (CO),which you can’t see or
smell. It can cause unconsciousness and death.
You might have exhaust coming in if:
0 Your exhaust system sounds strange
or different.
0 Your vehicle gets rusty underneath.
Your vehicle was damaged in a collision,
Your vehicle was damaged when driving over
high points on the road
or over road debris,
0 Repairs weren’t done correctly.
0 Your vehicle or exhaust system had been
modified improperly.
If you ever suspect exhaust is coming into
your vehicle:
0 Drive it only with all the windows down to
blow out anyCO; and
0 Have your vehicle fixed immediately.
Running Your Engine While You’re
Parked (Automatic Transmission)
It’s better not to park with the enginerunning. But if
ever you have to, hereare some thingsto know.
1A
CAUTION:
I
~
Idling the engine withthe air system controloff
could allow dangerous exhaust into your vehicle
(see the earlier Caution under “Engine Exhaust”).
Also, idling in a closed-in place can letdeadly
carbon monoxide (CO)into yourvehicle even if
the fanswitch is at the highest setting. One place
this can happenis a garage. Exhaust with
CO can come in easily. NEVER park in a
garage with the engine running.
Another closed-in place can be a blizzard. (See
“Blizzard” in the Index.)
--
--
1rA
CAUTIO1
1
It can be dangerous toget out of your vehicle if
the shiftlever is not fully in PARK (P) with the
parking brakefirmly set. Your vehiclecan roll.
Don’t leave your vehicle when the engine is
running unless you have to. If you’ve left the
engine running, the vehicle can move suddenly.
You or others could be injured. To be sure your
vehicle won’t move, even whenyou’re on fairly
level ground, always set your parkingbrake and
move the shiftlever to PARK (P).
If you have four-wheel drive and your transfer case is in
NEUTRAL (N),your vehicle will be free to roll, even if
your shift lever is in PARK (P). So, be sure the transfer
case is in a drive gear -- not in NEUTRAL (N). Always
set your parking brake. Follow the proper steps to be
sure your vehicle won’t move. See “ShiftingInto
PARK (P)” in the Index.
If you’re pulling a trailer, see “Towing a Trailer” in
the Index.
2-31
Locking Rear Axle(If Equipped)
Power Windows (If Equipped)
If you have this feature, your locking rear axle can
give
you additional traction on snow, mud, ice, sand or
gravel. It works like a standard axle most of the time,
but when one of the rear wheels has no traction and the
other does,this feature will allow the wheel with
traction to movethe vehicle.
Windows
Manual Windows
Turn the hand crank on each door to
raise or lower
manual windows.
Regular and ExtendedCab
2-32
Press the rearof the switch with the power window
symbol on it to lower thewindow.
Press the front of the switch with the power window
symbol on it to raise thewindow.
The driver’s window also has an express down feature
that allows the window to be lowered without holding
the switch. Press and hold the side of the window switch
marked AUTO for one secondto activate the express
down mode. The express down mode can be canceled at
any time by pressing the opposite sideof the switch. To
open the window partway, lightly tap the switch until the
window is at the desired position.
Crew Cab
If you have the optional power windows,the controls
are on each of the side doors.
The driver’s doorhas a switch for the passenger
windows as well.Your power windows will work when
the ignition has been turned to ACCESSORY or RUN.
Lockout Switch (Crew Cab)
If you have a CrewCab and power windows, the power
window switch has a lockout feature. This feature
prevents the rear windows from operatingwhen the
front driver’s side switch is in LOCK. The windows can
still be operated using the driver’s window switch.
When the switch ismoved to NORM, the rear power
windows will operate again.
2-33
Swing-Out Windows (ExtendedCab)
To open a rear swing-out
window, just flip the
Horn
On air bag-equipped vehicles, press the air bag module
in the center of the steeringwheel to soundthe horn.
On vehicles not equipped with an air bag, press the pad
in the centerof the steering wheel to sound the horn.
Tilt Wheel (If Equipped)
A tilt steering wheel allows
you to adjustthe steering
wheel beforeyou drive.
The latch will catch when the window is fully open and
hold the window in the open position.
Sliding Rear Window (If Equipped)
To open the sliding rear window, unlock the latch lever
by moving the lever toward the front of the cab. Release
the lever fromthe latch plate and slide the window
toward the driver’s side of the vehicle,
To close the window, slide the window toward the
passenger’s side of the vehicle. The latch lever will
automatically snap locked on to the latch plate. Try to
open the window without releasing the latch lever to be
sure the window is in the locked position.
I.
You can also raise itto the highest levelto give your
legs more room when you enter and exitthe vehicle.
To tilt the wheel, hold the steering wheel and pull the
lever. Move the steering wheel to a comfortable level,
then release the lever to lock the wheel in place.
Turn SignaVMultifunction Lever
r
Turn Signal and Lane Change Signals
The turn signal has two upward (for right) and two
downward (for left) positions. These positions allow you
to signal a turn or a lane change.
To signal a turn, move the lever all the way up or
down. When the turn is finished, the lever will
return automatically.
An arrow on the instrument
panel will flash in the
direction of the turn or
lane change.
The lever onthe left side of the steering column
includes your:
Turn Signal and Lane Change Indicator
0
Headlamp HighLow Beam Changer
0
Windshield Wipers
0
Windshield Washer
0
Cruise Control (If Equipped)
To signal a lane change,just raise or lower the lever
until the arrow starts to flash. Hold it there until you
complete your lane change. Thelever will return by
itself when you release it.
If you move the lever all the way up or down, and the
arrow flashes at twice the normal rate, a signal bulb may be
burned out and other drivers may not see your turn signal.
2-35
If a bulb isburned out, replace it to help avoid an
accident. If the arrowsdon’t go on at all when you
signal a turn,check for burned-out bulbs and a blown
fuse (see “Fuses and Circuit Breakers” in the Index).
Headlamp HighLow-Beam Changer
Windshield Wipers
You control the windshield
wipers by turning the knob
with the wiper symbol on it.
To change the headlamps from low to high beam or high
to low beam, pull the multifunction lever all the way
toward you. Then release it.
When the high beams are
on, this light on the
instrument panel also will
be on.
For a single wiping cycle, turn the knob to MIST. Hold
it there until the wipers start, then let go. The wipers will
stop after one cycle.If you want more cycles, hold the
knob on MIST longer.
You can set the wiper speed for a long orshort delay
between wipes. This can be very useful in light rain or
snow. Turn the knob to choose the delay time. The
closer to LOW, the shorter the delay.
2-36
For steady wipingat low speed, turnthe knob to the LOW
position. For high-speed wiping,turn the knob further,to
HIGH. To stop the wipers, move the knob to OFF.
Windshield Washer
At the top of the lever,
there's a paddle with the
word PUSH on it. To spray
washer fluid onthe
windshield, push the paddle.
Damaged wiper blades may prevent you from seeing
well enough to drivesafely. To avoid damage, be sureto
clear ice and snow from thewiper blades before using
them. If they are frozen tothe windshield, carefully
loosen or thaw them. If your blades do become
damaged, get new blades or blade inserts.
Heavy ice or snow can overload yourwipers. The
windshield wiper motor is protected from overloadby a
circuit breaker and a fuse.If the motor overheats dueto
heavy snow, etc., the wiper will stop until the motor
cools. Although protected from electrical overload,
overload due to heavy snow, etc. may cause wiper
linkage damage. Always clear ice and heavy snow from
the windshield beforeusing your windshield wipers.
ACAUTION:
In freezing weather, don't use your washer until
the windshieldis warmed. Otherwise the washer
fluid can form ice on the windshield, blocking
your vision.
2-37
Washer fluid will spray as long asyou push the paddle.
When you let go of the paddle, the wipers will continue
to wipe for afew seconds and then either stop orreturn
to the preset speed.
The use of a hood-mounted air deflector may adversely
affect windshield wiper and washer performance.
Cruise Control (If Equipped)
With cruise control, you can
maintain a speed of about
25 mph (40 k m h ) or more
without keeping your foot
on the accelerator. This can
really help on long trips.
Cruise controldoes not
work at speeds below about
25 mph (40 k d h ) .
When you apply your brakes, the cruise control
shuts off.
Cruise control can be dangerous where you
can’t drive safely at a steady speed. So,
don’t use your cruise controlon winding
roads or in heavy traffic.
Cruise control can be dangerous on
slippery roads. On such roads, fast changes
in tire tractioncan cause needless wheel
spinning, and you could lose control. Don’t
use cruise control on slippery roads.
Setting Cruise Control
If you leave your cruise controlswitch on when
you’re not using cruise, you might hit a button
and go into cruisewhen you don’twant to. You
could be startled andeven losecontrol. Keep the
cruise control switch off until you want to use it.
1. Move the cruise switch
to ON.
Resuming a Set Speed
Suppose you set your cruise control at a desired speed
and then you apply the brake. This, of course, shutsoff
the cruise control. But you don’t need to reset it.
Once you’re going about
25 mph (40 km/h) or more,
you can move the cruise
switch from ON to R/A
(Resume/Accelerate) for
about half a second.
~
2. Get up to the speed you want.
3. Press in the SET button
at the end of the lever
and release it.
You’ll go right back up to your chosen speed and
stay there.
Remember, if you hold the switch at R/A longer than
half a second, the vehicle will keep going fasteruntil
you release the switch or apply the brake. So unless you
want to go faster, don’t hold the switch at R/A.
4. Take your foot off the accelerator pedal.
2-39
Increasing Speed While Using Cruise Control
Passing Another Vehicle While Using Cruise Control
There are twoways to go toa higher speed:
Use the accelerator pedal to increase your speed. When
you take your foot off the pedal, your vehicle will slow
down to the cruise control speed you set earlier.
Use the accelerator pedal to get to the higher speed.
Press the button at the end of the lever, then release
the button and the accelerator pedal. You’ll now
cruise at the higher speed.
Move the cruise switch from ON to WA. Hold it
there until you get up tothe speed you want, and
then release the switch. (To increase yourspeed in
very small amounts, move the switch to R/A for less
than half a second. Each time you do this, your
vehicle will go about 1 mph (1.6 k d h ) faster.)
Reducing Speed While Using Cruise Control
There are twoways to reduce your speed while using
cruise control:
0
Press in the button at the end of the lever until you
reach the lower speed you want, then release it.
To slow down in very small amounts, press the
button for lessthan half a second. Each time you do
this, you’ll go 1 mph (1.6 k d h ) slower.
2-40
Using Cruise Control on Hills
How well your cruise control will work on hills depends
upon your speed, load and the steepness of the hills.
When going up steep hills, you may have to step on the
accelerator pedal to maintain your speed. If the
steepness of the hill causes the vehicle speed to drop
more than 15 mph (24 kmh) below the set speed, your
cruise control will automatically disengage. When going
downhill, you may have to brake or shift to a lower gear
to keep your speed down. Of course, applying the brake
takes you out of cruise control. Many drivers findthis to
be too much trouble and don’t use cruise control on
steep hills.
Exterior Lamps
Ending Cruise Control
There are twoways to turn off the cruise control:
Step lightly on the brake pedal or
Move the cruise switch
to OFF.
Erasing Speed Memory
When you turn off the cruise control or the ignition,
your cruise controlset speed memory is erased.
Your parking lamp and headlamp switch is on the
driver’s side of your instrument panel.
Rotate the knob to the right, to the parking lamp symbol,
to turn on:
Parking Lamps
Sidemarker Lamps
2-41
0
Clearance Lamps (If Equipped)
0
Taillamps
0
License Plate Lamps
0
Instrument Panel Lights
0
Transfer Case Shift Indicator Light
(Four-Wheel-Drive Vehicles)
Rotate the knob to the right again to the master
lighting symbol toturn on all the lamps listed as
well as the headlamps.
Rotate the knob to the left, to OFF, to turn off
your lamps.
Rotate the thumb wheel next to the knob up to adjust
instrument panel lights. Rotate the thumb wheel up to
the first notch to return the radio display and gearshift
indicator LED display to full intensity when the
headlamps or parking lamps areon.
You can switch your headlamps from high to low beams
by pulling on the turn signaUmultifunction lever.
ACCESSORY, the buzzer can be turned off by turning
the thumb wheel next to the parking lamp/headlamp
knob all the way down.
Daytime Running Lamps
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) can make it easier for
others to see the front of your vehicle during the day.
DRL can be helpful in many different driving
conditions, but they can be especially helpful in the
short periods after dawn and before sunset.
The DRL system will make your headlamps come on at
a reduced brightness when:
0
the ignition is on,
the headlamp switch is off and
the parking brake is released.
When the DRL are on, only your headlamps will be on.
The taillamps, sidemarker and other lamps won’t be on.
Your instrument panel won’t be lit up either.
Headlamps On Reminder
When it begins to get dark, your DRL indicator light is a
reminder to turn your headlamp switch on. The other lamps
k d t come on with your headlamps will also come on.
A buzzer will sound when your headlamps areturned on
and the key is turned to the OFF, LOCK or
ACCESSORY position. If you need to use your
headlamps when the key is turned to OFF, LOCK or
When you turn off the headlamp switch, the regular
lamps will go off, and your headlamps will change to
the reduced brightness of DRL.
2-42
To idle your vehicle with the DRL off, set the parking
brake. The DRL will stay off until you release the
parking brake.
As with any vehicle, you should turn on the regular
headlamp system when you need it.
Fog Lamps (If Equipped)
If you have fog lamps, usethem for bettervision in
foggy or misty conditions. Your parking lamps and/or
low-beam headlamps must be on for your fog lamps
to work.
The fog lampswitch is on
the lower edgeof your
instrument panel.
Remember, fog lamps alone will not give off as much
light as your headlamps. Never use your fog lamps in
the dark without turning on your headlamps.
Fog lamps will go off whenever your high-beam
headlamps come on.When the high beams go off, the
fog lamps will come on again.
Interior Lamps
Instrument Panel Intensity Control
The instrument panel intensity control is located to the
right of the headlamp switch.
Rotate the thumb wheel up to adjust instrument panel
lights. Rotate the thumb wheel up to the first notch to
return the radio display and gearshift indicator LED
display to full intensity when the headlamps or parking
lamps are on. To turn on the dome lamps (with the
vehicle doors closed)rotate the thumb wheel up to the
second notch position.
Illuminated Entry
Press the ribbed top part of the switch to turn the fog
lamps on. Press the bottom of the switch to turn them
off. A light will glow in the switch when the fog lamps
are on.
Your vehicle is equipped with an illuminated
entry feature.
When the doors are opened,the dome lamps will come
on if the dome lamp button is out. When all the doors
are closed,or the dome lamp button is pressed in, the
lamps will stay on for a short period of time and will
then go out.
Front Reading Lamps (If Equipped)
If your vehicle has reading
lamps, press the button next
to the lampto turn the lamp
on. The lamps can be
adjusted to point in the
direction you want.
Press the button again to turn the lamp off.
Dome Lamps
The dome lampswill come on when you open the doors.
You can also turn the dome lamps on by rotating the
thumb wheel, located next to the parking/headlamps
knob, all the way up to the second notch. In this
position, the dome lamps will remain on whether the
doors are openedor closed.
2-44
You can use the DOME OVERRIDE button, located
below the parking/headlamp knob, to set the dome
lamps to come on automatically when the doors are
opened, or remain off. To turn the lamps off, press the
button once. With the button in this position, the dome
lamps will remain off when the doors are open. To
return the lamps to automatic operation,press the button
again and return it to the “out” position. With the button
in this position, the dome lamps will come on when you
open the door.
Mirrors
Cargo Lamp
Press the ribbed top part of
the switch to turn the cargo
lamp on. Press the bottom
of the switch to turn it off.
Inside Daymight Rearview Mirror
1
The dome lamp switch
must be on or oneof the doors
open for the cargo lamp towork.
Pull the tab under the mirror rearward to reduce glare
from headlamps behindyou after dark.Push the tab
forward for normal daytime operation.
2-45
Electrochromic Inside Rearview Mirror
with Compass (If Equipped)
Your vehicle may have an electrochromic inside
rearview mirror.
When on, an electrochromic mirror automatically dims
to the proper levelto minimize glare from lights behind
you after dark.
The mirror also includesan eight-point compass display in
the upper rightcomer of the mirror face. When on, the
compass automatically calibrates as the vehicleis driven.
2-46
Mirror Operation
The right sideof the switch located at the bottom
of the
mirror tuns the electrochromic mirroron and off. The
AUTO LED will come on whenthe electrochromic mirror
is turned on.To tum the rnirroron, press and hold the
MRROR button for three seconcls. The rnirror will darken
and remain dark until the buttonis released. To turn the
mirror off, press and release the MIRROR button.
Compass Operation
The mirror can be calibrated in one of two ways:
Press the COMP switch once briefly to turn the compass
on oroff.
0
Drive the vehicle in circles at five mph (8 k d h ) or
less until the display reads a direction, or
When the ignition and the compass feature areon, the
compass will show two character boxes for
approximately two seconds. After two seconds, the
mirror will display the compass heading.
0
Drive the vehicle on your everyday routine.
When cleaning themirror, use a paper towel or similar
material dampened with glass cleaner. Do not spray
glass cleaner directly on the mirror as that may cause the
liquid cleanerto enter the mirror housing.
Compass Calibration
If, after two seconds, the display does not show a compass
heading (“N’ for North, for example), there may be a
strong magnetic field interfering withthe compass. Such
interference may be caused by a magnetic antenna mount,
magnetic note pad holder or a similar magnetic item.If the
letter “C” should ever appearin the compass window, the
mirror may need calibration.
Compass Variance
The mirror is set in zone eight upon leaving the factory.
It will be necessary to adjust the compassto compensate
for compass varianceif you live outside zoneeight.
Under certain circumstances, as duringa long distance
cross-country trip, it will be necessary to adjust for
compass variance. Compass variance is the difference
between earth’s magnetic north and true geographic
north. If not adjusted to account for compass variance,
your compass could give falsereadings.
To adjust for compassvariance:
I . Use the COMP button located at the bottom of
the mirror.
2. Press and hold the COMP button for three seconds
until a zone number appears in the display.
3. Find your current location and variance zone number
on the following zone map.
2-47
The use of hood-mounted air deflectors and add-on
convex mirror attachments may adversely affect
mirror performance.
Camper Type Outside Mirrors
(If Equipped)
4. Press the COMP button on the bottom of the mirror
until the new zone number appears in the display.
After you stop pressing the button in, the display will
show a compass directionwithin a few seconds.
Outside Manual Adjust Mirrors
Adjust your outside mirrors so you can just see the
side of your vehicle and have a clearview of objects
behind you. Some mirrors can be folded in, to enter
narrow doorways.
If your vehicle is equipped with the camper type
mirrors, they can be adjusted so you can have a clear
view of objects behind you.
1. To adjust the mirrors when hauling a slide-in camper
or towing a trailer, rotate the mirror
by pushing the
of the vehicle.
mirror head toward the front
J. Rotate the mirror head,so that the mirror surface
faces the rearof the vehicle.
2-49
West Coast Q p e Outside Mirrors
(If Equipped)
If your vehicle is equipped with the west coast type
mirrors, they can be adjusted so you can have a clear
view of objects behind you.
backward or forward. You can also loosen the nut (C) on
the top and bottom of the outer mirror frame to tilt the
mirror head.
Electric Outside Rearview Mirrors
(If Equipped)
Select themirror you want
to move by moving the
center of the switch, located
on the driver’s door armrest,
to L (left) or R (right).
A. Outer Mirror Frame
B. Mirror Head
C. Nut
The mirrors can be adjusted by rotating the mirror
head (B) and moving the outer mirror frame (A)
2-50
Then, adjust the mirror angle by pressing the outer
arrows on the switch until the mirror is adjusted where
you want it.
Convex Outside Mirror
Your passenger’s side mirror may be convex. A convex
mirror’s surface is curved so you can see more from the
driver’s seat.
1A
CAUTION:
A convex mirror can make things(like other
vehicles) look farther away than they really are.
If you cut too sharply into the right lane, you
could hit a vehicle on your right. Check your
inside mirror or glance over your shoulder before
changing lanes.
Storage Compartments
Your vehicle has a variety of storage compartments
designed to store small items.
Your vehicle includes a number of storage
compartments for storageof often-used items.
Some vehicles have storage areas in the instrument panel.
Use these spacesfor items such as gloves or small books.
Some models have a storagepocket on each of the
front doors.
Some vehicles have a storage areabehind the seat.
Glove Box
To open your glove box, move the button toward the
passenger’s side and pull the door open.
Center Overhead Console(If Equipped)
Your vehicle may have an overhead console.It has
storage compartments inside it.
Installing a Garage Door Opener
If you have a garage dooropener, the front overhead
compartment can be used to conveniently store
the opener.
1. To install the garage door opener, first open the
compartment doorby pressing the release
button forward.
2-51
.1
2. Peel the protective
backing from the hook
and loop patch. Press it
firmly to the back of
your garage door opener,
as close to the center of
the opener aspossible.
3. Center the garage door opener activation button over
the console door button, and press the opener firmly
into place.
The pegs inside the compartment door are used to
make sure the button on the compartment doorwill
contact the control button on the garage door opener.
2-52
4. Add one peg at a time
until the PUSH button on
the compartment door
operates the garage door
opener, with the
compartment door closed,
when you press the
button marked PUSH.
5. Now, with the
compartment door
closed, press the
button markedPUSH
again to make sure the
Sunglasses Storage Compartment
The center overhead compartment can used
be to
conveniently store your sunglasses.
To open the center compartment, press the release
button located at the rear
of the compartment door.
With the garage door opener positioned properly and
the right numberof pegs in place,you should only
have to press thePUSH button slightly to operate
the opener.
6. Adjust the positionof the garage door opener and
add or remove pegs, as needed, until the opener
operates properly.
Place your sunglassesin the compartment doorwith the
lenses facing out.
The rear compartment canbe used to store a small item,
like a book.
To open the rear compartment, press the release
button
located at the rear
of the compartmentdoor.
2-53
Instrument Panel Cupholder
Center Console Storage Area (If Equipped)
Your vehicle has a cupholder in the middle of the
instrument panel.
Your vehicle may have a console compartmentbetween
the bucket seats.
To use the cupholder, pull
the handle and slide the
cupholder tray open.
To close the cupholder, slide it back into the
instrument panel.
2-54
To open it, lift the latch handle and swing the door open.
Your console may have a
cupholder that swingsout
for the backseat passengers
to use.
Your vehicle may have a
memo holder attached to the
front of the console. Use it
to hold padsof paper or
similar items.
There may also be a drawer
that slides outfrom the
bottom of the console.
Your vehicle may have a
cassettekompact discholder
at the front of the console.
The holderwill store up to
four compact disc cases,
up
to four cassette tape cases,
or any combinationof these
items that adds up to four.
2-55
The cassettekompact disc
holder can be removed and
replaced with a cupholder
that is located in the center
console storagearea.
Armrest Storage Compartment
(If Equipped)
To remove the cassettekompact discholder, pull the
it
front of the holder towardyou and then lift up.
To insert the cupholder,
place it in the console.
Engage the rear tabs first
and then pressthe front
portion in place.
Your vehicle may have a center armrest storage
compartment in the front bench seat.
To open it, fold down the armrestand press the latch
handle located at the front
of the armrest. Then, let the
lid pop up and swingopen.
2-56
The storage compartmenthas a cassettekompact disc
holder. The holder will store up to five compact disc
cases andup to six cassette tape cases.
The storage compartment also has a folding writing
table on top of the armrest lid.
To use the writing table, pull the latch at the rear of the
table and swing the writing table forward. Use it to hold
a pad of paper and a pen.
2-57
Ashtrays and Cigarette Lighter
Rear Ashtray(If Equipped)
Front Ashtray
To use a rear ashtray, if you have them, pull at the top of
the ashtray door to flipthe door open.
The frontashtray is located at the bottom of the
instrument panel. Pull on the notch in the ashtray door
to open it.
To remove a rear ashtray, press down on the inside tabs
and open the door fully.
NOTICE:
NOTICE:
If you store paperor otherthings that burn in
your ashtrays, they could beset on fire by
cigarettes or other smoking materials. Thatcould
cause a fire andpossibly damage yourvehicle. Do
not store papers and other things
that burnin
your ashtrays.
To remove the front ashtray, press the retainer spring
and pivot the ashtray toward you. To replace the ashtray,
place the bottom part of the ashtray on the pivot bar at
the bottom of its mounting on the instrument panel.
Then rotate the ashtray back to its original position.
2-58
~
If you store paperor otherthings that burnin
your ashtrays, they could beset on fire by
cigarettes or othersmoking materials. That could
cause a fire andpossibly damage your vehicle. Do
not store papers and other
things that burnin
your ashtrays.
To use the cigarette lighter, push it in all the way, and let
go. When it's ready, it will pop back by itself.
I NOTICE:
Holding a cigarette lighter in with your hand
while it is heating can makeit overload,
damaging the lighter and the heating element.
Just push the lighterall the way in and letgo.
When it’s done, it will pop back by itself.
Accessory Power Outlets
Two auxiliary power outlets are located near the
cigarette lighter. Use these outletsto power mobile
telephones or other devices designed to operate
with
vehicle electrical systems.
Sun Visors
To block out glare, you can swing downthe visors. You
can also swingthem out to help block glare at the front
and side windows.
Your visor may have a strap to hold small items, such
as maps.
Some visors have an extender on the inside edge. When
the visor is down, pull the extender out for extra glare
coverage at the front or side.
Some visors have mirrors with lamps. If the mirror has
lamps, they will come on when you lift the mirror cover.
2-59
Instrument Panel
2-60
A. Dome Lamp Switch
K. Cupholder
B. Lamp Controls
L. Auxiliary Power Outlets
C. Air Outlets
E. Instrument Cluster
M. Storage Area or Compact Disc Player(If Equipped)
N. Rear Window Defogger Switch(If Equipped)
0. Passenger Air Bag Off Switch (If Equipped)
E GearshiftLever
P. Electronic Transfer Case Switch (If Equipped)
G. Audio System
Q. Tilt Lever (If Equipped)
H. Comfort Control System
I. Glove Box
R. Parking Brake Release
J. Ashtray
T. FuseBlock
D. Multifunction Lever
S. Hood Release
2-61
~
Instrument Panel Cluster
CHECK
SECURITY
GAGES
-
ANTI
LOCK
SERVlCE
ENGINE
SOON
l o l o l o l o 1 TRIP
loo 0 0 oolol
United States version shown, Canada similar
APPLY BRAKE TO SHIFT FROM PARK
4.-
Speedometer and Odometer
Your speedometer lets you see your speed in both miles
per hour (mph) and kilometers per hour (km/h).Your
odometer shows how far your vehicle has been driven,
in either miles (used in the United States) or kilometers
(used in Canada).
Tamper-Resistant Odometer
Your odometer is tamper-resistant. The odometer will
show silver lines between the numbers if someone tries
to turn it back.
You may wonder what happens if your vehicle needs a
new odometer installed. If the new odometer can be set
to the mileage total of the old odometer, then it must be.
But if it can’t, then it’s set at zero, and a labelmust be
put on the driver’s door to show the old mileage reading
when the new odometer was installed.
Trip Odometer
The trip odometer can tell you how far your vehicle has
been driven since you last set the trip odometer to zero.
To reset the trip odometer, fully press the reset button
located near the trip odometer readout.If the reset
button is not fully pressed, the trip odometer may not go
all the way back to zero. If it doesn’t, you may have to
press the reset button again to reset the readout to zero.
Tachometer
Your tachometer displaysthe engine speed in
revolutions per minute (rpm).
NOTICE:
On vehicles with a manual transmission, if you
operate the engine with the tachometer in the red
area, your engine or other parts could be damaged.
Damage to your engineor vehicle caused by
operating the engine in the red area
isn’t covered
by your vehicle warranty. Don’t operate the
engine with the tachometer in the red area.
2-63
Warning Lights, Gages
and Indicators
This part describes the warning lights and gages that
may be on your vehicle. The pictures will help you
locate them.
Warning lights and gages can signal that something is
wrong before it becomes serious enoughto cause an
expensive repair or replacement. Paying attention to
your warning lights andgages could alsosave you or
others from injury.
Warning lights come on when there may be or is a
problem with one of your vehicle’s functions. As you
will see in the detailson the next few pages, some
warning lights come on briefly when you start the
engine just tolet you know they’re working. If you are
familiar with this section, you should not be alarmed
when this happens.
Gages can indicatewhen there may be or is a problem
with one of your vehicle’s functions. Often gages and
warning lights work together to let you know when
there’s a problem with your vehicle.
2-64
When one of the warning lights comes on and stays on
when you are driving, orwhen one of the gages shows
there may be a problem, check the section that tells you
what to do about it. Please follow this manual’s advice.
Waiting to do repairs can becostly -- and even
dangerous. So please get to know your warning lights
and gages. They’re a big help.
Safety Belt Reminder Light
When the key is turned to RUN or START, a tone will
come on for about eightseconds to remind people to
fasten their safety belts, unless the driver’s safety belt is
already buckled.
The safety belt light will
also come on and stay on
for about 20 seconds, then it
will flash for about55
1 seconds. If the driver’s belt
is already buckled, neither
the tone nor the light will
come on.
~
Air Bag Readiness Light
AIR BAG OFF Light (Except Crew Cab)
There is an air bag readiness lighton the instrument panel,
which shows AIR BAG. The system checks the air bag’s
electrical system for malfunctions. The light tells you if
there is an electrical problem. The system check includes
the air bag sensors, the air bag module, the wiring and the
diagnostic module. For more information on the air bag
system, see “Air Bag” in the Index.
When you turn the right front passenger’s air bagoff, this
light will come on and stay on to remind you that the air
bag has been turned off. This light will go off when you
turn the air bag back on again.See “Securing a Child
Restraint in the Right Front Seat Position” in the Index for
more on this, including important safety information.
AIR
BAG
This light will come on
when you start your engine,
and it will flash for a few
seconds. Then the light
should go out. This means
the system is ready.
If the air bag readiness light stays on afteryou start the
engine or comeson when you are driving, your air bag
system may not work properly. Have your vehicle
serviced right away.
The air bag readiness light should flash for a few
seconds when you turn the ignition key to RUN. If the
light doesn’t come on then, have it fixed so it will be
ready to warn you if there is a problem.
2-65
I
A CAUTION:
If the right front
passenger’s air bag is turned
off, an adult or
a child who is no longer an infant
sitting in the right frontpassenger’s position
won’t have the extraprotection of an airbag. In
a crash, the airbag wouldn’t be able to inflate
and help protect the person sitting
there. Make
sure the air
bag is turned on unless you are using
a rear-facing child restraint in the right front
seat position.
1
If the air bag readiness light.ever comes on when
you have turned off the air bag, it means that
i
something may bewrong with the air bag system.
The right frontpassenger’s air bag could inflate
even though the switch Is off. If this ever
happens, don’t secure a rear-facing child
restraint in your vehicle until you have your
l vehicle serviced.
~
C’ arging System Indicator Light
This light should come on
briefly when you turn OR the
ignition, before starting the
engine, as a check to show
you it is working.
2-66
After the engine starts, the light should go out.
If it stays
on or comes on whileyou are driving, you may have a
problem with your charging system. It could indicate a
problem with the generator drive belt, or some other
charging system problem. Haveit checked rightaway.
Driving while this light is on could drain your battery.
If you must drive a short distance with this light on, it
helps to turnoff all your accessories, such as the radio
and the air conditioner.
Tioltmeter
19
When your engineis not
running, but the ignition is
in RUN, this gage shows
your battery’s state of
charge in DC volts.
Readings in the low warning zone
may occur when a
large numberof electrical accessoriesare operating in
the vehicle and the engine is leftanatidle foran
extended period. This conditionis normal since the
charging system is not able to provide full power at
engine idle.As engine speedsare increased, this
condition should correct itself as higher engine speeds
allow the charging system to create maximum
power.
You can only drive fora short timewith the reading in
either warning zone.If you must drive, turnoff all
unnecessary accessories.
Readings in either warning zone indicate a possible
problem in the electrical system. Have the vehicle
serviced as soon as possible.
Brake System Warning Light
When the ignition is on,
the brake system warning light
will come on whenyou set your parking brake. The light
will stay onif your parking brake doesn’t release
fully.
If it stays on after your parking brake is fully released,
it
means you have a brake problem.
Your vehicle’s hydraulic brake system is divided into
When the engineis running, the gage shows the
two parts.If one part isn’t working, the other part can
condition of the charging system. Readings between the still work and stop you. For good braking, though,
you
low and high warning zones indicate the normal
need both parts working well.
operating range.
2-67
If the warning light comes on, there could be a brake
problem. Have your brake system inspected right away.
A CAUTION:
This light should come on
I
BRAKE
briefly when you turn the
ignition key to RUN. If it
doesn’t come on then, have it
fixed so it will be ready to
warn you if there’s a problem.
If the light comes on while you are driving,pull off the
road and stop carefully. You may notice that the pedal is
harder to push. Or, the pedal may go closer to the floor.
It may take longer to stop. If the light is still on, have the
vehicle towed for service. (See “Towing Your Vehicle”
in the Index.)
Your brake system may not be working properly
if the brake system warning lighton.
is Driving
with the brake system warning light on can lead
to an accident. If the lightis still on after you’ve
pulled off the road and stopped carefully, have
the vehicle towedfor service.
Anti-Lock Brake System Warning Light
ANTI LOCK
2-68
With the anti-lock brake
system, this light will
come on when you start
your engineand may stay
on for several seconds.
That’s normal.
If the light stays on,or comeson when you’re driving,
your vehicle needs service. If the regular brake system
warning light isn’t on, you still have brakes, but you
don’t have anti-lock brakes.If the regular brake system
warning light is also on,you don’t have anti-lock brakes
and there’s a problem with your regularbrakes. See
“Brake System Warning Light” earlier in this section.
It also provides an indicator of how hard your vehicleis
working. During a majority of the operation, the gage
will read 2 10°F (100°C) or less. If you are pulling a
load or going up hills, it is normal for the temperature to
fluctuate and approach the 260°F (125 “C) mark. If the
gage reaches the260°F (125°C) mark, it indicates that
the cooling systemis working beyond itscapacity.
The anti-lock brake system warning lightshould come
on briefly when you turn the ignition key to RUN. If the
light doesn’t come on then, have fixed
it
so it will be
ready to warn you if there is a problem,
The “Problems on the Road,” section of this manual shows
what to do. See “Engine Overheating” in the Index.
Engine Coolant Temperature Gage
This gage showsthe engine
coolant temperature.
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (Service
EngineSoon Lig t) ( asolineEngine)
SERVICE
ENGINE
SOON
Your vehicle is equipped
with a computerwhich
monitors operation of the
fuel, ignition and emission
control systems.
2-69
This light willalso come on during a malfunction in one
This system is called OBD
LI (On-Board
of two ways:
Diagnostics-Second Generation) and is intended to
assure that emissions are at acceptable levels for the life0 Light Flashing-- A misfire condition has been
of the vehicle, helpingto produce a cleaner
detected. A misfire increases vehicle emissions and
environment. TheSERVICE ENGINE SOON light
may damage the emission control system on your
comes on to indicate that there is a problem and service vehicle. Dealer or qualified service center diagnosis
is required. Malfunctions often will be indicated by the
and service may be required.
system beforeany problem is apparent. This may
0 Light On Steady-- An emission control system
prevent more serious damage to your vehicle. This
system is also designed to assist your service technician malfunction has been detected on your vehicle.
Dealer or qualified service center diagnosis and
in correctly diagnosing any malfunction.
service may be required.
I NOTICE:
If the LightIs Flashing
The followingmay prevent more serious damage
to
your vehicle:
If you keep driving your vehicle with this light
on, after a while, your emission controls may not
Reducing vehicle speed.
work as well, your fuel economy may
not be as
Avoidinghardaccelerations.
good and your engine may not run as smoothly.
a Avoiding steep uphill grades.
This could leadto costly repairs that
may notbe
covered by your ,warranty.
0 If you are towing a trailer, reduce the amount of
cargo being hauled assoon as it is possible.
This light should come on, as a check to show
it isyou If the light stops flashing and remains on steady,
see “If
working, when the ignition is on and the engine is not the Light Is On Steady” following.
it repaired.
running. If the light doesn’t come on, have
If the light continues to flash, when
it is safe to doso,
stop the vehicle. Find a safe placeto park your vehicle.
2-70
Turn the key off, wait at least 10 seconds and restart the
engine. If the light remainson steady, see “If the Light
Is On Steady” following.If the light is still flashing,
follow the previous steps, and drive the vehicle to your
dealer or qualified service center for service.
If the Light Is On Steady
You may be able to correct
the emission system
malfunction by considering the following:
Did you recently put fuel into your vehicle?
If so, reinstall the fuel cap, making sureto fully install
the cap. The diagnostic system can determine
if the fuel
cap has been left off or improperly installed. A loose or
missing fuel capwill allow fuel to evaporate into the
atmosphere. A few driving tripswith the cap properly
installed should turn the light off.
Did you just drive through a deep puddle
of water?
If so, your electrical systemmay be wet. Thecmdition
will usually be corrected when the electrical system
dries out. A few driving trips should turn the light off.
Are you low on fuel?
As your engine startsto run out of fuel, your engine may
not run as efficiently as designed since small amountsof
air are sucked into the fuel line causingmisfire.
a
The
system can detect this.Adding fuel should correct this
condition. Make sureto install the fuel capproperly. It
will take a few driving tripsto turn the light off.
Have you recently changed brandsof fuel?
If so, be sure to fuelyour vehicle with quality fuel (see
“Fuel” in the Index). Poor fuel quality will cause your
engine not to run as efficiently as designed. You may
notice this as stalling after start-up, stallingwhen you
put the vehicle into gear, misfiring, hesitation on
acceleration or stumbling on acceleration. (These
conditions may go away once the engineis warmed up.)
This will be detected by the system and cause the light
to turn on.
If you experience oneor more of these conditions,
change the fuel brand you use. It will require at least one
full tank of the proper fuel to turn the light off.
If none of the above steps have made the light turn off,
have your dealer or qualified service centercheck the
vehicle. Your dealer has the proper test equipment and
diagnostic tools to fix any mechanicalor electrical
problems that may have developed.
2-71
Oil Pressure Gage
0
?E3
a
80
The oil pressuregage shows
the engine oil pressure in psi
(pounds per square inch)
when the engine is running.
Canadian vehicles indicate
pressure inkPa (kilopascals).
Oil pressure may vary with engine speed, outside
temperature and oil viscosity, but readings above the
low pressure zone indicate thenormal operating range.
A reading in the low pressure zone may be caused by a
dangerously low oil levelor some other problem causing
low oil pressure. Check youroil as soon as possible.
CAI,'"ION:
Don't keep driving if the oil pressure is low. If
you do, your engine can become so hot that it
catches fire. You or others could be burned.
Check your oil as soon as possible and have your
vehicle serviced.
I NOTICE:
1
Damage to yourengine from neglected oilproblems
can be costly
and is not covered by your warranty.
Up Shift Light(If Equipped)
Security Light
This light is used on
some models with
manual transmissions.
This light will come on
briefly when you turn the
key to START.
SHIFT
The light will stay on until the engine starts.If the light
flashes, the Passlock@ System
has entered a tamper
mode. If the vehicle failsto start, see “Passlock” in
the Index.
The SHIFT indicator lightwill help you get the best fuel
economy. See “Shift Light” or “Shift Speeds” in this
section for more information.
If the light comeson continuously while driving and
stays on, there may be a problem with the Passlock
System. Your vehicle will not be protected by Passlock,
and you should see your GM dealer.
2-73
:::o
Daytime Running Lamps Indicator Light
Check Gages Light
This light goes on whenever
the DRL are on.
e..
When it begins to get dark, the DRL indicatorlight is a
reminder to turn on your headlamps.
2-74
CHECK
GAGES
This light will come on
briefly when you are
starting the engine.
If the light comes on and stays on while you are driving,
it could indicate a problem with your vehicle. It could be
a problem with your oil pressure, coolant temperature,
or some otherproblem, Check your various gages to see
if they are in the warning zones. If they are, have your
vehicle serviced right away.
Fuel Gage
The fuel gage,when the
ignition is on, tells you
about how much fuel you
have left in your tank.
Here are four situationsyou may experience with your
fuel gage. None of these indicate a problem with the
fuel gage.
At the gas station, the fuel pump shuts off before the
gage reads FULL (F).
It takes a little more or less fuel to fill up than the
fuel gage indicated.For example, the gage may have
indicated the tank was half full, but it actually took a
little more or less than half the tank’s capacity to fill
the tank.
The gage moves a little when you turn a corner or
speed up.
The gage will first indicate EMPTY(E) before you
are out of fuel, andyou should get more fuel assoon
as possible.
The gage doesn’t go back to EMPTY (E) when you
turn off the ignition.
If you have a diesel engine, see “FuelGage” in the
Diesel Engine Supplement.
2-75
~6%) NOTES
2-76
Section 3 Comfort Controls and Audio Systems
In this section, you’ll find out how to operate the comfort control and audio systemsoffered with your vehicle. Be
sure to read about the particular systems suppliedwith your vehicle.
3-2
3-4
3-5
3-5
3-6
3-6
3-7
3-7
3-7
3-8
3-9
3-12
Comfort Controls
Air Conditioning
Heating
Ventilation System
Defogging and Defrosting
Rear Window Defogger (If Equipped)
Audio Systems
Setting the Clock
AM-FM Stereo Radio
Playing the Radio
AM-FM Stereo with Cassette Tape Player
(If Equipped)
AM-FM Stereo with Cassette Tape and
Automatic Tone Control (If Equipped)
3-15
3-16
3-20
3-2 1
3-23
3-24
3-25
3-26
3-26
3-26
CD Adapter Kit
AM-FM Stereo with Compact Disc Player and
Automatic Tone Control (If Equipped)
Remote Compact Disc Player (If Equipped)
Theft-Deterrent Feature
Understanding RadioReception
Tips About Your Audio System
Care of Your Cassette Tape Player
Care of Your Compact Discs
Care of Your Compact Disc Player
Fixed Mast Antenna
3-1
Comfort Controls
Heater Control System
Temperature Knob
The middleknob on the control panel letsyou select the
relative temperatureof the air flowing into the passenger
area of your vehicle. Thisknob will allow you to adjust
the relative air temperature independentlyof the
function knobsetting. Move the knobto the right,
toward the red area for warmerair. Move the knob to the
left, towardthe blue area for coolerair.
Mode Knob
The right knob on the control panelallows you to
choose the directionof air delivery. The controlknob
can be placed in any position between twomode settings
to blend the flow of air.
+e
Fan Knob
The knobon the left side of the heating system control
panel controls the fan speed. The knobhas four speed
positions. To increase airflow, move the knob toward
HI. To decrease airflow, move it toward LO. To turn the
fan off, move the knob to OFF.
3-2
/II
VENT This setting directs air through the
instrument panel outlets.
-be
+#
VENT/HEAT Use this setting to divide airflow
between the floor outlets and instrument panel outlets.
HEATER: This setting directsair through the
floor outlets.
+’
w.
DEFOG: This setting directs air to the heater
outlets and toward the windshield.
9 DEFROST This setting directs air toward
the windshield.
Heater and Air Conditioning Control
System (If Equipped)
Fan Knob
The knob on the left side of the heating system control
panel controls the fan speed. The knobhas four speed
positions. To increase airflow, move the knob toward
HI. To decrease airflow, move it toward LO. To turn the
fan off, move the knob to OFF. If you have the air
conditioner on, moving the fan knob toOFF also turns
off the A/C compressor.
While driving with the fan knob in OFF, ram airflow
will vent to the floor outlets.The mode knob will not
redirect ram airflow to other selected outlet positions.
This is a normal operation forthe OFF position.
Temperature Knob
The middle knob on the control panel lets you select the
relative temperature of the air flowing intothe passenger
area of your vehicle. This knob will allow you to adjust
the relative air temperature independently of the
function knob setting. Movethe knob to the right,
toward the red area for warmer air. Move the knob to the
left, toward the blue area for cooler air.
3-3
Mode Knob
The right knob on the control panel allows you to
choose the direction of air delivery. The control knob
can be placed in any position between two mode settings
to blendthe flow of air.
+e
/.I
VENT This setting directs air through the
instrument panel outlets.
+’
+a
+’,
VENTLHEAT Use this setting to divide airflow
between the floor outlets and instrument panel outlets.
HEATER: This setting directs air through the
heater floor outlets.
w.
?pd DEFOG: This setting directs air to the heater
outlets and toward the windshield.
9 DEFROST This setting directs air toward the
windshield.
Air Conditioning
On hot days, open the windows long enoughto let hot
air inside escape. This reduces the time it takes for your
vehicle to cool down. Then keepyour windows closed
for the air conditioner to work its best.
3-4
The recirculation button, between the fan and
temperature knobs, allows the air inside your vehicle to
be recirculated. This setting helps to maximize your air
conditioner’s performance and your vehicle’s fuel
economy. This setting also coolsthe air the fastest and
can be used to keep unwanted odors and/or dust from
entering the vehicle. When using the air conditioner,
turn off recirculation after the vehicle reaches a
comfortable interior temperature. When the right knob
on the control panel is between HEATER and
DEFROST, the recirculation feature will not function.
The A/C button, between the temperature and mode
knobs, allows the air coming intoyour vehicle to be
cooled. This setting is useful for normal cooling on hot
days. When you use A/C with the recirculation button
pushed in, turn off recirculation as soon as the vehicle
reaches a comfortableinterior temperature.
With the A/C on, move the temperature knob to MAX
for maximum cooling. Thissetting also puts the system
in the recirculation mode and helps to maximize your air
conditioner’s performance and your vehicle’s fuel
economy. This setting also cools the air the fastest. After
the vehicle’s interior reaches a comfortable temperature,
move the temperature knob to the right, to place the air
conditioning system in the normal mode.
Heating
The heater works bestif you keepyour windows closed
while usingit. On cold days, use the
HEATER or
VENT/HEAT setting with the temperatureknob in the
red area.
Outside air will also enter the vehicle when the heater
the air conditioning fan is running, unless
you have the
recirculation button pushed in. For more information o
the recirculation button, see “Air Conditioning” earlier
in this section.
If you use the engine coolant heater before starting your
engine in cold weather, 20°F (-8 O C) or lower, your
heating system will produce warmer air faster, to heat
the passenger compartment in cold
weather.
The useof an engine coolant heater also reduces the
time it takes for the engine
to reach normal operating
temperature, and shortens the time it takes the heater to
reach full output. For more information, see “Engine
Coolant Heater” in the Index.
Ventilation System
For mild outside temperatures when little heating or
cooling is needed, use VENT to direct outside air
through your vehicle. Air will flow through the
instrument panel outlets.
Your vehicle’s ventilation system supplies outsideair to
the inside of your vehicle whenit is moving. With the side
windows closed, air will flow into the front air inlet grilles,
through the vehicle,and out the air exhaust valves.
Your vehicle has air outlets in the center and on the sid
of your instrument panel.You can move the outlets from
side-to-side or up and down to direct the flow
of air, or
close the outlets altogether. When
you close an outlet, it
will increase the flow
of air coming outof any outlets
that are open. These outlets
do not completely shutoff
airflow whenin the closed position.
Ventilation Tips
0
Keep the hood and front air inlet free of ice, snow or
any other obstruction (such as leaves). Theheater
and defroster will work far better, reducing the
chance of fogging the inside of your windows.
0
When you enter a vehicle in cold weather, turn the
blower fan to HI for a few moments before driving.
This helps clear the intake ducts of snow and
moisture, and reduces the chance of fogging the
inside of your windows,
0
Keep the air path under the front seats clearof
objects. Thishelps air to circulate throughout
your vehicle.
0
The use of hood air deflectors may adversely
affect the performance of the heating and air
conditioning system.
Defogging and Defrosting
On cool, humid days, use DEFOG to keepthe
windshield and side windows clear. Use DEFROST to
remove fog or icefrom the windshield in extremely
humid or cold conditions. Use DEFROST with the
temperature knob toward the red area and the fan control
toward HI.
3-6
Rear Window Defogger (If Equipped)
If you see lines running across the rear window, you
have a rear window defogger. The lines warm the glass.
To turn on the rear window
defogger, press this button
next to the fan control knob.
The rear window defogger
will only work if the
ignition switch is turned to
RUN. For best results, clear
the window of as much
snow or ice as possible first.
The defogger will shut itself off after several minutes. If
you need additional warming time, press the button
again. You can turn the defogger off at any time by
pressing the button.
Do not attach a temporary vehicle license, tape or decals
across the defogger grid on the rear window.
NOTICE:
Don’t usea razor bladeor something else sharp
on the insideof the rear window.If you do, you
could cutor damage the warming grid, and the
repairs wouldn’t be covered by your warranty.
Audio Systems
Your Delco Electronics audio systemhas been designed
to operate easily and give years of listening pleasure.
You will get the most enjoyment out of it if you acquaint
yourself with it first. Find out what your Delco
Electronics system cando and how to operate all its
controls, to be sure you’re getting the most out of the
advanced engineering that went into it.
Setting the Clock for Systems with
Automatic Tone Control
Press and hold HR until the correct hour appears on the
display. Press and hold MN until the correct minute
appears on the display. To display the clock with the
ignition off, press RECALL or HR/MN and the time
will be displayed for a few seconds. Thereis an initial
two-second delay before the clock goes intothe
time-set mode.
AM-FM Stereo
Setting the Clock for Systems without
Automatic Tone Control
Press SET. Within five seconds, press and hold the
SEEK right arrow until the correct minute appears on
the display. Press and hold the SEEK left arrow until the
correct hour appearson the display.
3-7
Playing the Radio
VOLUME: This knob turns the systemon and off and
controls the volume. To increase volume and turn the
radio on, turn the knob to the right. Turn it to the left to
decrease volume.
RECALL: Display the time with the ignition off by
pressing the recall knob. When the radio is playing,
press this knob to recall the station frequency.
Finding a Station
AM-FM: Press the lower knob to switch between AM
and FM. The display shows yourselection.
TUNE: Turn the lower knob to tune in radio stations.
SEEK: Press the right arrow to tune to the next higher
station and the left arrow to tune to the next lower
station and stay there.
SCAN: Press both SEEK buttons to listen to a few
seconds of each radio station. SCAN will light up on
the display. Press the right arrow to tune in the next
higher station and press the left arrow to tune to the next
lower station. Press VOLUME or both SEEK buttons to
stop scanning.
3-8
PUSHBUTTONS: The fournumbered pushbuttons let
you return to your favorite stations. You can set up to
14 stations (seven AM and seven FM). Just:
1. Turn the radio on.
2. Press AM-FM to select the band.
3. Tune in the desired station.
4. Press SET. (SET will appear on the display.)
5. Press and hold one of the four pushbuttons within
five seconds.Whenever you press that numbered
button, the station you set will return.
6. Repeat the steps for each pushbutton.
In addition to the four stations already set,up to three
more stations may be preset on each band by pressing
two adjoining buttons at the same time. Just:
1. Tune in the desired station.
2. Press SET. (SET will appear on the display.)
3 . Press two adjoining buttons at-thesame time, within
five seconds.Whenever you press the same two
buttons, the station you set will return.
4. Repeat the steps for each pair of pushbuttons.
Setting theTone
BASS: Slide this leverup or down to increase or
decrease bass.
AM-FM Stereo with CassetteTape Player
(If Equipped)
TREB: Slide this leverup or down to increase or
decrease treble. If a station is weak or noisy, you may
want to decrease the treble.
Adjusting the Speakers
BAL: Turn the control behind the upper knob to move
the sound to the left or right speakers. Themiddle
position balances thesound between the speakers.
FADE: Turn the control behind the lower knob to move
the sound to the front or rear speakers. The middle
position balances the sound between the speakers.
Playing the Radio
VOLUME: This knob turns the system on and off and
controls the volume. To increase volume and turn the
radio on, turn the knob to the right. Turn it to the left to
decrease volume.
RECALL: Display the time with the ignition off by
pressing this knob.When the radio is playing, press this
knob to recall the station frequency.
3-9
Finding a Station
AM-FM: Press the lower knob to switch between AM,
FMl and FM2.
TUNE: Turn the lower knob to tune in radio stations.
SEEK: Press the right arrow to tune to the next higher
station and the left arrow to tune to the next lower
station and stay there.
PUSHBUTTONS:The four numbered pushbuttons let
you return to your favorite stations. You can set up to
21 stations (seven AM, seven FM1 and seven FM2). Just:
1. Turn the radio on.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Press AM-FM to select the band.
Tune in the desired station.
Press SET. (SET will appear on the display.)
Press and hold one of the four pushbuttons within
five seconds. Whenever you press that numbered
button, the station you set will return.
6. Repeat the steps for each pushbutton.
3-10
In addition to the four stations already set, up to three
more stations may be preset on each band by pressing
two adjoiningbuttons at the same time. Just:
1. Tune in the desired station.
2. Press SET. (SET will appear on the display.)
3. Press two adjoining buttons at the same time, within
five seconds. Whenever you press the same two
buttons, the station you set will return.
4. Repeat the steps for each pair of pushbuttons.
P.SCAN: Press both SEEK buttons to scan through each
of your preset stations. The system will scan through
and play each preset station stored on your pushbuttons
for a fewseconds. Press either SEEK button or
RECALL to stop scanning through the preset stations.
Setting theTone
BASS: Slide this lever up or down to increase or
decrease bass.
Once the tape is playing, use the knobs for VOLUME,
BAL FADE, BASS and TREBjust as you do for
the radio.
TREB: Slide this lever up or down to increase or
decrease treble. If a station is weak or noisy, you may
want to decrease the treble.
REV Press the SEEK left arrow to reverse the cassette
tape. Press the SEEKright arrow to stop reversing
the tape.
Adjusting the Speakers
FWD: Press the SEEK right arrow to advance the
cassette tape. Press the SEEK left arrow to stop
forwarding thetape.
BAL: Turn the control behind the upper knob to move
the sound to the left or right speakers. The middle
position balances the soundbetween the speakers.
FADE: Turn the control behind the lower knob to move
the sound to the front or rear speakers. The middle
position balances the sound between the speakers.
Playing a Cassette Tape
Your tape player is built to work best with tapes that are
30 to 45 minutes long on each side. Tapes longer than
that are so thin they may not work well in this player.
RECALL: Press this knob toswitch tape sides.
EJECT: Press this button to remove the tape or stop the
tape and play the radio.
CLN: If this message appearson the display, the
cassette tape player needs to be cleaned. It will still play
tapes, but you should clean it as soon as possible to
prevent damage to the tapes and player. See “Care of
Your Cassette Tape Player” in the Index. After you clean
the player, press and hold EJECT for five secondsto
reset the CLN indicator. The radio will display --- to
show the indicator was reset.
3-11
~~
AM-FM Stereo with Cassette Tape and
Automr ic Tone Control (If Equipped)
.~
SCV: Your system has a feature called
Speed-Compensated-Volume (SCV). With SCV, your
audio system adjusts automatically to makeup for road
and wind noise as you drive. Set the volume at the
desired level. Move the control ring behind the upper
knob to the right to adjust the SCV. Then, as you drive,
SCV automatically increases the volume, as necessary,
to overcome noise at any particular speed. Thevolume
level should always sound the same to you as you drive.
If you don’t want to use SCV, turn the control all the
way down. Each notch on the control ring allows for
more volume compensation at faster vehicle speeds.
Finding a Station
Playing the Radio
AM-FM: Press this button to switch between AM, FM1
and FM2. The display will show your selection.
PWR-VOL: Press this knob to turn the system on and
off. To increase volume, turn the knob tothe right. Turn
it to the left todecrease volume. The knob is capableof
being rotated continuously.
TUNE: Press this knob lightly so it extends. Turn it to
choose radio stations. Push the knob back into its stored
position when you’re not using it.
RECALL: Display the time with the ignition off by
pressing this button. When the radio isplaying, press
this button to recall the station frequency.
3-12
SEEK: Press the right arrowto tune to the next higher
station and the left arrowto tune to the next lower station
and stay there. The sound will mute while seeking.
SCAN: Press and hold SEEK for two seconds until
SCAN appears on the display. SCAN allows you to
listen to stations for a few seconds. The receiver will
continue to scan and momentarily stop at each station
until you press the button again. The sound will mute
while scanning.
PUSHBUTTONS: The six numbered pushbuttons let
you return to your favorite stations. You can set up to
18 stations (six AM, six FM1 and six FM2). Just:
1. Turn the radio on.
2. Press AM-FM to select the band.
3. Tune in the desired station.
4. Press AUTO TONE to select the setting you prefer.
5. Press and hold one of the six pushbuttons. The sound
will mute. When it returns, release the button.
Whenever you press that numbered button, the
station you set will return and the tone you selected
will be automatically selected forthat button.
6. Repeat the steps for each pushbutton.
P. SCAN: The preset scanbutton lets you scan through
your favorite stations stored on your pushbuttons. Select
either the AM, FM1 or FM2mode and then press
P. SCAN. It will scan through each station stored on
your pushbuttons and stop for afew seconds before
continuing to scan through all of the pushbuttons. Press
P. SCAN again or oneof the pushbuttons to stop
scanning to listen to a specific preset station. P. SCAN
will light up on the display while in this mode. If one of
the stations stored on a pushbutton is too weak for the
location you are in, the radio display will show the
channel number (P 1-P6) for several seconds before
advancing to the next preset station.
Setting the Tone
BASS: Press lightly on this knob to release it from its
stored position. Turn the knobto the right to increase bass
and to the left to decrease bass. When the BASS controlis
rotated, the AUTO TONE display will go blank.
TREB: Press lightly on this knob to release it from its
stored position. Turn the knob to the right to increase
treble and to the left to decrease treble.When the TREB
control is rotated, the AUTO TONE display will go
blank. If a station is weak or noisy, you may want to
decrease the treble.
Push these knobs back into their stored positions when
you’re not using them.
AUTO TONE: Press this button to select amongthe six
preset equalization settings and tailor the sound to the
music or voice being heard. Each time you press the
button, the selection will switch to one of the preset
3-13
settings of CLASSIC, NEWS, ROCK, POP, C N
(CountryNestern) or JAZZ.To return to the manual
mode, press and release this button until the AUTO
TONE display goes blank. This will return the tone
adjustment to the BASS and TREB controls.If a
BASS or TREB control is rotated, the AUTO TONE
display will go blank. Use PUSHBUTTONS to program
AUTO TONE.
Adjusting the Speakers
BAL: Press lightly on this knob to release it from its
stored position. Turn the control to the right to adjust
sound to the right speakers and to the left to adjust
sound to the left speakers. The middle position balances
the sound between the speakers.
FADE: Press lightly on this knob to release it from its
stored position. Turn the control to the right to adjust the
sound to the front speakers and to the left for the rear
speakers. The middle position balances the sound
between the speakers.
Push these knobs back into their stored positions when
you’re not using them.
Playing aCassette Tape
Your tape player is built to work best with tapes that are
30 to 45 minutes long on each side. Tapes longer than
that are so thin they may not work well in this player.
3-14
To load a cassette tape with the ignition off, press
EJECT or RECALL. Then, insert the cassette tape.
If the ignition is on but the radio is off, the tape will
begin playing.
Once the tape is playing, use the VOL, AUTO TONE,
BAL, FADE, BASS and TREB controls just asyou do
for the radio. The tape symbol and a direction arrow will
be on the display whenever a tape is being played.
Anytime a tape is inserted, the top side is selected for
play first.
The player automatically senses if the cassette tape is
metal or Cr02 and adjusts for best playback sound.
For metal tapes, the double-D symbol will appear on
the display.
PREV (1): Press the PREV button or the SEEK left
arrow to search for the previous selection. A minimum
three-second blank gap is required for the player to stop
at the beginning of the selection. The tape direction
arrow will blink during the SEEK operation.
PROG (2): Press this button to switch from one side of
the tape to the other.
NEXT (3): Press the NEXT button or the SEEK right
arrow to search for the next selection. A minimum
three-second blank gap is required for the player to stop
at the beginning of the selection. The tape direction
arrow will blink during the SEEK operation. The sound
will mute while searching for the next selection.
REV (4): Press this button to rapidly reverse the tape to
the beginning of the cassette or until you press REV
again. The radiowill play the last selected station while
reversing the tape. The tape direction arrow will blink
during the reverse operation.
00 (5): Press this button to reduce cassettetape noise.
The double-D symbol will appear on the display while
the player is in this mode.
Dolby Noise Reduction is manufactured under a license
from Dolby Laboratories Licensing Corporation.Dolby
and the double-D symbol are trademarksof Dolby
Laboratories Licensing Corporation.
FWD (6): Press this button to rapidly forward the tape
to the end of the cassette or until you press FWD again.
The radio will play the last selected station while
forwarding the tape. The tape direction arrow will blink
during the forward operation.
AM-FM: Press this button to switch from a tape to
the radio.
TAPE AUX: Press this button to return to the tape
player when playing the radio. The lighted arrow will
appear and show the direction of play when a tape is in
the active mode.
EJECT Press this button to remove the tape. The
radio will now play. EJECT can be used with either the
ignition or radio off. To load a cassette tape with
the ignition or radio off, press EJECT before loading
the cassette.
CLN: If this message appears on the display, the
cassette tape player needs to be cleaned. It will still play
tapes, but you should clean it assoon as possible to
prevent damage to the tapes and player. See “Care of
Your Cassette Tape Player” in the Index. After you clean
the player, press and hold EJECT for five seconds
to
reset the CLN indicator. The radio will display --- to
show the indicator was reset.
CD Adapter Kits
It is possible to use a CD adapter kit with your cassette
tape player after activatingthe bypass feature on your
tape player.
To activate the bypass feature, use the following steps:
1. Turn the ignition to RUN or ACCESSORY.
2. Turn your radio off.
3. Press and hold the TAPE AUX button for five
seconds. The tape symbol on the display will flash
for two seconds, indicating that the feature is active.
4. Insert the adapter. It will power up the radio and
begin playing.
This override routinewill remain active until EJECT
is pressed.
3-15
AM -FM Stereo with Compact Disc Player
and Automatic Tone Control (If Equipped)
and wind noise as you drive. Set the volume at the
desired level. Move the control ring behind the upper
knob to the right to adjust the SCV. Then, as you drive,
SCV automatically increases the volume, as necessary,
to overcome noise at any particular speed. The volume
level should always sound the same to you as you drive.
If you don’t want to use SCV, turn the control all the
way down. Each notch on the control ring allows for
more volume compensation at faster vehicle speeds.
Finding a Station
AM-FM: Press this button to switch between AM, FMl
and FM2. The display will show your selection.
TUNE: Press this knob lightly so it extends. Turn it to
Playing the Radio
PWR-VOI,: Press this knob to turn the system on and
off. To increase volume, turn this knob tothe right. Turn
it to the left to decrease volume. The knob is capable of
rotating continuously.
RECALL: Display the time with the ignition off by
pressing this button. When the radio is playing, press
this button to recall the station frequency.
SCV: Your system has a feature called
Speed-Compensated-Volume (SCV). With SCV, your
audio system adjusts automatically to make up for road
choose radio stations. Push the knob back into its stored
position when you’re not using it.
SEEK: Press the right arrowto tune to the next higher
station and the left arrow to tune to the next lower station
and stay there. The sound will mute while seeking.
SCAN: Press and hold SEEK for two seconds until
SCAN appears on the display. SCAN allows you to
listen to stations for a few seconds. The
receiver will
continue to scan and momentarily stop at each station
until you press the button again. The sound will mute
while scanning.
PUSHBUTTONS: The six numbered pushbuttons let
you return to your favorite stations. You can set up to
18 stations (six AM,six FM 1 and six FM2). Just:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Turn the radio on.
Press AM-FM to select the band.
Tune in the desired station.
Press AUTO TONE to select the setting you prefer.
Press and hold one of the six pushbuttons. The sound
will mute, Whenit returns, release the button.
Whenever you press that numbered button,the
station you set will return and the tone you selected
will be automatically selected forthat button.
6. Repeat the steps for each pushbutton.
P.SCAN: The preset scan button lets you scan through
your favorite stations stored on your pushbuttons. Select
either the AM, FMl or FM2 mode and then press
P.SCAN. It will scan through each station stored on your
pushbuttons and stopfor a few seconds before continuing
to scan through all of the pushbuttons. PressP.SCAN
again or one of the pushbuttons to stop scanning to listen
to a specific stored station. P.SCAN will light up on the
display while in this mode. If one of the stations stored on
a pushbutton is too weak for the location you are in, the
radio display will show the channel number(Pl-P6) for
several seconds before advancing to the next preset station.
Setting theTone
BASS: Press lightly on this knob to release it from its
stored position. Turn the knob to the right to increase bass
and to the left todecrease bass. When the BASS control is
rotated, the AUTO TONEi display will go blank.
TREB: Press lightly on this knob to release it from its
stored position. Turn the knob to the right to increase
treble and to the left to decrease treble.When the TREB
control is rotated, the AUTO TONE display will go
blank. If a station isweak or noisy, you may want to
decrease the treble.
Push these knobs back into their storedpositions when
you’re not using them.
AUTO TONE: Press this button to select among the
six preset equalization settingsand tailor the sound to
the music or voice being heard. Each time you press the
button, the selection will switch to one of the preset
settings of CLASSIC, NEWS,ROCK, POP, CM’
(CountryNestern) or JAZZ.To return to the manual
mode, press and release this button until the AUTO
TONE display goesblank. This will return the tone
adjustment to the BASS and TREB controls. If a BASS
or TREB controlis rotated, the AUTO TONE display
will go blank. Use PUSHBUTTONS to program
AUTO TONE.
3-17
Adjusting the Speakers
BAL: Press lightly on this knob to release it from its
stored position. Turn the control to the right to adjust
sound to the right speakers and to the left to adjust
sound to the left speakers. The middle position balances
the sound between the speakers.
FADE: Press lightly on this knob to release it from its
stored position. Turn the control to the right to adjust the
sound to the front speakers and to the left for the rear
speakers. The middle position balances the sound
between the speakers.
Push these knobs back into their stored positions when
you’re not using them.
Playing a Compact Disc
PWR: Press this knob to turn the system on. (Please note
that you can also turn the systemon when you insert a
compact disc into the player with the ignition on.)
Insert a disc partway into the slot, label side up. The
player will pull it in. Wait a few seconds and the disc
should play. CD and a CD symbolwill also appear on
the display. Anytime you are playing a CD, the letters
CD will be next to the CD symbol.
3-18
If the disc comes back out and ERR appears on the
display, it could be that:
0
You are driving on a very rough road. (The disc
should play when the road gets smoother.)
The disc is upside down.
It is dirty, scratched or wet.
0
It is very humid. (If so, wait about an hour and
try again.)
The disc player is very hot.
Press RECALL to make ERR go off the display.
PREV (1): Press PREV or the SEEK left arrow to
search for the previous selection. If you hold this button
or press it more than once, the disc will advance further.
Sound is muted in this mode.
RDM (2): Press this button to play the tracks on the disc
in random order. While in the RDM mode, RANDOM
appears on the display. Press RDM again to return to
normal play.
NEXT (3): Press NEXT or the SEEK right arrow to
search for the next selection. If you hold this button or
press it more than once, the discwill advance further.
The next track number will appear on the display. Sound
is muted in this mode.
REV (4): Press and hold REV to return rapidly to a
favorite passage. You will hear the disc selection play at
high speed while you press the REV button. This allows
you to listen and find out when the disc is at the desired
selection. Release REV to resume playing.
FWD (6): Press and hold this button to advan& rapidly
within a track. You will hear the disc selection play at
high speed while you press the FWD button. This allows
you to listen and find out when the disc is at the desired
selection. Release FWD to resume playing.
RECALL: Press this button to see what track is playing.
Press it again within five seconds to see how long the
CD has been playing that track. Elapsed time is
displayed in minutes and tenths of a second. Thetrack
number will also appear when a new track begins to
play. Press RECALL again to return to the time display.
AM-FM: While in the CD mode, press this button to
stop playing the CD and play the radio. The CD symbol
will still display but the word CD will be replaced with
either AM, F M 1 or FM2. (If the radio is turned off, the
disc stays in the player and will resume playing at the
point where it stopped.)
CD AUX: To switch between the player and the radio
when a disc is playing, press the AM-FM button. To
return to the player, press CD AUX. When a disc is
playing, the letters CD and the CD symbol will appear
on the display. (If the radio is turned off, the disc stays
in the player and will resume playing at the point where
it stopped.)
EJECT Press this button to eject the disc from the
player and play the radio. When the same or a new disc
is inserted, the disc will start playing on track one. If a
compact disc is left sitting in the opening for more than
a few seconds, the player will pull the CD back in. The
radio will continue playing. When the ignition is off,
press this button to load a CD.
3-19
Remote Compact Disc Player(If Equipped)
To remove the disc, press the EJECT button and remove
the disc fromthe player.
All of the compact disc functions arecontrolled by the
radio buttons except for EJECT. When a disc is in the
player, a CD symbol will appear on the display. When a
disc is playing, the letters CD will appear next to the CD
symbol in the bottom left corner. The track number will
also be displayed.
If you have this option, you can play one compactdisc
(CD) at a time.
To load a CD into the player, hold the disc with the label
side upand insert it carefully into theplayer
(approximately halfway). The disc will automatically be
pulled into the player. If the radio is off and the ignition
is on when a CD is inserted,the radio will turn on and
begin playing the CD. It is possible to load and unload
CDs with the ignition off. To load a disc with the
ignition off, press the EJECT button on the remote
player and then insert the disc. To remove the disc, press
the EJECT button and remove the disc fromthe player.
A disc that has been ejected but is still sitting in the
remote CD player will be pulled back into the player
after approximately 30 seconds. This protects the disc
and player from damage. The disc will not start playing.
3-20
If the disc comes back out and ERR appears on the
display, it could be that:
The disc is upside down.
It is dirty, scratched or wet.
There’s too much moisture in the air. (Wait about an
hour and try again.)
You are driving on a very rough road.
Please contact your dealership if any error recurs or
cannot be corrected.
PREV (1): Press this button togo back to the start of the
current track if more than eight seconds have played. Press
PREV again to go to the previous track on the disc.
NEXT (3): Press this button to advance to the next track
on the disc.
REV (4): Press and hold this button to quickly reverse
within a track. As the CD reverses, elapsed timewill be
displayed to help you find the correct passage.
FWD (6): Press and hold this button to quickly advance
within a track. As the CD advances, elapsedtime will be
displayed to helpyou find the correct passage.
SEEK: Press the left arrow while playing a CD to go
back to the start of the current track.It will go back to
the current track if more than eight seconds haveplayed.
Press the left arrow again to go to previous tracks.Press
the right arrow to go to the next higher track on the disc.
RANDOM: Press P.SCAN to enter the random play
mode. RANDOMwill appear on thedisplay. While in
this mode, the tracks on the discs will be played in
random order. If you press SEEK, PREV or NEXT
while in the random mode, the previous or next track
will be scanned randomly. Press P.SCAN again to turn
off RANDOM and return to normal operation.
RECALL: Press this button to see what track is
currently playing. Press RECALL againwithin five
seconds to see how long the track has been playing.
When a new track starts to play, the track number will
also appear. Press RECALL athird time and the time of
day will be displayed.
TAPE AUX:With a disc loaded in the player and the
radio playing, press this button once to play the compact
disc. To return to playing the radio, press AM-FM. If
both a cassette tapeand CD are loaded, press TAPE
AUX to switch between the tape and compact disc.
EJECT Press this button on the remote player to eject a
compact disc.
Theft-Deterrent Feature(If Equipped)
THEFTLOCK@is designed to discourage theft of your
radio. It works by using a secret codeto disable all radio
functions whenever battery power is removed.
The THEFTLOCK feature forthe radio may be used or
ignored. If ignored, the system plays normally and the
radio is not protected by the feature. If THEFTLOCK is
activated, your radio will not operate if stolen.
When THEFTLOCK is activated, the radio will display
LOC to indicate a locked condition anytime battery
power has been interrupted. If your battery loses power
for any reason, you must unlock the radio with the secret
code before it will operate.
3-21
Activating the Theft-Deterrent Feature
The instructions which follow explain how to enter your
secret code to activate the THEFTLOCK system.It is
recommended that you read through all nine steps
before starting the procedure.
NOTE: If you allow more than 15 seconds to elapse
between any steps, the radio automatically reverts to
time and you must start the procedure over at Step 4.
1. Write down any three or four-digit number from
000 to 1999 and keep it in a safe place separate from
the vehicle.
2. Turn the ignition to ACCESSORY or RUN.
3. Turn the radio off.
4. Press the 1 and 4 buttons together. Hold them down
until --- shows on the display. Next you will use the
secret codenumber which you have written down.
8. Press AM-FM after you have confirmed that the
code matches the secret code you have written down.
The display will show REP to let you know that you
need to repeat Steps 5 through 7 to confirm your
secret code.
9. Press AM-FM and this time the display will show
SEC to let you know that your radio is secure. The
indicator by the volume control will begin flashing
when the ignition is turned off.
Unlocking the Theft-Deterrent Feature After a
Power Loss
Enter your secret code as follows; pause no more than
15 seconds between steps:
1. LOC appears when the ignition is on.
2. Press MN and 000 will appear on the display.
5. Press MN and 000 will appear on the display.
3. Press MN again to make the last two digits agree
with your code.
6. Press MN again to make the last two digits agree
with your code.
4. Press HR to make the first one or two digits agree
with your code.
Press HR to make the first one or two digits agree
with your code.
3-22
5 . Press AM-FM after you have confirmed that the
code matches the secret code you have written down.
The display will show SEC, indicating the radio is
now operable and secure.
If you enter the wrong coae eight times, INOPwill
appear on the display. You will have to wait an hour
with the ignition on before you can try again. When you
try again, you will only have three chances to enter the
correct code before INOP appears.
If you lose or forget your code, contact your dealer.
Disabling the Theft-Deterrent Feature
Enter your secret code as follows; pause no more than
15 seconds between steps:
If the code entered is incorrect, SEC will appear on the
display. The radio will remain secured until the correct
code is entered.
When battery power is removed and later applied to a
secured radio, the radio won’t turn on and LOC will
appear on the display.
To unlock a secured radio, see “Unlocking the
Theft-Deterrent Feature After a Power Loss” earlier
in this section.
1. Turn the ignition to ACCESSORY or RUN.
Understanding Radio Reception
2. Turn the radio off.
AM
3. Press the 1 and 4 buttons together. Hold them down
until SEC shows on the display.
The range for most AM stations is greater than for FM,
especially at night. The longer range, however, can
cause stations to interfere with each other. AM can pick
up noise from things like storms and power lines. Try
reducing the treble to reduce this noise if you ever get it.
4. Press MN and 000 will appear on the display.
5 . Press MN again to make the last two digits agree
with your code.
6. Press HR to make the first one or twodigits agree
with your code.
7. Press AM-FM after you have confirmed that the
code matches the secret code you have written down.
The display will show ---, indicating that the radio
is no longer secured.
FM Stereo
FM stereo will give you the best sound, but FM signals
will reach only about 10 to 40 miles (16 to 65 km). Tall
buildings or hills can interfere with FM signals, causing
the sound to come and go.
3-23
Tips About Your Audio System
Hearing damage fromloud noise is almostundetectable
until it is too late. Your hearing can adapt tohigher
volumes of sound. Sound that seems normal can be loud
and harmful to yourhearing. Take precautions by
adjusting the volume control on your radio to a safe
sound level before your hearing adapts to it.
To help avoid hearing loss or damage:
Adjust the volume control to the lowest setting.
0
Increase volume slowly until you hear comfortably
and clearly.
3-24
NOTICE:
Before you add any sound equipment to your
vehicle like a tape player, CB radio, mobile
telephone or two-way radio be sure you can
add what you want. If you can, it’s very
important to do properly.
it
Added sound
equipment may interfere with the operation of
your vehicle’s engine, DelcoElectronics radio or
other systems, and even damage them. Your
vehicle’s systems may interfere with the
operation of sound equipment that has been
added improperly.
So, before adding sound equipment, check with
your dealer andbe sure tocheck Federal rules
covering mobile radio andtelephone units.
--
--
Care of Your Cassette Tape Player
A tape player that is not cleaned regularly can cause
reduced sound quality, ruined cassettes or a damaged
mechanism. Cassette tapes shouldbe stored in their
cases away from contaminants, direct sunlightand
extreme heat.If they aren’t, they may not operate
properly or may cause failure of the tape player.
Your tape player should be cleaned regularly after every
50 hours of use. Your radio may display CLN to indicate
that you have used your tape player for 50 hours without
resetting the tape clean timer. If this message appears on
the display, your cassette tape player needs to be
cleaned. It will still play tapes, but you should clean it as
soon as possible to prevent damage to your tapes and
player, If you notice a reduction in sound quality, try a
known good cassette to see if it is the tape or the tape
player at fault. If this other cassette hasno improvement
in sound quality, clean the tape player.
The recommended cleaningmethod for your cassette
tape player is the use of a scrubbing action,
non-abrasive cleaning cassettewith pads which scrub
the tape head as the hubs of the cleaner cassetteturn.
The recommended cleaning cassetteis available through
your dealership (GM Part No. 12344789).
When using a scrubbing action, non-abrasive cleaning
cassette, it is normal for the cassette to eject while
cleaning because your unit is equipped with a cuttape
detection feature and some cleaning cassettesmay
appear as a brokentape. To prevent the cleaning cassette
from being ejected, use the followingsteps:
If your vehicle is equipped with the AM-FM Stereo with
Cassette Tape Player:
1. Turn the ignition to RUN or ACCESSORY.
2. Turn the radio on.
3. Insert the $%Tubbingaction cleaning cassette.
4. Within five seconds, press and hold the REV and
FWD buttons at the sametime for three seconds.The
tape symbol on the display will flash, showing that
the cut tape detections featureis no longer active.
5. Eject the cleaning cassette after the manufacturer’s
recommended cleaning time.
3-25
If your vehicle is equipped with the AM-FM Stereo with
Care of Your Compact Discs
Cassette Tape Player and Automatic Tone Control:
Handle discs carefully. Store them in their original cases
1. Turn the ignition to RUN or ACCESSORY.
or other protective cases and away from direct sunlight
2. Turn the radio off.
and dust. If the surface of a disc is soiled, dampen a
clean, soft cloth in a mild, neutral detergent solution and
3. Press and hold the TAPE AUX button for
clean it, wiping from the center to the edge.
five seconds. The tape symbol on the display will
flash for two seconds.
Be sure never to touch the signal surface when handling
discs. Pick up discs by grasping the outer edges or the
4. Insert the scrubbing action cleaning cassette.
edge of the hole and the outer edge.
5. Eject the cleaning cassette after the manufacturer’s
recommended cleaning time.
Care of Your Compact Disc Player
When the cleaning cassette has been ejected, the cut tape
The use of CD lens cleaner discs is not advised, due to
detection feature is active again.
the risk of contaminating the lens of the CD optics with
You may also choose a non-scrubbing action, wet-type
lubricants internal to the CD mechanism.
cleaner which uses a cassette with a fabric belt to clean
the tape head. This type of cleaning cassette will not
Fixed Mast Antenna
eject on its own. A non-scrubbing action cleaner may
The fixed mast antenna can withstand most car washes
not clean as thoroughly as the scrubbing type cleaner.
without being damaged. If the mast should ever become
The useof a non-scrubbing action, dry-typecleaning
slightly bent, you can straighten it out by hand. If the
cassette is not recommended
mast is badly bent, as it might be by vandals, you should
After you clean the player, press and hold EJECT for
replace it.
five seconds to reset the CLN indicator. The radio will
Check every once in a while to be sure the mast is still
display --- to show the indicator was reset.
tightened
to the cowl.
Cassettes are subject to wear and the sound qualitymay
degrade over time. Always make sure the cassette tape is in
good condition before you have your tape player serviced.
3-26
fi
NOTES
3-27
fi
3-28
NOTES
Section 4 Your Driving and the Road
Here you’ll find information about driving
on different kinds of roads and in varying weather conditions. We’ve also
included many other useful tips on driving.
4-2
4-2
4-5
4-6
4-8
4-1 1
4-1 1
4-13
4- 14
4-27
4-28
Defensive Driving
Drunken Driving
Control of a Vehicle
Braking
Steering
Off-Road Recovery
Passing
Loss of Control
Off-Road Driving with Your
Four-Wheel-Drive Vehicle
Driving at Night
Driving in Rain and on Wet Roads
4-3 1
4-32
4-33
4-33
4-34
4-36
4-4 1
4-42
4-47
4-47
4-48
City Driving
Freeway Driving
Before Leaving on a Long Trip
Highway Hypnosis
Hill and Mountain Roads
Winter Driving
Recreational Vehicle Towing
Loading Your Vehicle
Camper Wiring Harness (If Equipped)
Pickup Conversionto Chassis Cab
Towing a Trailer
Defensive driving really means “be ready for anything.‘,
On city streets, rural roads or freeways, it means
“always expect the unexpected.”
Assume that pedestrians or other drivers are going to be
careless and make mistakes. Anticipate what they might
do. Be ready for their mistakes.
Rear-end collisions are about the most preventable of
accidents. Yet they are common. Allow enough
following distance. It’s the best defensive driving
maneuver, in both city and rural driving. You never
know when the vehicle in front of you is going to brake
or turn suddenly.
Defensive Driving
The best advice anyone can give about driving is:
Drive defensively.
Please start with a very important safety device in your
vehicle: Buckle up. (See “Safety Belts” in the Index.)
4-2
Defensive driving requires thata driver concentrate on the
driving task. Anything that distracts
from the driving
task -- such as concentrating on a cellular telephone call,
reading, or reaching for something on the floor -- makes
proper defensive driving more difficult and can even cause
a collision, with resulting injury.Ask a passenger to help
do things like this, or pull off the road in a safe placeto do
them yourself. These simple defensive driving techniques
could save your life.
Death and injury associated with drinking and driving is
a national tragedy. It’s the number one contributor to
the highway death toll, claiming thousands of victims
every year.
The obvious way to solve this highway safety problem
is for people never to drink alcohol and then drive. But
what if people do? How much is “too much’’ if the
driver plans to drive? It’s a lot less than many might
think. Although it depends on each person and situation,
here is some general information on the problem.
Alcohol affects four things that anyone needs to drive
a vehicle:
The Blood Alcohol Concentration (BAC)of someone
who is drinking depends upon four things:
Drunken Driving
Judgment
0
The amount of alcohol consumed
0
MuscularCoordination
0
The drinker’s body weight
0
Vision
0
The amount of food that is consumed before and
during drinking
0
The length of time it has taken the drinker to
consume the alcohol.
Attentiveness.
Police records show that almost half of all motor
vehicle-related deaths involve alcohol. In most cases,
these deaths arethe result of someone who was drinking
and driving. In recent years, over 17,000 annual motor
vehicle-related deaths have been associated with the use
of alcohol, with more than 300,000 people injured.
Many adults -- by some estimates, nearly half the adult
population -- choose never to drink alcohol, so they
never drive after drinking.For persons under 2 1, it’s
against the law in every U.S. state to drink alcohol.
There aregood medical, psychological and
developmental reasons forthese laws.
According to the American Medical Association, a
180-lb. (82 kg) person who drinks three 12-ounce
(355 ml) bottles of beer in an hour will end up with a
BAC of about 0.06 percent. The person would reach the
same BAC by drinking three 4-ounce (120 ml) glasses
of wine or three mixed drinks if each had 1 - 1/2 ounces
(45 ml) of a liquor like whiskey, gin or vodka.
4-3
Since alcohol is carried in body water, this means that a
woman generally will reach a higher BAC level than a
man of her same body weight when each has the same
number of drinks.
The law in many U.S. states sets the legal limit at a BAC
of 0.10 percent. In a growing number of U.S. states, and
throughout Canada, the limit is 0.08 percent. In some
other countries, it’s even lower. The BAC limit for all
commercial drivers in the United States is 0.04 percent.
The BAC will be over 0.10 percent after three to six
drinks (in one hour). Of course, as we’ve seen, it
depends on how much alcohol is in the drinks, and how
quickly the person drinks them.
It’s the amount of alcohol that counts. For example, if
the same person drank three double martinis (3 ounces
or 90 ml of liquor each) within an hour, the person’s
BAC would be close to 0.12 percent. A person who
consumes foodjust before or duringdrinking will have a
somewhat lower BAC level.
There is a gender difference, too. Women generally have
a lower relative percentage of body water than men.
4-4
But the ability to drive is affected well below a BAC of
0.10 percent. Research shows that the driving skills of
many people are impaired at a BAC approaching
0.05 percent, and that the effects are worse at night. All
drivers are impaired at BAC levels above 0.05 percent.
Statistics show that the chance of being in a collision
increases sharply for driverswho have a BAC of
0.05 percent or above. A driverwith a BAC level of
0.06 percent has doubled his or her chance of having a
collision. At a BAC level of 0.10 percent, the chance of
this driver having a collision is 12 times greater; at a
level of 0.15 percent, the chance is 25 times greater!
The body takes about an hourto rid itself of the alcohol
in one drink. No amount of coffee or number of cold
showers will speed that up. “I’ll be careful’’ isn’t the
right answer. What if there’s an emergency, a need to
take sudden action, aswhen a child darts into the street?
A person with even a moderateBAC might not be able
to react quickly enough to avoid the collision.
There’s something else about drinking and driving
that
many people don’t know. Medical research shows that
alcohol in a person’s system can make crash injuries
worse, especially injuries tothe brain, spinal cord or
heart. This means that when anyone who has been
drinking -- driver or passenger-- is in a crash, that
person’s chance of being killed or permanently disabled
is higher than if the person had not been drinking.
Drinking and then driving very
is dangerous.
Your reflexes, perceptions, attentiveness and
judgment canbe affected by even a small amount
of alcohol. You can have a serious or even
fatal collision if you drive after drinking.
Please don’t drink anddrive or ride with a driver
who has been drinking. Ride home in a cab; or if
you’re with a group,designate a driverwho will
not drink.
--
--
Control of a Vehicle
You have three systems that make your vehicle go where
you want it to go. They are thebrakes, the steering and
the accelerator. All three systems have to do their work
at the places where the tires meet the road.
4-5
Average reaction time is about 3/4 of a second. But
that’s only an average. It might be less with one driver
and as long as two or three seconds or more with
another. Age, physical condition, alertness, coordination
and eyesight all play a part. So do alcohol, drugs and
frustration. But even in 314 of a second, a vehicle
moving at 60 mph ( 100 kmh) travels 66 feet (20 m).
That could be a lot of distance in an emergency, so
keeping enough space between your vehicle and others
is important.
And, of course, actual stopping distances vary greatly
with the surface of the road (whether it’s pavement or
gravel); the condition of the road (wet, dry, icy); tire
tread; the condition of your brakes; the weight of the
vehicle and the amount of brake force applied.
Sometimes, as when you’re driving on snow or ice, it’s
easy to ask more of those control systemsthan the tires
and road can provide. That means you can lose control
of your vehicle.
Braking
Braking action involvesperception time and reaction time.
First, you have to decide to push on the brake pedal.
That’s perception time. Then you have to bring up your
foot and do it. That’s reaction time.
4-6
Avoid needless heavy braking. Some people drive in
spurts -- heavy acceleration followed by heavy
braking -- rather than keeping pace with traffic. This
is a mistake. Your brakes may not have time to cool
between hard stops. Your brakes will wear out much
faster if you do alot of heavy braking. If you keep pace
with the traffic and allow realistic following distances,
you will eliminate a lot of unnecessary braking. That
means better braking and longer brake life.
If your engine ever stopswhile you’re driving, brake
normally but don’t pump your brakes. If you do, the
pedal may get harder to push down. If your engine
stops, you will still have some power brake assist.But
you will use it when you brake. Once thepower assist is
used up, it may take longer to stopand the brake pedal
will be harder to push.
Anti-Lock Brakes (ABS)
Your vehicle has anti-lock brakes (ABS). ABS is an
advanced electronicbraking system that will help
prevent a braking skid.
When you start your engine and begin to drive away,
your anti-lock brake system will check itself. You may
hear a momentary motor or clicking noise while this
test is going on. Thisis normal.
I
ANTI LOCK
If there’s a problem with
the anti-lock brake system,
this warning light will stay
on. See “Anti-Lock Brake
System Warning Light” in
the Index.
Here’s how anti-lock works. Let’s say the road is wet.
You’re driving safely. Suddenly an animal jumps out in
front of you.
You slam on the brakes. Here’s what happens with ABS.
A computer sensesthat wheels are slowing down. If one
of the wheels is about to stop rolling,the computer will
separately work the brakes at each front wheel and at
both rear wheels.
4-7
The anti-lock systemcan change the brake pressure faster
than any driver could. The computer is programmedto
make the most of available tire and road conditions.
Remember: Anti-lock doesn’t change the time you need
to get your foot up to the brake pedal or always decrease
stopping distance. If you get too closeto the vehicle in
front of you, you won’t have time to apply your brakes
if that vehicle suddenly slows or stops. Always leave
enough room up ahead to stop, even though you have
anti-lock brakes.
Using Anti-Lock
Don’t pump the brakes. Just hold the brake pedal down
firmly and let anti-lock work for you. You may feel the
brakes vibrate, or you may notice some noise, but this is
normal. On vehicles with four-wheel drive, your
anti-lock brakes work at all times -- whether you are in
two-wheel drive or four-wheel drive.
Braking in Emergencies
With anti-lock, you can steer and brake at the same
time. In many emergencies, steering can help you more
than even the very best braking.
You can steer around the obstacle while braking hard.
Steering
As you brake, your computerkeeps receiving updates on
wheel speed and controls braking pressure accordingly.
Power Steering
If you lose power steering assist because the engine
stops or the system is not functioning, you can steer but
it will take much more effort.
Speed Sensitive Steering
This system varies the amount of steering effort
proportionate to your vehicle speed. Steering is easier at
lower speeds for maneuveringand parking ease. As your
vehicle speed increases, the steeringeffort also
increases. At highway speeds, the amount of steering
effort is increased for vehicle controland stability.
Steering Tips
Driving on Curves
It’s important to take curves at a reasonable speed.
A lot of the “driver lost control” accidentsmentioned on
the news happen on curves. Here’s why:
Experienced driver or beginner, each of us is subject to
the same laws of physics when driving on curves. The
traction of the tires against the road surface makes it
possible for the vehicle to change its path when you turn
the front wheels. If there’s no traction, inertia will keep
the vehicle going in the same direction. If you’ve ever
tried to steer a vehicle onwet ice, you’ll understand this.
Suppose you’re steering through a sharp curve.
Then you suddenly accelerate. Both control
systems -- steering and acceleration -- have to do their
work where the tires meet the road. Adding the sudden
acceleration can demandtoo much of those places. You
can lose control.
What should you do if this ever happens‘?Ease up on the
accelerator pedal, steer the vehicle the way you want it
to go, and slow down.
Speed limit signs near curves warn that you should
adjust your speed. Of course, the posted speeds are
based on good weather and road conditions. Under less
favorable conditionsyou’ll want to go slower.
If you need to reduce your speed as you approach a
curve, do it before you enter the curve, while your front
wheels are straight ahead.
Try to adjust your speed so you can “drive” through the
curve. Maintain a reasonable, steady speed. Wait to
accelerate until you are out of the curve, and then
accelerate gently into the straightaway.
The traction you can get in a curve depends on the
condition of your tires and the road surface, the angle at
which the curve is banked, and your speed. While you’re in
a curve, speed is the one fxtor you can control.
4-9
Steering in Emergencies
There are times when steering can be more effective
than braking. For example, you come over a hill and
find a truck stopped in your lane, or acar suddenly pulls
out fromnowhere, or achild darts out frombetween
parked cars and stops right in front of you. You can
avoid these problems by braking -- if you can stop in
time. But sometimes you can’t; there isn’t room.
That’s the time for evasive action -- steering around
the problem.
Your vehicle can perform very well in emergencies like
these. First apply your brakes. (See “Braking in
Emergencies’’ earlier in this section.) It is better to
remove as much speed as you can from apossible
collision. Then steeraround the problem, to the left or
right depending on the space available.
An emergency like this requires close attention and a
quick decision. If you are holding the steering wheel at
the recommended 9 and 3 o’clock positions, you can
turn it a full 180 degrees very quickly without removing
either hand. But you have to act fast, steer quickly, and
just as quickly straighten the wheel once you have
avoided the object.
The fact that such emergency situations are always
possible is a good reason to practice defensive driving at
all times and wear safety belts properly.
4-10
Off-Road Recovery
Passing
You may find that your right wheels have droppedoff the
edge of a road onto the shoulder while you’re driving.
The driver of a vehicle about to pass another on a
two-lane highway waits for just the right moment,
accelerates, moves around the vehicle ahead, then goes
back into the right lane again. A simple maneuver?
OFF - ROAD RECOVERY
I
r///
/
i .
Not necessarily! Passing another vehicle on a two-lane
highway is a potentially dangerous move, since the
passing vehicle occupies the same lane as oncoming
traffic for several seconds. A miscalculation, an error in
judgment, or a brief surrender to frustration oranger can
suddenly put the passing driver face to fdce with the
worst of all traffic accidents -- the head-on collision.
So here are some tips for passing:
edge of paved
surface
If the level of the shoulder is only slightly below the
pavement, recovery should be fairly easy. Ease off the
accelerator and then, if there is nothing in the way, steer
so that your vehicle straddles the edge of the pavement.
You can turn the steering wheel up to one-quarterturn
until the right front tire contacts the pavement edge.
Then turn your steering wheel to go straight down
the roadway.
“Drive ahead.” Look down the road, to the sides and to
crossroads for situations that might affect your passing
patterns. If you have any doubt whatsoever about
making a successful pass, wait for a better time.
Watch for traffic signs, pavement markings and lines.
If you can see a sign up ahead that might indicate a
turn or an intersection, delay your pass.A broken
center line usually indicates it’s all right
to pass
(providing the road ahead is clear). Never crossa solid
line on your side of the lane or a double solid line,
even if the road seems empty of approaching traff-ic.
4-11
0
0
0
Do not get too close to the vehicle you want to pass
while you’re awaiting anopportunity. For one thing,
following too closely reduces your area
of vision,
Also, you
especially if you’re following a larger vehicle.
won’t have adequate space if the vehicle ahead suddenly
slows or stops. Keep backa reasonabledistance.
When it looks like a chance to pass is coming up,
start to accelerate but stay in the right lane and don’t
so you will be
get too close. Time your move
increasing speed as the time comes to move into the0
other lane. If the way is clear to pass, you will have a
“running start” that more than makes up for the
distance you would lose by dropping back. And if
0
something happens to cause you to cancel your pass,
you need only slow down and drop back again and
wait for another opportunity.
0
If other cars are lined up to pass a slow vehicle, wait
your turn. But take care that someone isn’t trying to
pass you as you pull out to pass the slow vehicle.
Remember to glance over your shoulder and check
the blind spot.
4-12
Check your mirrors, glance over your shoulder and
start your left lane change signal before moving out
of the right lane to pass. When you
are far enough
ahead of the passed vehicle to see its front in your
inside mirror, activate your right lane change signal
and move back into the right lane. (Remember that if
your right outside mirroris convex, the vehicleyou
just passedmay seem to be farther away from you
than it really is.)
Try not to pass more than one vehicle at a time
the
on two-lane roads. Reconsider before passing
next vehicle.
Don’t overtake a slowly moving vehicle too rapidly.
Even though the brake lampsare not flashing, it may
be slowing down or starting to turn.
If you’re being passed, make it easy for the
following driver to get ahead of you. Perhaps you
can ease a little to the right.
Loss of Control
Let’s review what driving experts say about what
happens when the three control systems (brakes,steering
and acceleration) don’t have enough friction
where the
tires meet the road to do what the driver has asked.
In any emergency, don’t give up. Keep tryingto steer and
constantly seek an escape route or area of less danger.
Skidding
In a skid, a driver can lose control of the vehicle. Defensive
drivers avoid most skidsby taking reasonable care suited to
existing conditions, and by not “overdriving” those
conditions. But skids are always possible.
If your vehicle startsto slide, ease your footoff the
accelerator pedal and quickly steer the way you want the
vehicle to go. If you start steering quickly enough, your
vehicle may straighten out. Always be ready for a
second skid if it occurs.
Of course, traction is reduced when water, snow, ice,
gravel or othermaterial is on the road. For safety, you’ll
want to slow downand adjust your driving to these
conditions. It is important to slow down on slippery
surfaces becausestopping distance will be longer and
vehicle control more limited.
The three types of skids correspondto your vehicle’s
three control systems.In the braking skid, yourwheels
aren’t rolling. In the steering or cornering skid, too
much speed or steering in a curve causestires to slip and
lose cornering force. And in the acceleration skid, too
much throttle causes the driving wheels to spin.
While driving on a surface
with reduced traction, try
your best to avoid sudden steering, acceleration or
braking (including engine braking by shifting to a lower
gear). Any sudden changes could cause the tires to slide.
You may not realize the surface isslippery until your
vehicle is skidding. Learn to recognize warning clues -such as enoughwater, ice orpacked snow on the road to
make a “mirrored surface” -- and slow down when you
have any doubt.
A cornering skidand an acceleration skid arebest
handled by easing your foot off the accelerator pedal.
Remember: Any anti-lock brake system (ABS) helps
avoid only the braking skid.
4-13
Off-Road Driving with Your
Four-Wheel-DriveVehicle
This off-road guide is for vehicles that have
four-wheel drive.
Also, see “Anti-Lock Brakes” in the Index.
If your vehicle doesn’t have four-wheel drive, you
shouldn’t drive off-road unless you’re on a level,
solid surface.
Off-road driving can be greatfun. But it does havesome
definite hazards.The greatest of these is the terrain itself.
“Off-roading” means you’ve left the great North
American road system behind. Traffic lanes aren’t
marked. Curves aren’t banked. There are no road signs.
Surfaces can be slippery, rough, uphill or downhill. In
short, you’ve gone right back to nature.
Off-road driving involves some new skills. And that’s
why it’s very important that you read this guide. You’ll
find many driving tips and suggestions. Thesewill help
make your off-road driving safer and more enjoyable.
4-14
Before You Go Off-Roading
There are somethings to do before you go out. For
example, be sure tohave all necessary maintenance and
service work done. Check to make sure all underbody
shields (if so equipped) areproperly attached. Be sure
you read all the information about your
four-wheel-drive vehicle in this manual. Is there enough
fuel? Is the spare tire fully inflated? Are the fluid levels
up where they should be? What are the local laws that
apply to off-roading where you’ll be driving? If you
don’t know, you should check with law enforcement
people in the area. Will you be on someone’s private
land? If so, be sure to get the necessary permission.
Loading Your Vehicle for Off-Road Driving
There are someimportant things to remember about
how to load your vehicle.
0
The heaviest things should be on the load floor and
forward of your rear axle. Put heavier items as far
forward as you can.
Be sure the load is secured properly, so driving on
the off-road terrain doesn’t toss things around.
Environmental Concerns
0
0
0
Cargo on the load floor piled h i g k tlrnll
the seatbackscan be thrown forward
during a sudden stop. You or your
passengers could be injured. Keep cargo
below the topof the seatbacks.
Unsecured cargo on theload floor can be
tossed about when driving over rough
terrain. You or your passengers can be
struck by flying objects. Secure the
cargo properly.
Heavy loads on the roof raise thevehicle’s
center of gravity, making it morelikely to
roll over. You can be seriously or fatally
injured if the vehicle rolls over. Put heavy
loads inside the cargo area,not on the roof.
Keep cargo in the cargo area far
as forward
and low as possible.
Off-road driving can provide wholesome and satisfying
recreation. However, it also raises environmental
concerns. GM recognizes these concerns and urges
every off-roader to follow these basic rules for
protecting the environment:
0
Always use established trails, roads and areas that
have been specially set aside for public off-road
recreational driving; obey all posted regulations.
0
Avoid any driving practice that could damage the
environment -- shrubs, flowers, trees, grasses-- or
disturb wildlife (this includes wheel-spinning,
breaking down trees or unnecessary driving through
streams or oversoft ground).
0
Always carry a litter bag . . . make sure all refuse is
removed from any campsite before leaving.
0
Take extreme care with open fires (where permitted),
camp stoves and lanterns.
0
Never park your vehicle over dry grass or other
combustible materials that could catch firefrom the
heat of the vehicle’s exhaust system.
You’ll find other important information
in this manual.
See “Vehicle Loading,” “Luggage Carrier”and “Tires”
in the Index.
4-15
Traveling to Remote Areas
Controlling your vehicle is the key to successful
off-road driving. Oneof the best ways to control your
It makes sense to plan your trip, especially
when going
vehicle is to control yourspeed. Here are some things to
to a remote area. Know the terrain and plan your route. keep in mind. At higher speeds:
You are much less likely to get bad surprises. Get
you approach things faster and you have less time to
Try to learn of any
accurate maps of trails and terrain.
scan the terrain for obstacles.
blocked or closed roads.
0 you have less time to react.
It’s also a good idea to travel with at least one other
vehicle. If something happens toone of them, the other
you have more vehicle bounce when you drive
can help quickly.
over obstacles.
Does your vehicle have a winch? so,
If be sure to read
you’ll need more distance for braking, especially
the winch instructions. In a remote area, a winch can be
since you’re on an unpaved surface.
handy if you get stuck. But you’ll want to know how to
use it properly.
Getting Familiar with Off-Road Driving
It’s a good idea to practice
in an area that’s safe and
go into the wilderness.
close to home before you
Off-road driving does require some new and different
driving skills. Here’s what we mean.
Tune your sensesto different kinds of signals. Your
eyes, for example, need to constantly sweep the terrain
for unexpected obstacles. Your ears need to listenfor
unusual tire or engine sounds. With your arms, hands,
feet and body, you’ll need to respond to vibrations and
vehicle bounce.
When you’re driving off-road, bouncing and
quick changes in direction can easily throw you
out of position. This could cause you
to lose
control and crash.So, whether you’re driving on
or off the road, you and your passengers should
wear safety belts.
Scanning the Terrain
Off-road driving can take you over many different kinds
of terrain. You need to be familiar with the terrain and its
many different features. Here are some things to consider.
SurJace Conditions. Off-roading can take you over
hard-packed dirt, gravel, rocks, grass, sand, mud, snow or
ice. Each of these surfaces affects the steering, acceleration
and braking of your vehicle in different ways. Depending
you may experience
upon the kind of surface you are on,
slipping, sliding, wheel spinning, delayed acceleration,
poor traction and longer braking distances.
Sutjiace Obstacles. Unseen or hidden obstacles canbe
hazardous. A rock, log, hole, rut or bump can startle you if
you’re not prepared for them. Often these obstacles are
hidden by grass, bushes, snow or even the rise and fall of
the terrain itself. Here are some things to consider:
0
Is the path ahead clear?
0
Will the surface texture change abruptly up ahead?
0
Does the travel take you uphill or downhill? (There’s
more discussionof these subjects later.)
0
Will you have to stop suddenly or change
direction quickly?
When you drive over obstaclesor rough terrain, keep a
wheel. Ruts, troughsor other
firm grip on the steering
surface features can
jerk the wheel outof your hands if
you’re not prepared.
When you drive over bumps, rocks,
or other obstacles,
your wheels can leave the ground. If this happens, even
with one or two wheels, you can’t control the vehicle as
well or atall.
Because you will be on an unpaved surface, it’s
especially important to avoid sudden acceleration,
sudden turns or sudden braking.
In a way, off-road driving requires a different kind of
alertness from driving on paved roads and highways.
There are no road signs, posted speed limits or signal
lights. You have to use your own good judgment about
what is safe and what isn’t.
Drinking and driving can be very dangerous
on any
At
road. And this is certainly true for off-road driving.
the very time you need special alertness and driving
can be
skills, your reflexes, perceptions and judgment
affected by evena small amount of alcohol.You could
have a serious-- or even fatal-- accident if you drink
and drive or ride with a driver who has been drinking.
See “Drunken Driving”in the Index.
4-17
Driving on Off-Road Hills
Off-road driving oftentakes you up, down or across a
hill. Driving safely on hills requires good judgment and
an understanding of what your vehicle can and can’t do.
There are somehills that simply can’t be driven, no
matter how well built the vehicle.
incline may get steeper as you near the top, but you may
not see this because the crest of the hill is hidden by
bushes, grass or shrubs.
Here are some otherthings to consider as you approach
a hill.
0
Is there a constantincline, or doesthe hill get sharply
steeper in places?
0
Is there good traction on the hillside, or will the
surface cause tire slipping?
0
Is there a straight path up or down the hill so you
won’t have to make turning maneuvers?
0
Are there obstructions on the hill that can block your
path (boulders, trees, logs or ruts)?
0
What’s beyond the hill? Is there a cliff, an
embankment, adrop-off, a fence? Get outand
walk the hill if you don’t know. It’s the smart way to
find out.
0
Is the hill simply too rough? Steep hills often have
ruts, gullies, troughs and exposed rocks because they
are more susceptible to the effects of erosion.
I
Many hills are simply too steepfor any vehicle. If
you drive up them, you will stall. If you drive
down them, youcan’t control your speed. If you
drive across them, you will roll
over. You could be
seriously injuredor killed. If you have any doubt
about the steepness, don’t drive the hill.
Approaching a Hill
When you approach a hill, you need to decide if it’s one
of those hills that’s just too steep to climb, descend or
cross. Steepness can be hard to judge. On a very small
hill, for example, there may be a smooth, constant
incline with only a small change in elevation where you
can easily see all the way to the top. On alarge hill, the
Driving Uphill
Ease up on your speed as you approach the top of
the hill.
Once you decide you can safely drive up the hill, you
need to take some special steps.
0
0
0
0
Use a low gear and get a firm grip on the
steering wheel.
Get a smooth start up the hill and try to maintain
your speed. Don’tuse more power than you need,
because you don’t want your wheels to start spinning
or sliding.
Try to drive straightup the hill if at all possible. If
the path twists and turns, you might want to find
another route.
I
lhrnina Ir driving across steep hills can be
dangerous. You could lose traction, slide
sideways, and possibly roll over. You could be
seriously injured orkilled. When driving uphills,
always try to go straight up.
Attach a flag to the vehicle to make you more visible
to approaching trafficon trails or hills.
Sound the horn as you approach the top of the hill to
let opposing trafficknow you’re there.
Use your headlamps even duringthe day. They make
you more visible to oncoming traffic.
I A CAUTION:
Driving to the top(crest) of a hill at full speed can
cause an accident. There could be a drop-off,
embankment, cliff, or even another vehicle. You
could be seriously injured or killed. As you near
the topof a hill, slowdown and stay alert.
4-19
@
What should I do if my vehicle stalls,or is about
to stall, andI can’t makeit up the hill?
A:
If this happens, there are somethings you should
do, and there are some things
you must not do.
First, here’s what you should do:
0
Push the brakepedal to stop the vehicle and keep it
fi-om rolling backwards. Also, apply the parking brake.
0
If your engineis still running, shiftthe transmission
to REVERSE (R), release the parking brake, and
slowly back down the hill in REVERSE (R).
0
If your engine has stopped running, you’ll need to
restart it. With the brake pedal depressed and the
parking brake still applied, shift the transmission to
PARK (P) (or, shift to NEUTRAL (N) if your
vehicle has a manual transmission) and restart the
engine. Then, shift to REVERSE(R), release the
parking brake, and slowly back down the hill as
straight as possiblein REVERSE (R).
0
As you are backing down the hill,put your left hand
on the steering wheel at the 12 o’clock position. This
way, you’ll be able to tell if your wheels are straight
and maneuver as you back down. It’s best that you
4-20
back down the hill with your wheels straight rarner
than in the left or right direction. Turning the wheel
too farto the left or right will increase the possibility
of a rollover.
Here are somethings you must not do if you stall, or are
about to stall, when going up a hill.
Never attempt to prevent a stall by shifting into
NEUTRAL (N) (or depressingthe clutch, if you
have a manual transmission) to “rev-up” the engine
and regain forward momentum. This won’t work.
Your vehicle will roll backwards very quickly and
you could go out of control.
Instead, apply the regular brake to stop the vehicle.
Then apply the parking brake. Shift to
REVERSE (R), release the parking brake, and
slowly back straight down.
0
Never attempt to turn around if you are about to stall
when going up a hill. If the hill is steep enough to
stall your vehicle, it’s steep enough to cause you to
roll over if you turn around. If you can’t make it up
the hill, you must back straight down the hill.
&.’ Suppose, after stalling, I try to back down the
hill and decide I just can’t do it. What should
I do?
A:
Set the parking brake, put your transmissionin
PARK (P) (or the manual transmission in
FIRST (1)) and turn off the engine. Leave the
vehicle and go get some help. Exiton the uphill
side and stay clear of the path the vehicle would
take if it rolled downhill. Do not shift the transfer
case to NEUTRAL (N) when you leave the vehicle.
Leave itin some gear.
Shifting thetransfer case to NEUTRAL (N) can
cause your vehicle to roll even if the transmission
is in PARK (P) (or, if youhave the manual
transmission, even if you’re in gear). This is
because the NEUTRAL (N) position on the
transfer case overrides thetransmission. You or
someone else could beinjured. If you are going to
leave your vehicle, set the parkingbrake and
shift the transmissionto PARK (P)(or, put your
manual transmissionin FIRST (1)). But do not
shift thetransfer case to theNEUTRAL (N)
position. Leave the transfercase in the2 Wheel,
4 High or 4 Low position.
4-21
Driving Downhill
When off-roading takes you downhill, you’ll want to
consider a number of things:
0
How steep is the downhill? Will I be able to maintain
vehicle control?
0
What’s the surface like? Smooth?Rough? Slippery?
Hard-packed dirt? Gravel?
0
Are there hidden surface obstacles? Ruts?Logs?
Boulders?
0
What’s at the bottom of the hill? Is there a hidden
creek bank or even a river bottom with large rocks?
If you decide you can go down a hill safely, then try to
keep your vehicle headed straight down,and use a low
gear. This way, engine drag can helpyour brakes and
they won’t have to do all the work. Descend slowly,
keeping your vehicle under control at all times.
4-22
1
Heavy braking when going down a hill can cause
your brakes to overheat and fade. This could cause
loss of control and a serious accident. Apply the
brakes lightly when descending a hill and use a low
gear to keep vehicle speed under control.
Are there some thingsI should not do when
Q: driving
down a hill?
A:
Yes! These are important because if you
ignore them you could lose control and have a
serious accident.
0
When driving downhill,avoid turns that take you
across the incline of the hill. A hill that’s not too
steep to drive down may be too steep to driveacross.
You could roll over if you don’t drive straight down.
0
Never go downhill with the transmission in
NEUTRAL (N), or with the clutch pedal depressed
in a manual shift. This is called “free-wheeling.”
Your brakes will have to do all the work and could
werheat and fade.
&.’ Am I likely to stall when going downhill?
A:
0
It’s much more likely to happen going uphill. But if
it happens going downhill,here’s what to do.
Stop your vehicle by applying the regular brakes.
Apply the parking brake.
Shift to PARK (P) (or to NEUTRAL (N) with the
manual transmission) and, while still braking, restart
the engine.
0
over end. But when you drive across an incline, the
much more narrow track width (the distance between
the left and right wheels) may not prevent the vehicle
from tilting and rolling over. Also, driving across an
incline puts more weight on the downhill wheels.
This could cause a downhill slide orrollover.
a
Shift back to a low gear, release the parking brake,
and drive straight down.
If the engine won’t start, get out and get help.
Driving Acrossan Incline
Sooner orlater, an off-road trail will probably go across
the incline of a hill. If this happens, you have to decide
whether to try to drive across the incline.Here are some
things to consider:
A hill that can be driven straight up or down may be
too steep to drive across.When you go straight up or
down a hill, the length of the wheel base (the
distance from the front wheels to the rear wheels)
reduces the likelihood the vehicle will tumble end
0
Surface conditionscan be a problem when you drive
across a hill. Loose gravel, muddy spots, or evenwet
grass can cause yourtires to slip sideways, downhill.
If the vehicle slips sideways, it can hit something
that will trip it (a rock, a rut, etc.) and roll over.
0
Hidden obstacles can make the steepness of the
incline even worse. If you drive across arock with
the uphill wheels, or if the downhill wheels drop into
a rut or depression, your
vehicle can tilt even more.
For reasons like these, you need to decide carefully
whether to try to drive across an incline. Just because
the trail goes across the incline doesn’t mean you
have to drive it. The last vehicle to try it might have
rolled over.
4-23
I Stalling on an Incline
If your vehicle stalls when you're crossing an incline, be
Driving across an incline that's too steep will
make yourvehicle roll over. You could be
seriously injured orkilled. If you have any doubt
about thesteepness of the incline, don't drive
across it. Find another routeinstead.
sure you (and your passengers) get outon the uphill
side, evenif the door there is harder to open. If you get
out on the downhill side and the vehicle starts to roll
over, you'll be right in its path.
If you have to walk down the slope, stay out of the path
the vehicle will take if it does roll over.
What if I'm driving acrossan incline that's not
too steep, but I hit some loosegravel andstart to
slide downhill. What shouldI do?
A:
If you feel your vehicle starting to slide sideways,
turn downhill. This should help straighten out the
vehicle and prevent the side slipping. However, a
much better way to prevent this is to get out and
"walk the course" so you know what the surface is
like before you drive it.
4-24
g
want to reducethe air pressure in your tires slightly
when driving on sand. Thiswill improve traction.
Getting outon the downhill (low) side of a vehicle
stopped acrossan incline is dangerous. If the
vehicle rolls over, you couldbe crushedor killed.
Always get out on the uphill (high) side of the
vehicle and stay well clear of the rollover path.
Hard packed snow and ice offerthe worst tire traction.
On these surfaces, it’s very easy to lose control. On wet
so poor that you will
ice, for example, the traction is
have difficulty accelerating.And if you do get moving,
poor steering and difficult braking can causeyou to slide
out of control.
Driving in Mud, Sand, Snow or Ice
When you drive in mud, snow or sand, your wheels
won’t get good traction. You can’t accelerate as
quickly, turning is more difficult. and vou’llneed
longer braking distances.
It’s best to use a low gear when you’re in mud -- the
deeper the mud, the lower the gear. In really deep mud,
the idea is to keep your vehicle moving so you don’t
get stuck.
Driving on frozen lakes, ponds or rivers can
be
dangerous. Underwater springs,currents under
the ice, or sudden thaws canweaken the ice. Your
vehicle couldfall through theice and you and
your passengers could drown. Drive your vehicle
on safe surfaces only.
When you drive on sand, you’ll sense a changein wheel
traction. But it will depend upon how loosely packed the
sand is. On loosely packed sand (as on beaches or sand
dunes) your tireswill tend to sink intothe sand. This has
an effect on steering, accelerating and braking. You may
4-25
Driving in Water
Light rain causes no special off-road driving problems.
But heavy rain can mean flash flooding, and flood
waters demand extreme caution.
Driving through rushing water can be dangerous.
Deep water can sweep your vehicle downstream
and you and your passengers could drown.
If it’s
only shallow water, it canstill wash away the
ground from under your tires, and you could lose
traction and roll the vehicle over. Don’t drive
through rushing water.
Find out how deep the water is before you drive through
it. If it’s deep enough to cover yourwheel hubs, axles or
exhaust pipe, don’t try it -- you probably won’t get
through. Also, water that deep can damageyour axle
and othervehicle parts.
If the water isn’t too deep, thendrive through it slowly. At
fast speeds, water splasheson your ignition system and
your vehicle can stall. Stalling can also occurif you get
your tailpipe under water. And,as long as your tailpipe is
under water, you’ll never be able to start your engine.
When you go through water, remember that when your
brakes get wet,it may take you longer to stop.
L
See “Driving Through Water” in the Index for more
information on driving through water.
After Off-Road Driving
Remove any brush or debris that has collected on the
underbody, chassis or under the hood. These
accumulations can be a fire hazard.
After operation in mud or sand, have the brake linings
cleaned and checked. Thesesubstances can cause
glazing and uneven braking. Check the body structure,
4-26
steering, suspension, wheels, tires and exhaust system
for damage. Also, check the fuel lines and cooling
system for any leakage.
Night driving is more dangerousthan day driving. One
reason is that some drivers are likely to be impaired -- by
alcohol or drugs, with night vision problems, or by fatigue.
Your vehicle will require more frequent service due to
off-road use. Refer to the Maintenance Schedule for
additional information.
Here are some tips on night driving.
Driving at Night
Drivedefensively.
Don’t drink and drive.
0
Adjust your inside rearview mirror to reduce the
glare from headlamps behind you.
0
Since you can’t see as well, you may need to
slow down and keep more space between
you and
other vehicles.
0
Slow down, especially on higher speed roads.Your
headlamps can lightup only so much road ahead.
0
In remote areas, watch for animals.
If you’re tired, pulloff the road in a safe place
and rest.
Night Vision
No one can seeas well at nightas in the daytime. Butas
we get older these differences increase. A 50-year-old
driver may require at least twiceas much light to see the
same thing atnight as a 20-year-old.
4-27
What you do in the daytime can also affect your night
vision. For example, if you spend the day in bright
sunshine you are wise to wear sunglasses. Your eyes will
have less trouble adjusting to night. But if you're
driving, don't wear sunglasses at night. They may cut
down on glare from headlamps,but they also make a lot
of things invisible.
You can be temporarily blinded by approaching
headlamps. It can take a second ortwo, or even several
seconds, foryour eyes to readjust to the dark. When you
are faced with severe glare(as from a driver who
doesn't lower the high beams, or a vehicle with
misaimed headlamps), slow down alittle. Avoid staring
directly into the approaching headlamps.
Keep your windshield and all the glass on your vehicle
clean -- inside and out. Glare at night is made much
worse by dirt on the glass. Even the inside of the glass
can build up a filmcaused by dust. Dirty glass makes
lights dazzle and flash more than clean glass would,
making the pupils of your eyes contract repeatedly.
4-28
Remember that your headlamps light up far lessof a
roadway when you are in a turn or curve. Keep your
eyes moving; that way, it's easier to pick out dimly
lighted objects. Just as your headlamps should be
checked regularly for proper aim, so should your eyes
be examined regularly. Some drivers suffer fromnight
blindness -- the inability to see in dim light -- and aren't
even aware of it.
Driving in Rain and on
Wet Roads
Rain and wet roads can mean driving trouble. On
a wet
road, you can’t stop, accelerate orturn as well because
your tire-to-road traction isn’tas good as on dry roads.
And, if your tires don’t havemuch tread left, you’llget
even less traction.It’s always wise togo slower andbe
cautious if rain starts to fall whileyou are driving. The
surface may get wet suddenly when your reflexes are
tuned for driving on dry pavement.
it is to see. Even if your
The heavier the rain, the harder
windshield wiper blades are in good shape,heavy
a rain
can make it harder to see road signs and traffic signals,
pavement markings, the edgeof the road andeven
people walking.
It’s wise to keepyour wiping equipmentin good shape
and keep your windshield washer tank filled
with
washer fluid. Replaceyour windshield wiper inserts
when they show signsof streaking or missing areas on
the windshield, orwhen strips of rubber start to separate
from the inserts.
or even
Driving too fast through large water puddles
going through some car washes cancause problems, too.
The water may affect your brakes. Try to avoid puddles.
But if you can’t, try to slow down before you hit them.
4-29
Hydroplaning usually happens at higher speeds. There
just isn’t a hard and fast rule about hydroplaning. The
best advice is to slow down when it is raining.
Wet brakes cancause accidents. They won’t work
as well in a quick stop andmay cause pulling to
one side. You could lose control of the vehicle.
After driving through a large puddle of water or
a car wash, apply your brake pedal lightly until
your brakes work normally.
Driving Through Deep Standing Water
NOTICE:
If you drive too quickly through deep puddles or
standing water, water can come in through your
engine’s air intake andbadly damage your
engine. Neverdrive through water thatis slightly
lower than theunderbody of your vehicle. If you
can’t avoid deep puddles or standing water, drive
through them very slowly.
Hydroplaning
Hydroplaning is dangerous. So much water can build up
under your tires that they can actually ride on the water.
This canhappen if the road is wet enough and you’re
going fast enough. Whenyour vehicle is hydroplaning,
it has little orno contact with the road.
Some Other Rainy Weather Tips
Hydroplaning doesn’t happen often. But it can if your
tires do not have much tread or if the pressure in one or
more is low. It can happen if a lot of water is standing on
the road. If you can see reflections from trees, telephone
poles or other vehicles, and raindrops “dimple” the
water’s surface, there could be hydroplaning.
0
Besides slowing down, allow some extra following
distance. And be especially careful when you pass
another vehicle. Allow yourself more clear room
ahead, and be prepared to have your view restricted
by road spray.
Have good tires with proper tread depth. (See
“Tires” in the Index.)
City Driving
0
Know the best way to get to where you are going. Get
a city map and plan your trip into an unknown partof
the city just as you would for a cross-country trip.
0
Try to use the freeways that rim and crisscross most
large cities. You’ll save time and energy. (See the
next part, “Freeway Driving.”)
0
Treat a green light as a warning signal. A traffic light is
there because the corneris busy enough to need it.
When a light turns green, andjust before you start to
move, check both ways for vehicles that have not
cleared the intersection or may be running the red light.
One of the biggest problems with city streets is the
amount of traffic on them. You’ll want to watch out for
what the other drivers are doingand pay attention to
traffic signals.
Here are ways to increase your safety in city driving:
4-31
Freeway Driving
At the entrance, there is usually a ramp that leads to the
of the freeway as you
freeway. If you have a clear view
you should begin to
drive along the entrance ramp,
check t r m c . Try to determine where you expect to
to
blend with theflow. Try to merge into the gap at close
the prevailing speed. Switch
on your turn signal, check
your mirrors and glance over your shoulder as often
as
necessary. Try to blend smoothly with the traffic flow.
Once you are on the freeway, adjust your speed to the
posted limit or to the prevailing rate if it’s slower. Stay
in the right lane unless you want to pass.
Before changing lanes, check your mirrors. Then use
your turn signal.
Just before you leave the lane, glance quicklyyour
over
shoulder to make sure there isn’t another vehicle in your
“blind” spot.
Once youare moving on the freeway, make certain you
to move
allow a reasonable following distance. Expect
Mile for mile, freeways (also called thruways, parkways, slightly slower at night.
expressways, turnpikes or superhighways) are the safest
When you want to leave the freeway, move to the proper
of all roads. But they have their own special rules.
lane well in advance. If youmiss your exit, do not,
The most important advice on freeway driving is: Keep under any circumstances, stop and back up. Drive on to
up with traffic and keep to the right. Drive at the same the next exit.
speed most of the other drivers are driving. Too-fast or
too-slow driving breaksa smooth traffic flow. Treat the The exit ramp can be curved, sometimes quite sharply.
left lane on a freeway as a passing lane.
The exit speedis usually posted.
Reduce your speed accordingto your speedometer, not
to your senseof motion. After driving for any distance
at higher speeds, you may tend to think you are going
slower than you actually are.
0
e Lamps: Are they all working? Are the lenses clean?
e Tires: They are vitally important to a safe,
trouble-free trip. Is the tread good enough for
long-distance driving? Are the tires all inflated to the
recommended pressure?
Before Leaving on a Long Trip
Make sure you’reready. Try to be well rested. If you
must start when you’re not fresh -- such as aftera day’s
work -- don’t plan to make too many miles that first part
of the journey. Wear comfortable clothingand shoes you
can easily drivein.
Is your vehicle ready for a long trip? If you keep it
serviced and maintained, it’s ready to go. If it needs
service, have it done before startingout. Of course,
you’ll find experienced and able service experts
in GM
dealerships all across North America. They’ll be ready
and willing to help if you need it.
Here are some thingsyou can check beforea trip:
0
Windshield Washer Fluid: Is the reservoir full? Are
all windows clean insideand outside?
0
Wiper Blades: Are they in good shape?
Fuel, Engine Oil, Other Fluids:Have you checked
all levels?
e Weather Forecasts: What’s the weather outlook
along your route? Shouldyou delay your trip a short
time to avoid a major storm system?
0
Maps: Do you have up-to-date maps?
Highway Hypnosis
Is there actually sucha condition as “highway hypnosis”?
Or is it just plain falling asleep at the wheel? Call
it
highway hypnosis, lack of awareness,or whatever.
of road with the
There is something about an easy stretch
same scenery, along with the hum of the tires on the road,
the drone of the engine, and the rush of the wind against
the vehicle that can make you sleepy. Don’t itlethappen
to you! If it does, your vehicle can leave the road inless
than a second, and you could crash and be injured.
4-33
What canyou do about highway hypnosis? First, be
aware that it can happen.
Hill and MountainRoads
Then here are sometips:
0
Make sure your vehicle is well ventilated, with a
comfortably cool interior.
0
Keep your eyes moving. Scan the road ahead and
to the sides. Check yourmirrors and your
instruments frequently.
0
If you get sleepy, pull off the road into a rest, service
or parking area and take a nap, get some exercise,or
both. For safety, treat drowsiness on the highway as
an emergency.
Driving on steep hills or mountains is different from
driving in flat or rolling terrain.
If you drive regularly in steep country, or if you’re planning
to visit there, here are some tips thatcan make your trips
safer and more enjoyable. (See “Off-Road Driving” in the
Index for information about driving off-road.)
4-34
0
Keep your vehicle in good shape. Check all fluid
levels and also the brakes, tires, cooling system and
transmission. These parts can work hard on
mountain roads.
A
Coasting downhill in NEUTRAL (N) or with the
ignition off is dangerous. Your brakes will have
to do all thework of slowing down.They could
get so hot that they wouldn’t work well. You
would then have poor braking or
even none going
down a hill. You could crash. Always have your
engine running and yourvehicle ingear when
you go downhill.
Know how to go down hills. The most important
thing to know is this: let your enginedo some of the
slowing down. Shift to a lower gear
when you go
down a steep or long
hill.
11 you don’t shift down, yourbrakes could get so
hot that they wouldn’t work well. You would then
have poorbraking or even none going downa hill.
You could crash. Shift down
to let your engine
assist your brakes on a steep downhill slope.
-AUTION:
0
Know how to go uphill. You may want to shift down
to a lower gear. The lower gears help cool your engine
and transmission,and you can climb the hill better.
0
Stay in your own lane when driving on two-lane
roads in hills or mountains. Don’t swingwide or cut
across the centerof the road. Drive at speeds thatlet
you stay in your own lane.
As you go overthe top of a hill,be alert. There could
be
something in your lane, like a stalled an
caraccident.
or
You may see highway signs on mountains that warnof
special problems. Examples are long grades, passing
or
no-passing zones, a falling rocks area or winding
roads. Be alert to these and take appropriate action.
0
0
4-35
Winter Driving
Here are some tips for winter driving:
Have your vehicle in good shape for winter.
You may want to put winter emergency supplies in
your vehicle.
Include an ice scraper, a small brush or broom, a supply
of windshield washer fluid, a rag, some winter outer
clothing, a small shovel, a flashlight, a red cloth and
reflective warning triangles. And, if you will be driving
under severe conditions, include a small bag of sand, a
piece of old carpet or a coupleof burlap bags to help
provide traction. Be sure you properly secure these
items in your vehicle.
4-36
Driving onSnow or Ice
Most of the time, those places where your tires meet the
road probably havegood traction.
However, if there is snow or ice between your tires and
the road, you can have avery slippery situation. You’ll
have a lot less traction or “grip” and will need to be
very careful.
What’s the worst time for this? “Wet ice.” Very cold
snow or ice can be slick and hard to drive on. But wet
ice canbe even more trouble because it may offer the
least traction of all. You can get wet ice when it’s about
freezing (32°F; 0°C) and freezing rain begins to fall.
Try to avoid driving on wet ice until salt and sand crews
can get there.
Whatever the condition -- smooth ice, packed, blowing
or loose snow -- drive with caution.
Accelerate gently. Try not to break the fragile traction. If
you accelerate too fast,the drive wheels will spin and
polish the surface under the tires even more.
.........................................
.........................................
Your anti-lock brakes improve your vehicle’s stability
when you make a hard stop on aslippery road. Even
though you have an anti-lock braking system, you’ll
want to begin stopping sooner than you would on dry
pavement. See “Anti-Lock” in the Index.
Allow greater following distance on any
slippery road.
1
4-37
0
Watch for slippery spots. The road might be fine
until you hit a spot that’s covered with ice. On an
otherwise clearroad, ice patches may appear in
shaded areas where the sun can’t reach: around
clumps of trees, behind buildings orunder bridges.
Sometimes the surfaceof a curveor an overpass may
remain icy when the surrounding roads are clear. If
you see apatch of ice ahead of you, brake before you
are on it. Try not to brake while you’re actually on
the ice, and avoid sudden steering maneuvers.
4-38
If You’re Caught in a Blizzard
If you are stopped by heavy snow, you could be in a
serious situation. You should probably stay with your
vehicle unless you know for sure thatyou are near help
and you can hike throughthe snow. Here are some
things to do to summon help and
keep yourself and your
passengers safe:
Turn on your hazard flashers.
Tie a red cloth to your vehicle to alert police that
you’ve been stopped by the snow.
Put on extra clothing or wrap a blanket around you.
If you have no blankets or extra clothing, makebody
insulators from newspapers, burlap bags, rags, floor
mats -- anything you can wrap around yourself or
tuck under your clothing to keep warm.
You can run the engine to keepwarm, but be careful.
4-39
Snow can trapexhaust gases under your vehicle.
This cancause deadly CO (carbon monoxide) gas
to get inside. CO could overcome you and kill
you. You can’t see it orsmell it, so you might not
know it is in your vehicle. Clear away snow from
around thebase of your vehicle, especially any
that is blocking your exhaust pipe. And check
around again from
time to time to be sure snow
doesn’t collect there.
Open a window just a little on the side of the
vehicle that’s away from thewind. This will help
keep CO out.
4-40
Run your engine only as long as you must. This saves
fuel. When you run the engine, makeit go a little faster
than just idle. That is, push the accelerator slightly. This
uses less fuel for theheat that you get and it keeps the
battery (or batteries) charged. You will need a
well-charged battery (or batteries) to restart the vehicle,
and possibly for signaling later on with your headlamps.
Let the heater run for a while.
If you have a diesel engine, you may have to run it at a
higher speed to get enough heat. Then, shutthe engine
off and close the window almost all the way to preserve
the heat. Start the engine again and repeat this only
when you feel really uncomfortable from thecold. But
do it as little as possible. Preserve the fuel aslong as you
can. To help keep warm, you can get out of the vehicle
and do somefairly vigorous exercises everyhalf hour or
so until help comes.
Recreational Vehicle Towing
Two-Wheel-Drive Vehicles
There may be times when you want to tow your vehicle
behind another vehicle for use at your destination. Be
sure to use the proper towing equipment designedfor
recreational vehicle towing.Follow the instructions for
the towing equipment.
Two-wheel-drive vehicles should not be towed with
all four wheels on the ground. Two-wheel drive
transmissions have no provisions for internal lubrication
while being towed. To properly tow these vehicles, they
should be placed on a platform trailer with all four
wheels off the ground.
In rare cases when it’s unavoidable that a
two-wheel-drive vehicle is to be towed with all four
wheels on the ground, the propeller shaft to axle yoke
orientation should be marked and the propeller shaft
removed following the applicable servicemanual
removalhnstallation procedure.
Dust or dirtcan enter theback of the transmission
through the opening created by removing the propeller
shaft if proper protection is not provided. Also, check
the transmission fluid level before driving the truck.
4-41
Four-Wheel-Drive Vehicles
(Manual Transfer Case Only)
A CAUTION:
-Shifting the transfercase into NEUTRAL (N) can
cause your vehicle to roll even if the transmission
is in PARK (P), for anautomatic transmission, or
if your vehicle is in gear,for a manual
transmission. You or otherscould beinjured.
Make sure the parking
brake is firmly set before
you shift the transfercase into NEUTRAL (N).
Use the following procedure tocorrectly tow your
vehicle on all four wheels:
I
1. Firmly set the parking brake.
2. Place the transmission in PARK (P) or a manual
transmission in FIRST (1).
3. Securely attach the vehicle being towed to the
tow vehicle.
4. With the engine running, shift the transfer case to
NEUTRAL (N). See “Four-wheel Drive”in the
Index for the proper procedureto select the neutral
position for your vehicle.
5. Release the parking brake only after the vehicle
being towedis firmly attached to the towing vehicle.
6. Turn the ignition to OFF. The OFF position unlocks the
steering column and reduces battery drain.
Unlocking
the steering column will allow the proper movement of
the front wheels and tires during towing.
The Certificationmire label also tells you the maximum
weights for the front and rear axles, called Gross Axle
Weight Rating (GAWR). To find out the actual loads
on
your front and rear axles,you need to goto a weigh
station and weigh your vehicle. Your dealer can help
you with this. Be sure to spreadout your load equally on
both sides of the centerline.
Loading Your Vehicle
Never exceed the GVWR for your vehicle, or the
GAWR for eitherthe front or rear axle.
COLD TIRE PRESSURE
0 0
0 0
0 0
The CertificatiodTirelabel is found on the rear edge of
the driver’s door orin the Incomplete Vehicle Document
in the cab.
The label shows the size of your original tires and the
inflation pressures needed to obtain the grossweight
capacity of your vehicle. This is called the Gross Vehicle
Weight Rating (GVWR). The GVWR includesthe
weight of the vehicle, all occupants, fuel and cargo.
And, if you do have a heavy load, you should spread
it out.
In the case of a sudden stop or collision, things
carried in the bedof your truck could shift
forward and come into the passenger area,
injuring you and others.If you put things in the
bed of your truck, you should make sure they are
properly secured.
4-43
NOTICE: (Continued)
NOTICE:
Some vehicles may be
equipped with RPO VYU
(snow plowprep package). With this option, the
payload your vehicle can carry is reduced when a
snow plow isinstalled. Your vehiclecan be
damaged if either the frontor rearaxle ratings,
or the GVW are exceeded.
As a general.guideline, witha 650 (295 kg)
snow plow, the weight of the occupantsand cargo
mulet not exceed 300 lb. (135kg).However, this
may depend on the vehicle’s option content.
Therefore, to help avoid vehicle damaget
Make sure theweight on the front and
rear axles doesnot exceed their respective
axle ratings.
Total vehicle weightmust notexceed the
GVW rating.
NOTICE: (Continued)
0
If more eargo orpassengers need to be
carried, appropriate counter
ballast must
be installed rear of the rear axle and
properly secured.
See your dealer for advice and information
about using a snow plow onyour vehicle.
Ib.
Do not Ioad your vehicle any heavier than the
GVWR, or either the maximum fmnt orrear
G A M . If you do, parts on your vehicle can break,
or it can change the way your vehicle handles.
These could cause you to lose control.Also,
overloading canshorten the life of your vehicle.
Using heavier suspension componentsto get added
durability mightnot change your weight ratings. Ask
your dealer to help you load your vehicle the right way.
4-44
NOTICE:
I
Your warranty does not cover parts or
components that fail because of overloading.
If you put things inside your vehicle
-- like suitcases,
tools, packages, or anything else
-- they go as fast as the
vehicle goes. If you have to stop or
turn quickly, or if
there is a crash, they’ll keep
going.
A CAUT’3N:
Things you put inside your vehiclecan strike and
injure people in a sudden stopor turn,or in a crash.
0 Put things in the cargo area
of your vehicle.
Try to spread theweight evenly.
0 Never stack heavier things, like suitcases,
inside the vehicle so that some of them are
above the tops of the seats.
0 Don’t leave an unsecured child restraint in
your vehicle.
CAUTION: (Continued)
0
When you carry something inside the
vehicle, secure itwhenever you can.
Don’t leave a seatfolded down unlessyou
need to.
There’s also importantloading information foroff-road
driving in this manual. See “LoadingYour Vehicle for
Off-Road Driving”in the Index.
Truck-Camper Loading Information
This label is inside your glove box.will
It tell you if
your vehicle can carry a slide-in camper,
how much of a
load your vehicle cancarry, and how to correctly spread
out your load.Also, it will help you match the right
slide-in camper toyour vehicle.
When you carry a slide-in camper, the
total cargo load
of your vehicle is the weight
of the camper,plus
everything else added tothe camper after it left
the factory,
0
everything in the camper and
0
all the people inside.
4-45
The CargoWeight Rating (CWR) is the maximum
weight of the load your vehicle can carry. It doesn’t
include theweight of the people inside. But, you can
figure about 150 lbs. (68 kg) for each seat.
The total cargo load must not be more than your
vehicle’s CWR.
Here is an exampleof proper truck and campermatch:
p
-
4
Refer to the Truck Camper LoadingInformation label
in glove box for dimensions A and B as shown in the
following illustration.
A. Camper Centerof Gravity
B. Recommended Center of Gravity Location Zone
The camper’s center of gravity should fall within the
center of gravity zone for your vehicle’s cargo load.
Use the rear edge of the load floor for measurement
purposes. The recommended location for the cargo center
of gravity is at point C for the CWR. It is the point where
the mass of a body is concentrated and, if suspended at
that point, would balance the front and rear.
4-46
You must weigh any accessories or other equipmentthat
you add to your vehicle. Then, subtract this extra weight
from the CWR. This extraweight may shorten the
center of gravity zone of your vehicle. Your dealer can
help you with this.
If your slide-in camper and its load weighs less
than the
CWR, the centerof gravity zone for your vehiclemay
be larger.
When you install and load your slide-in camper, check
the manufacturer’s instructions.
Your dealer can help you make a good vehicle-camper
match. He’ll alsohelp you determine your CWR.
weights, Cargo Weight Rating and the correct centerof
gravity zone for your vehicle, your dealer can help you.
Just ask fora copy of “Consumer Information,
Truck-Camper Loading.”
After you’ve loaded your vehicle and camper, drive ato
weigh station and weigh the front and rear wheels
separately. This will tell you the loads on your axles.
The loads on the front and rear axles shouldn’t be more
than either of the GAWRs. The total of the axle loads
should not be more than the GVWR.
Open your driver’s door and look at the
CertificatiodTire label to find out your GAWR
and GVWR.
If you’ve gone overyour weight ratings, moveor take
out some thingsuntil all the weight falls below the
ratings. Of course, you should always tie down any
loose items when you load your vehicleor camper.
If you want more information on curb weights, cargo
Trailer Recommendations
You must subtract your hitch loadsfrom the CWR for
your vehicle. Weigh your vehicle with the trailer attached,
so that you won’t go over the GVWR or GAWR.
You’ll get the best performance if you spread out the
weight of your load the right way, and if you choose the
correct hitch and trailer brakes.
For more information, see “Trailer Towing” in the Index.
4-47
Camper Wiring Harness
(If Equipped)
Brown: Rear Lamps
Yellow: Left Stoplamp and Turn Signal
Dark Green: Right Stoplamp and Turn Signal
White (Heavy Gage): Ground
Light Green: Back-up Lamps
When the harness is not being used, store it inits
original place. Wrap the harness together and tie it
neatly so it won’t be damaged.
Pickup Conversion to Chassis Cab
A five-wire harness is stored under your vehicle. The
harness is located inside the frame rail and is even with
the front of the pickup box. This harness has a 30 amp
battery feed wire and no connector, and should be wired
by a qualified electrical technician. After choosing an
aftermarket mating connector pair, have the technician
attach one connector to the five-wire camper harness and
the other connector to the wiring harness for the camper.
The technician can usethe following color code chart
when connecting the wiring harness to your camper.
4-48
General Motorsis aware that some vehicle owners
may consider having the pickup box removed and a
commercial or recreational body installed. Before you
do so, first contact the GM Zone Office for
your area for
information on such conversions specificto this vehicle.
(See the “Warranty and Owner Assistance” booklet for
Zone Office.) Owners should be aware that, as
manufactured, there are differences between a chassis
cab and a pickup with the box removed which may
affect vehicle safety. The components necessary to adapt
a pickup to permit its safe use with a specialized body
should be installed by a body builder in accordance with
the information available from the Zone Office.
Towing a Tri --.er
NOTICE:
A CAUTION:
If you don’t use the correct equipment and drive
properly, you can lose control when you pull a
trailer. For example, if the traileris too heavy, the
brakes may not work well or even at all. You
and yourpassengers could be seriously injured.
Pull a trailer only if you have followed all the
steps in thissection. Askyour dealerfor advice
and information abouttowing a trailer with
your vehicle.
--
Pulling a trailer improperly candamage your
vehicle and result in costly repairs not covered by
your warranty. To pull a trailer correctly, follow
the advice in this part, andsee your dealer for
important information abouttowing a trailer
with your vehicle.
Every vehicle is ready for some trailer towing. If yours
was built with trailering options, as many are, it’s ready
for heavier trailers. But trailering is different than just
driving your vehicle by itself. Trailering means changes
in handling, durability and fuel economy. Successful,
safe trailering takes correct equipment, and it has to be
used properly.
That’s the reason for this part. In it are many
time-tested, important trailering tips and safety rules.
Many of these are important for your
safety and that of
your passengers. So please read this section carefully
before you pull a trailer.
4-49
If you have an automatic transmission, you can tow
in OVERDRIVE (03).You may want to shift the
transmission to THIRD (3) or, if necessary, a lower
If You Do Decide To Pull A Trailer
If you do, here are some important points:
0
There aremany different laws, including speed limit
restrictions, having to do with trailering. Make sure
your rig will be legal, not only where you live but
also where you’ll be driving. A good source for this
information can be state or provincial police.
0
Consider using a sway control if your trailer will
weigh less than the capacity stamped on your step
bumper. You should always use a sway control if
your trailer will weigh more than the capacity
stamped on your step bumper. You can ask a hitch
dealer about sway controls.
0
0
gear selection if the transmission shifts too often
(e.g., under heavy loads and/or hilly conditions). If
you have a manual transmission and you are towing
a trailer, it’s better not to use FIFTH ( 5 ) gear. Just
drive in FOURTH (4) gear (or, as you need to, a
lower gear).
Three important considerations have to do with weight:
the weight of the trailer,
the weight of the trailer tongue
0
and the weight on your vehicle’s tires.
Don’t tow a trailer at all during the first 500 miles
(800 km) your new vehicle is driven. Your engine,
axle or other parts could be damaged.
How heavy can a trailer safely be?
Then, during the first 500 miles (800 km) that you
tow a trailer, don’t drive over 50 mph (80 kmh) and
don’t make starts at full throttle. This helps your
engine and other parts of your vehicle wear in at the
heavier loads.
It depends on how you plan to use your rig. For
example, speed,altitude, road grades, outside
temperature and how much your vehicle is used to pull a
trailer are all important. And, it can also depend on any
special equipment that you have on your vehicle.
4-50
Weight of the Trailer
Use one of the following chartsto determine how much
your vehicle canweigh, based upon your vehicle model
and options.
C-1500 (2WD)
Engine(Trans.)AxleRatio
Max. Trailer Wt.
(Auto.)
4.3L
Maximum trailer weightis calculated assuming the
driver and one passenger are inthe tow vehicle and it
has all the requiredtrailering equipment. The weight of
4.3L (Manual)
additional optional equipment, passengersand cargo in
the tow vehicle must be subtracted from the maximum
trailer weight.
3.08
4,000 lbs. (1 800 kg)
3.42
5,000 lbs. (2 270 kg)
3.08
Above the 2,000lbs. (908 kg) trailer rating,the engine
oil cooler is required on C/K- 1500 and C/K-2500
models with gas engines. Refer to the Trailering Guide
for oil cooler recommendations.
5.0L (Auto.)
3.08
Above the 5,000 lbs. (2 270kg) trailer rating,
heavy-duty or gas shock absorbers arerequired on
C - 1500 models, and heavy-duty shock absorbers
or the off-road chassis package are required on
K-1500 models.
5 .OL (Manual)
2,000 lbs. (908 kg)
2,500 lbs. (1 135 kg)
3,000 lbs. (1 362 kg)
4,500 lbs. (2 043 kg)
5,500 lbs. (2 497 kg)
6,500 lbs. (2 951 kg)
2,000 lbs. (908 kg)
3,000 lbs. (1 362 kg)
5,000 lbs. (2 270 kg)
6,000 lbs. (2 724 kg)
7,000 lbs. ( 3 178 kg)
3 -42
3.73
3.42
3.73
3.08
3.42
5.7L
3.08
3.42
3.73
4-51
K-1500 (4WD)
C-2500 (2WD)
Engine (Trans.) Axle Ratio Max. Trailer Wt.
4.3L (Auto.)
3.73
5,000 lbs. (2 270 kg)
4.3L (Manual)
3.73
2,500 lbs. (1 135 kg)
5.0L (Auto.)
3.42
5,000 lbs. (2 270 kg)
5.0L (Manual)
5.7L
6.5L Diesel
3.73
6,000 lbs. (2 724 kg)
3.42
3.73
2,500 lbs. (1 135 kg)
3.42
3.73
3.42
3.73
5,500 lbs. (2 497 kg)
6,500 lbs. (2 951 kg)
6,000 lbs.(2 724 kg)
7,000 lbs. (3 178 kg)
3,500 lbs. (1 589 kg)
Engine(Trans.)AxleRatio
5.0L3.42
(Auto.)
3.73
5 .OL (Manual)
3.42
3.73
3.42
5.7L
3.73
4.10
6.5L Diesel
3.42
3.73
4.10
7.4L
3.73
4.10
Max. Trailer Wt.
5,500 lbs. (2 497 kg)
6,500 lbs. (2 951 kg)
3,000 lbs. (1 362 kg)
4,000 lbs. (1 800 kg)
6,000 lbs.(2 724 kg)
7,000 1bs.T (3 178 kg)
8,000 lbs. (3 632 kg)
6,500 lbs.(2 951 kg)
7,500 1bs.T (3 405 kg)
8,500 lbs.(3 859 kg)
9,000 lbs. (4 086 kg)
11O
, OO lbs.* (4 994 kg)
+Vehicles with 8600 GVWRsubtract 500 lbs. (227 kg).
*Fifth wheel hitch rating; weight distributing hitch
rating is limited to10,000 lbs. (4 540 kg).
4-52
K-3500 (4WD)
K-2500 (4WD)
Engine(Trans.)AxleRatioMax.TrailerWt.
4.10
6,000 lbs. (2 724 kg)
5.7L
4.107,500
6.5L Diesel
7.4L
Engine(Trans.)AxleRatioMax.TrailerWt.
3.73
4.10
lbs. (3 405 kg)
6,500 lbs. (2 951 kg)
8,000 lbs. (3 632 kg)
3.73
8,500 Ibs. (3 859 kg)
4.1010,500
lbs.* (4767 kg)
5.7L
6.5L Diesel
4.10
7,500
7.4L
4.10
lbs.405
(3
10,000 lbs. (4 540 kg)
12,OOO lbs.* (5 448 kg)
4.56
*Fifth wheel hitch rating; weight distributing hitch
rating is limited to 10,000 lbs. (4 540kg).
Engine(Trans.)AxleRatioMax.TrailerWt.
C-3500 (2WD)
lbs. (3 178 kg)
7,000
4.10
5.7L
Engine(Trans.)AxleRatioMax.TrailerWt.
405 (3 lbs.
7,500
4.10
5.7L
kg)
C-3500 Crew Cab (2WD)
*Fifth wheelhitch rating; weight distributing hitch
rating is limited to 10,000 lbs. (4 540kg).
6.5L Diesel
7.4L
7,000 lbs. (3 178 kg)
4.56
kg)
4.56
9,000 lbs. (4086 kg)
4.10
8,000 lbs. (3 632 kg)
4.1010,500
lbs.* (4767 kg)
4.5612,500
lbs.* (5 675 kg)
6.5L Diesel
7.4L
8,500 lbs. (3 859 kg)
4.108,000
4.1010,500
4.5612,500
lbs. (3 632 kg)
lbs.* (4767 kg)
lbs.* (5 675 kg)
*Fifth wheel hitch rating; weight distributing hitch
rating is limited to 10,000 lbs. (4 540kg).
"Fifth wheel hitch rating; weight distributing hitch
rating is limited to 10,000 lbs. (4 540 kg).
4-53
K-3500 Crew Cab (4WD)
Engine (Trans.)
5.7L
6.5L Diesel
7.4L
Axle
RatioMax.Trailer
Wt.
4.10
6,500 lbs. (2 95 1 kg)
4.56 8,000 lbs. (3 632 kg)
4.107,500
lbs. (3 405 kg)
4.10
10,OOO lbs. (4 540 kg)
4.56
12,000lbs.* (5 448 kg)
*Fifth wheel hitch rating; weight distributing hitch
rating is limited to 10,000 lbs. (4 540 kg).
C-3500 HD Chassis Cab
Axle
Engine
(Trans.)
Ratio
Max.
Trailer
Wt.
6.5L Diesel (Auto.)
4.63
5.13
4.63
7.4L
5.13
9,000 lbs. (4 086kg)
10,OOO lbs. (4 540 kg)
12,000lbs." (5 448kg)
12,000 lbs." (5 448 kg)
*Fifth wheel hitch rating; weight distributing hitch
rating is limited to 10,000 lbs. (4 540 kg).
You can ask your dealer for our trailering information or
advice, or you can write us at the address listed in your
Warranty and Owner Assistance Information Booklet.
In Canada, write to:
General Motors of Canada Limited
Customer Communication Centre
1908 Colonel Sam Drive
Oshawa, OntarioL 1H 8P7
Weight of the Trailer Tongue
The tongue load (A) of any trailer is an important
weight to measure because it affects the total or gross
weight of your vehicle. The Gross Vehicle Weight
(GVW) includes the curb weight of the vehicle, any
cargo you may carry in it, and the people who will be
riding in the vehicle. And if you will tow a trailer, you
must add the tongue load to the GVW because your
vehicle will be carrying that weight, too. See "Loading
Your Vehicle" in the Index for more information about
your vehicle's maximum load capacity.
Total Weight onYour Vehicle’s Tires
Be sure your vehicle’s tires are inflated tothe upper
limit for coldtires. You’ll find these numbers on the
Certification label at the rear edgeof the driver’s door or
see “Tire Loading” in the Index. Then be sureyou don’t
go over theGVW limit for yourvehicle, including the
weight of the trailer tongue.
A
B
If you’re using a weight-carrying hitch, the trailer
tongue (A) should weigh 10 percent of the total loaded
trailer weight (B). If you’re using a weight-distributing
hitch, the trailer tongue(A) should weigh 12 percent of
the total loaded trailer weight (B).
After you’ve loaded your trailer, weigh the trailer and
then the tongue, separately, to see if the weights are
proper, If they aren’t, you may be able to get them right
simply by moving some items aroundin the trailer.
Hitches
It’s important tohave the correct hitch equipment.
Crosswinds, large trucks goingby and rough roads are a
few reasons why you’ll need the right hitch. Here are
some rules to follow:
0
If you use a step-bumper hitch, your bumper could
be damaged in sharp turns. Make sure you have
ample room when turning to avoid contactbetween
the trailer and the bumper.
0
If you’ll be pulling a trailer that, when loaded, will
weigh more than the capacity stamped on your step
bumper, be sure to use a properly mounted,
weight-distributing hitch and sway controlof the
proper size. This equipmentis very important for
proper vehicle loading and good handling when
you’re driving.
4-55
Safety Chains
You should always attach chains between your vehicle
and your trailer. Cross the safety chains under the tongue
of the trailerso that the tongue will not drop to the road
if it becomes separated fromthe hitch. Instructions
about safety chains may be providedby the hitch
manufacturer or by the trailermanufacturer. Follow the
manufacturer’s recommendation for attaching safety
chains and do not attach them to the bumper. Always
leave justenough slack so you can turn with your rig.
And, never allow safety chains to drag onthe ground.
Trailer Brakes
If your trailer weighs more than 1,000 lbs. (450 kg)
loaded, then it needs its own brakes -- and they must be
adequate. Be sure to read and follow the instructions for
the trailer brakesso you’ll be able to install, adjustand
maintain them properly.
Your trailer brake system can tap intothe vehicle’s
hydraulic brake system only if:
0
The trailer parts can withstand 3,000 psi
(20 650 kPa) of pressure.
4-56
The trailer’s brake system will use less than
0.02 cubic inch (0.3 cc) of fluid from your vehicle’s
master cylinder. Otherwise, both braking systems
won’t work well. You could even loseyour brakes.
If everything checks outthis far, make the brake tap at
the port on the master cylinder that sends the fluid to the
rear brakes. But don’t use copper tubing for this. If you
do, it will bend and finally break off. Use steel
brake tubing.
Driving with a Trailer
Towing a trailer requires a certain amount of experience.
Before setting out for the open road, you’ll want to get
to know your rig. Acquaint yourself with the feel of
handling and braking with the added weight of the
trailer. And always keep in mind that the vehicle you are
driving is now a good deal longer and not nearly as
responsive as your vehicle is by itself.
Before you start, check the trailer hitch and platform
(and attachments), safety chains, electrical connector,
lamps, tires and mirror adjustment. If the trailer has
electric brakes, start your vehicle and trailer moving and
then apply the trailer brake controller by hand to be sure
the brakes are working. This lets you check your
electrical connection at the same time.
During your trip, check occasionallybetosure that the
load is secure, and that the lamps and
any trailer brakes
are still working.
Following Distance
Stay at leasttwice as far behind the vehicle ahead as you
would when driving your vehicle without a trailer. This
can help you avoid situationsthat require heavy braking.
and sudden turns.
Making Turns
NOTICE:
Making very sharp turns while trailering could
cause the trailerto come in contact with the
vehicle. Your vehicle could be damaged. Avoid
making very sharp turns while trailering.
Passing
You’ll need more passing distance up ahead when
you’re towing atrailer. And, because you’re agood deal
longer, you’ll need to go much farther beyond the
passed vehicle before you can return to your lane.
When you’re turning witha trailer, make wider turns than
normal. Do this so your trailer won’t strike soft shoulders,
curbs, road signs, treesor other objects. Avoid jerky or
sudden maneuvers. Signal well in advance.
Backing Up
Turn Signals When Towing a Trailer
Hold the bottom of the steering wheelwith one hand.
Then, to move the trailer to the left, just move
that hand
to the left. To move the trailerto the right, move your
hand to the right. Always backup slowly and, if
possible, have someone guideyou.
The arrows on your instrument panelwill flash
whenever you signal a turn or lane change. Properly
hooked up, the trailer lamps will also flash, tellingother
drivers you’re aboutto turn, change lanesor stop.
When towing a trailer, the arrows on your instrument
panel will flash forturns even if the bulbs on the trailer are
burned out. Thus, you maythink drivers behind you are
seeing your signal when they are not.
It’s important to
check occasionally tobe sure the trailer bulbs are
still working.
4-57
Driving On Grades
Reduce speed and shift toa lower gear before you start
down a longor steep downgrade.If yc I don’t shift
down, you might have to use your brc1.
3s so much that
they would get hot and no longer wor! . well.
On a long uphill grade, shift downand reduce your
speed toaround 45 mph (70 M h ) to reduce the
possibility of engine andtransmission overheating.
If you have an automatictransmission, you can tow in
AUTOMATIC OVERDRIVE (@).You may want to
shift the transmission to THIRD(3) or, if necessary, a
lower gear selection if the transmission shifts too often
(e.g., under heavy loads and/orhilly conditions).
If you have a manual transmission and you are towing a
trailer, it’s better not to use FIFTH (5) gear. Just drivein
FOURTH (4) gear (or, as you need to, a lower gear).
When towing at high altitude on steepuphill grades,
consider the following: Engine coolantwill boil at a
lower temperature than at normal altitudes. If you turn
your engine off immediately after towing at high altitude
on steep uphill grades, your vehicle may show signs
similar to engine overheating. To avoid this, let the
engine run while parked (preferably on level ground)
4-58
with the automatic transmission in PARK (P) (or the
manual transmission out of gear and the parking brake
applied) for a fewminutes before turning the engine off.
If you do get the overheat warning, see “Engine
Overheating” in the Index.
Parking on Hills
You really should not park your vehicle, with a trailer
attached, on a hill. If something goeswrong, your rig
could start to move. People can be injured, and both
your vehicle and the trailer can be damaged.
But if you ever haveto park your rig on a hill, here’s
how to do it:
1. Apply your regular brakes, but don’t shift into
PARK (P) yet for an automatic transmission, or into
gear for a manual transmission.
2. Have someone place chocks underthe trailer wheels.
3. When the wheel chocks are in place, release the
regular brakesuntil the chocks absorbthe load.
4. Reapply the regular brakes. Then apply your parking
brake and shift into PARK (P) for an automatic
transmission, or REVERSE (R) for manual
a
transmission.
5 . If you have a four-wheel-drive vehicle,
drive gear andnot
be sure the transfer case isain
in NEUTRAL (N).
6. Release the regular brakes.
I
w
\ CAUTION:
When You Are Ready to Leave After
Parking on a Hill
1. Apply your regular brakes and hold the pedal down
while you:
0
Start your engine;
0
Shift into a gear; and
Release the parking brake.
It can be dangerous to get out of your vehicle if
the shift lever is not fully in PARK (P) with the
parking brake firmly set. Your vehiclecan roll.
If you have left the engine running, thevehicle
can move suddenly. You or otherscould be
injured. To be sure your vehicle won’t move, even
when you’re on fairly level ground, use the steps
that follow.
If you have four-wheel drive and your transfer
case is in NEUTRAL (N),your vehicle will be free
to roll, even if your shift lever is inPARK (P). So,
be sure the transfer
case is in a drive gear not
in NEUTRAL (N).
--
2. Let up on the brake pedal.
3. Drive slowly until the trailer is clear of the chocks.
4. Stop and have someone pick up and store the chocks.
Maintenance When Trailer Towing
Your vehicle will need service more often when you’re
pulling atrailer. See the Maintenance Schedulefor more
on this. Things that are especially importantin trailer
operation are automatic transmission fluid (don’t
overfill), engine oil, axle lubricant,belt, cooling system
and brake adjustment. Eachof these is covered in this
manual, and the Index will help you find them quickly.
If you’re trailering, it’s a good idea to review these
sections beforeyou start yourtrip.
Check periodically to see that all hitch nuts and bolts
are tight.
4-59
Trailer Wiring Harness
C
This harness has a 30 amp battery feed wire and no
connector, and should be wired by a qualified electrical
technician. After choosing an aftermarket mating
connector pair, have the technician attach one connector
to the eight-wire trailer
harness and theother connector
to the wiring harness on the trailer. Be sure that the
wiring harness on the trailer is strapped to thetrailer’s
frame and leaveit loose enough so that the wiring
doesn’t bend orbreak, but not so loose that it drags on
the ground. The technician can use thefollowing color
code chart when connecting the wiring harness to
your trailer.
a Brown: Rear Lamps
a Yellow: Left Stoplamp andTurn Signal
0
Dark Green: Right Stoplampand Turn Signal
A. Light-Duty Wiring Harness
a White (Heavy Gauge): Ground
B. Additional Heavy-Duty Wiring
a Light Green: Back-up Lamps
C. Tie Straps
a White (Light Gauge): Center High-Mounted
A eight-wire harness is stored under therear end of your
vehicle. Five wires (A) are located between the rear
bumper and the spare tire, near the center. This wiring
harness is tie-strapped to the taillamp and stoplamp
harness. Three wires (B) (light gauge white,blue and
orange) arelocated at therear left hand frame rail.
4-60
Stop Lamp
0
Blue: AuxiliaryElectric TrailerBrake Circuit
a Orange: FusedAuxiliary Circuit
Store the harness in its originalplace. Wrap the harness
together andtie it neatly so it won’t be damaged.
Power Winches
If you wish to use a power winch on your vehicle, only
use it when your vehicleis stationary or anchored.
Power Take-Off (PTO)
(Manual Tral--mission)
NOTICE:
NOTICE:
Using a power winch with the transmissionin
gear may damage the transmission.When
operating a power winch, always leave the
transmission in NEUTRAL (N).
Use the regular brakes, set the parking brake, or block
the wheels to keep your vehicle from rolling.
If you have a PTO thatwill exceed35 hp installed
on yourvehicle, it could damage the transfercase
or transmission. When having a PTO installed on
your vehicle, make surethat it will not exceed
35 hp.
Before using aPTO, refer to the manufacturer’s or
installer’s instructions.
NOTICE:
Using a PTO while operating in one placebefore
the vehicle has reached normal operating
temperature can damage the transfer
case or
transmission. If you will be usingthe PTOwhile
operating in one place, drive and warm up the
vehicle before using the PTO.
4-61
To engage aFTO:
To engage a PTO while the vehicle is moving:
1. Hold the clutch pedal down.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
2. Set the parking brake.
3. Shift the transmission into NEUTRAL (N).
4. Engage the PTO.
NOTICE:
Using a PTO for more than four hours without
driving your vehicle can damage the transfer case
or transmission.If using a PTO for more than
four hours without driving your vehicle, drive
your vehicle fora while to allow the transfer case
and transmissionto cool.
If you are going to drive the vehicle, shift the
transfer case into therange you want (if you have
four-wheel drive). Then shift thetransmission into
the gear you want, apply the regular brakes and
release the parking brake.
5. Release the clutch (and the regular brakes) asyou
normally would. When you release the clutch, the
PTO will start.
4-62
Hold the clutch pedal down.
Shift the transmission into NEUTRAL (N).
Engage the PTO.
Shift the transmission into the gear you want.
Release the clutch as you normally would. When you
release the clutch, the PTO will start.
Using a Transfer Case MountedPower
Take-Off (Manual Transmir
-' -I)
-
1.
2.
3.
4.
Hold the clutch pedal down.
Set the parking brake.
Shift the transfer case into NEUTRAL(N).
If the vehicle will remain in the sameplace, shift the
transmission into the highest gear.
5. Engage the PTO.
If you are going to drive the vehicle, shift the
transmission into the gear you want. Then shift the
transfer case into the range you want, apply the
regular brakes and release the parking brake.
6. Release the clutch (and the regular brakes) as you
normally would. When you release the clutch, the
PTO will start.
Using a Transfer Case Mounted Power
Take-Off (Automatic Transmission)
1. Set the parking brake.
2. Turn the ignition off.
3. Shift the transfer case into NEUTRAL
(N).
(N).
4. Shift the transmission into NEUTRAL
5. Engage thePTO.
If you are going to drive the vehicle, shift the
transfer case into the range
you want. Turn the
ignition to START. Then apply the regular brakes
and release the parking brake.
Step-Bumper Pad
If your vehicle hasa rear stepbumper, it may be
equipped with a rear step pad at the center
of
the bumper.
If you will be using the
bumper to towa trailer, you
must remove the center
cutout circle to install the
trailer ball.You must also
remove both outer cutouts
to attach the trailer
safety chains.
(3) to start the' PTO.
6. Shift the transmission to THIRD
7. Release the regular brakesto drive the vehicle.
Disengaging a Power Take-OFF
1. Turn the ignition off.
2. Put the transmission inPARK (P).
3. Release the PTO
4. Restart the engine.
To remove the pad, lift the
edge of the pad from the
rear of the bumper and
swing it forward. When the
pad releases from the
bumper holes, lift the
pad off.
4-63
NOTES
4-64
Section 5 Problems on the Road
Here you’ll find what to do about some problems that can occur on the roaa.
5-2
5-3
5-3
5-8
5-13
Hazard Warning Flashers
Other Warning Devices
Jump Starting
Towing Your Vehicle
Engine Overheating (Gasoline Engine)
5- 15
5-23
5-23
5 -24
5-36
Cooling System-- Gasoline Engines
Engine Fan Noise
If a Tire Goes Flat
Changing a Flat Tire
If You’re Stuck: In Sand, Mud,Ice or Snow
5-1
Hazard Warning Flashers
Press the button at the top
of the steering column all
the way down to make your
front and rear turn signal
lamps flash on and off.
Your hazard warning flashers work no matter what
position your key is in, and even if the key isn’t in.
To turn off the flashers, press the button until the first
click and release.
Your hazard warning flashers letyou warn others. They
also letpolice know you have a problem. Your front and
rear turn signal lampswill flash on and off.
But they won’t flash if you’re braking.
5-2
When the hazard warning flashers areon, your turn
signals won’t work.
Other Warning Devices
If you carry reflective triangles, you can use them to
warn others. Set one up at the side of the road about
300 feet (100 m) behind your vehicle.
Jump Starting
If your battery (or batteries) have run down, you may
want to use another vehicle and some jumper cablesto
start your vehicle. But please use the following stepsto
do it safely.
Ignoring these steps could result in costly damage
to your vehicle that wouldn’t be covered by your
vehicle warranty.
Rying to startyour vehicle by pushing or pulling it
won’t work, and it could damage your vehicle.
1 Check the other vehicle. It must have a 12-volt
battery with a negative ground system.
NOTICE:
Batteries canhurt you. They can be
dangerous because:
They contain acid that can burn you.
They contain gas that can explode or ignite.
They contain enough electricity to burn you.
If you don’t followthese steps exactly, some or all
of these things can hurt you.
If the othersystem isn’t a 12-volt system with a
negative ground, both vehicles can be damaged.
5-3
2. Get the vehicles close enough so the jumper cables
can reach, but be sure the vehicles aren’t touching
each other. If they are, it could cause a ground
connection you don’t want. You wouldn’t be able
to startyour vehicle, and the bad grounding could
damage the electrical systems.
To avoid the possibility of the vehicles rolling, set
the parking brake firmly on both vehicles involved
in the jump start procedure. Put an automatic
transmission in PARK (P) or a manualtransmission
in NEUTRAL (N). If you have afour-wheel-drive
vehicle, be sure the transfer case isnot in
NEUTRAL (N).
3. Turn off the ignition on both vehicles. Unplug
unnecessary accessories plugged intothe cigarette
lighter or accessory power outlets. Turn off all lamps
that aren’t needed as well as radios. This will avoid
sparks and help save both batteries. In addition, it
could save yourradio!
’’
5-4
NOTICE:
If you leaveyour radioon, it could be badly
damaged. The repairswouldn’t be covered by
your warranty.
4. Open the hoods and locate the batteries. Find the
positive (+) and negative (-) terminals on each battery.
r
If your vehicle has air conditioning, the auxiliary
electric fan under thehood can startup even
when the engine is not running and can injure
you. Keep hands, clothing and tools awayfrom
any underhoodelectric fan.
A CAUTION:
5. Check that the jumper cables don’t have loose or
missing insulation.If they do, you could get a shock.
L The vehicles could be damaged too.
Using a match near a battery cancause battery
gas to explode. Peoplehave been hurt doing this,
and some have been blinded. Use a flashlight if
you need more light.
Be sure the batterieshave enough water. You
don’t need to add water to the
ACDelco
Freedom@ battery (or batteries)
installed in
every new GM vehicle. But if a battery hasfiller
caps, be sure the right amount
of fluid is there. If
it is low, add water to take care
of that first. If
you don’t, explosive gas could be present.
Battery fluid containsacid that can burn you.
Don’t getit on you. If you accidentally get it in
your eyes or on your skin, flush the place with
water andget medicalhelp immediately.
Before you connect the cables, here are some
basic things you should know. Positive (+) will
go to positive (+) and negative(-) will go to a
metal engine part.Don’t connect positive(+) to
negative (-) or you’ll get a short thatwould
damage the battery and maybe other partstoo.
On vehicles equipped with dual batteries, makeany
battery connections tothe primary battery located on
the passenger’s side of the vehicle.
’A
CAUTION:
Fans or othermoving engine parts can injure you
badly. Keep your handsaway from moving parts
once the engine is running.
5-5
I
I .:I
6. Connect the red positive (+) cable to the positive (+)
terminal of the vehicle with the dead battery.
5-6
7. Don't let the other end
touch metal. Connect itto
thepositive (+) terminal
8. Now connect the black
negative (-) cable to
the good battery’s
negative (-) cable.
Don’t let the other end touch anything until the next
step. The otherend of the negative (-) cable doesn’t go
to the dead battery. It goes to a heavy unpainted metal
part of the vehicle with the dead battery.
9. Attach the cable at least 18 inches (45 cm) away
from the dead battery, but not near engine parts that
move. The electrical connection is just as good
there, but the chance of sparks gettingback to the
battery is much less.
10. Now start the vehicle with the good battery and run
the engine for awhile.
5-7
11. Try to start the vehicle with the dead battery.
If it won’t start after a few tries, it probably
needs service.
12. Remove the cables in reverse order to prevent
electrical shorting. Take care that they don’t touch
each otheror any other metal.
Towing Your Vehicle
Try to have your GM dealer or aprofessional towing
service tow your vehicle. See “RoadsideAssistance” in
the Index.
If your vehicle has been changed sinceit was
factory-new, by adding such things as fog lamps, aero
skirting, or special tires and wheels, these instructions
may not be correct.
Before you do anything, turn on the hazard
warning flashers.
When you call, tell the towing service:
I
IA. Heavy Metal Engine Part
B. Good Battery
C . Dead Battery
5-8
c
0
That your vehicle has rear-wheel-drive, or that it has
the four-wheel-drive option.
0
The make, model and year of your vehicle.
0
Whether you can move the shift lever for the
transmission and transfer case, if you have one.
0
If there was an accident, what was damaged.
When the towing service arrives, let the tow operator
know that this manual contains detailed towing
instructions and illustrations. The operator may want to
see them.
To help avoid injury toyou or others:
Never let passengers ride in a vehicle that is
being towed.
Never tow faster than safe or posted speeds.
Never tow with damaged parts not
fully secured.
Never get under your vehicle after ithas
been lifted by the tow truck.
Always use separate safety chains on each
side when towinga vehicle.
For pickups (except cab chassis models),
use T-hookson front of vehicle, J-hooks
on rear.
For cab chassis models, use f-hooks on
front and rearof vehicle.
A vehicle can fall froma car carrierif it isn’t
adequately secured. This cancause a collision,
serious personal injury and
vehicle damage. The
vehicle should be tightly secured with chains or
steel cablesbefore it is transported.
Don’t use substitutes (ropes, leather straps,
canvas webbing, etc.) that can be cut by sharp
edges underneath the towed vehicle.
Don’t have yourvehicle towed on the drivewheels
unless you must. If the vehicle must be towed on the
drive wheels, be sure to follow the speed and distance
restrictions laterin this section or yourtransmission will
be damaged. If these limitationsmust be exceeded,then
the drive wheels have to be supported on adolly.
5-9
Front Towing
3. Clamp the steering wheel in a straight-ahead position
with a clamping device designed for towing service.
(Do not use the vehicle’s steering column lock for this.)
4. Put an automatic or a manual transmission in
NEUTRAL (N).
5. When the vehicle is hooked up, release the
parking brake.
Four- Wheel-Drive Vehicles (Manual
ma---fer Case)
Tow Limits -- 55 mph (88 km/h) or legal speed limit,
distance is unlimited
If your vehicle is four-wheel drive with a manual
transfer case, use the following directions:
1. Engage the parking brake.
2. Turn the ignition key to OFF.
Two-Wheel-Drive Vehicles
Tow Limits -- 35 mph (55 km/h), 50 miles (80k d h )
If your vehicle is two-wheel drive, use the
following directions:
1 . Engage the parking brake.
2. Turn the ignition key to OFF.
5-10
3. Clamp the steering wheel in a straight-ahead position
with a clamping device designed for towing service.
(Do not use the vehicle’s steering column lock forthis.)
4. Put an automatic transmission in PARK (P), or a
manual transmission in FIRST (I).
5 . Put the transfer case in NEUTRAL(N). See
“Four-wheel Drive” in the Index for the proper
procedure to select NEUTRAL(N).
6. When the vehicle is hooked up, release the
parking brake.
Four- Wheel Drive-Vehicles (Electronic
Transfer Case)
Tow Limits -- 35 mph (55 k h ) , 50 miles (80 km/h)
If your vehicle is four-wheel drive withan electronic
transfer case, use the following directions:
1. Engage the parking brake.
2. Turn the ignition key to OFF.
4. Put the transmission in NEUTRAL (N).
5. Put the transfer case in 2 High (2HI).
6. When the vehicle is hooked up, release the
parking brake.
NOTICE:
If your vehicleis equipped with an electronic
transfer case and the tow limits must be
exceeded, a towing dolly must
be used under the
rear wheels or vehicle/powertrain damage
will occur.
3. Clamp the steering wheel in a straight-ahead position
with a clamping device designed for towing service.
(Do not use the vehicle’s steering column lock forthis.)
5-11
~~
Rear Towing
2. Engage the parking brake.
3. Clamp the steering wheelin a straight-ahead position
with a clamping device designed for towing service.
(Do not use the vehicle’s steering column lock for this.)
4. Put an automatic transmission in PARK (P), or a
manual transmission in FIRST (1).
5. When the vehicle is hooked up, release the
parking brake.
Four- Wheel-Drive Vehicles (Manual Transfer Case)
Tow Limits -- 35 mph (55 k h ) , 50 miles (80 k h )
If your vehicle is four-wheel drive with a manual
transfer case, use the following directions:
1 . Engage the parking brake.
Two-Wheel-Drive Vehicles
Tow Limits -- 55 mph (88 kmdh) or legal speed limit,
distance is unlimited
If your vehicle is two-wheel drive, usethe
following directions:
I. Turn the ignition key to OFF.
5-12
2. Turn the ignition key to ON.
3. Clamp the steering wheelin a straight-ahead position
with a clamping device designed for towing service.
(Do not use the vehicle’s steering column lock for this.)
4. Put an automatic transmission in PARK (P), or a
manual transmission in FIRST (1).
5. Put the transfer case in NEUTRAL (N). See
“Four-wheel Drive” in the Index for the proper
procedure to select NEUTRAL (N).
6 . When the vehicle is hooked up, release the
parking brake.
7. Turn the ignition key to OFF.
NOTICE:
If your vehicle isequipped with four-wheel drive
and thetowing limits must be exceeded,a towing
dolly must be used under the front wheels or
vehicle/powertrain damage will occur.
Four-Wheel-Drive Vehicles (Electronic
Transfer Case)
Tow Limits -- 35 mph (55 k d h ) , 50 miles (80 km/h)
If your vehicle is four-wheel drive with an electronic
transfer case, usethe following directions:
1. Engage the parking brake.
2. Turn the ignition key to ON.
3. Clamp the steering wheel in a straight-ahead position
with a clamping device designed for towing service.
(Do not use the vehicle’s steering column lock for this.)
4. Put the transmission in NEUTRAL (N).
5 . Put the transfer case in 2 High (2HI).
6. When the vehicle is hooked up, release the
parking brake.
7. Turn the ignition key to OFF.
NOTICE:
Towing pickup models from therear while loaded
with heavy cargo may cause the frameside rails
to flex sufficientlyto allow the pickup box to
contact the caband could cause damage to the
cab and/orbox.
Engine Overheating (Gasoline Engine)
You will find a coolant temperature gage on your
vehicle’s instrument panel. See “Engine Coolant
Temperature Gage” in the Index.
If your vehiclehas a diesel engine, see “Engine
Overheating” in the Diesel Engine Supplement.
5-13
If Steam Is Coming From Your Engine
If you keep driving when your engine is
overheated, the liquids in it can catchfire. You or
others could bebadly burned. Stop yourengine if
it overheats, and get out of the vehicle until the
engine iscool.
NOTICE:
If your engine catches fire because you keep
driving with no coolant,your vehicle can be
badly damaged. The costly repairs would not be
covered by your warranty.
r
Steam froman overheated engine can burn you
badly, evenif you just open the hood. Stay away
from theengine if you see or hearsteam coming
from it. Just turn itoff and get everyoneaway
from thevehicle until it cools down. Waituntil
there is no sign of steam or coolant before you
open the hood.
CAUTION: (Continued)
5-14
If No Steam Is Coming From Your Engine
If you get the overheat warning but see or hear no
steam, the problem may not be too serious. Sometimes
the engine can get a little too hot when you:
Climb a longhill on a hot day.
Stop after high-speed driving.
Idle for long periods in traffic.
Tow a trailer. See “Driving on Grades” in the Index.
If you get the overheat warning with no sign of steam,
try this for a minute or so:
1. If you have an air conditioner, turn it off.
Cooling System -- Gasoline Engines
When you decide it’s safe to liftthe hood, here’s what
you’ll see:
2. Turn on your heater to full hot at the highest fan
speed and open the window as necessary.
3. If you‘re in a traffic jam, shift to NEUTRAL (N);
otherwise, shift to the highest gear while
driving -- AUTOMATIC OVERDRIVE (0)
for automatictransmissions.
If you no longer have the overheat warning, you can
drive. Just tobe safe, drive slower for about 10 minutes.
If the warning doesn’t come back on, you can
drive normally.
If the warning continues, pull over, stop, and park your
vehicle right away.
If there’s still no sign of steam, push the accelerator until
the engine speed is about twice as fast as normal idle
speed. Bring the engine speed back to normal idle speed
after two orthree minutes. Now see if the warning stops.
But then, if you still have the warning, turn ofSthe
engine und get everyone outof the vehicle until it
cools down.
A. Coolant Recovery Tank
B. Radiator Pressure Cap
C. Engine Fan(s)
You may decide not to lift the hood but to get service
help right away.
5-15
The coolant level should be at or above the COLD mark.
If your vehicle has air conditioning, the auxiliary
electric engine cooling fan under thehood can
start upeven whenthe engine is not running and
can injure you. Keep hands, clothing and tools
away from any underhood electric fan.
If the coolant inside the coolant recovery tank is boiling,
don’t do anything else until it coolsdown.
If it isn’t, you may have a leak in the radiator hoses,
heater hoses, radiator, water pump or somewhere else in
the cooling system.
Heater and radiatorhoses, and otherengine
parts, can be very hot. Don’ttouch them. If you
do, you can be burned.
Don’t run the engine if there is a leak. If you run
the engine, it could loseall coolant. That could
cause an engine fire, and you could be burned.
Get any leak fixed before you drive thevehicle.
I NOTICE:
~~
Engine damage from running your engine
without coolant isn’t covered by your warranty.
5-16
If there seems tobe no leak, start the engine again. Seeif
the engine cooling fan speed increases when idle speed is
doubled by pushing the accelerator pedal down. If it
doesn’t, your vehicle needs service. Turnoff the engine.
How to Add Coolant to theCoolant
Recovery Tank Gasoline Engines
--
If you haven’t found aproblem yet, but the coolant level
isn’t at or abovethe COLD mark, add a 50/50 mixture
of clean water (preferably distilled)and DEX-COOL@
engine coolant at the coolant recovery tank. (See
“Engine Coolant’’ in the Index for more information.)
With plain water or the wrong mix, your engine
could get too hot but you wouldn’t get the
overheat warning. Your engine could catch fire
and you or others could be burned. Use a 50/50
mix of clean water and DEX-COOL@coolant.
NOTICE:
I
In cold weather, water can freeze and crack the
-\CAUTION:
engine, radiator, heater core and other parts.
I
Adding only plain water to yourcooling system
can be dangerous. Plain water, or some other
liquid like alcohol,can boil before the proper
coolant mix will. Your vehicle’scoolant warning
system is set for the propercoolant mix.
CAUTION: (Continued)
Use the recommended coolant and the proper
coolant mixture.
5-17
You can be burned if yousprll coolant on hot
engine parts. Coolant contains ethylene glycol
and it will burn if the engine parts are hot
enough. Don’t spill coolanton a hot engine.
When the coolant in the coolant recovery tank is at or
above the COLD mark, start your vehicle.
If the overheat warning continues, there’s one more
thing you can try. You can add the proper coolant
mixture directly to the radiator, but be sure the cooling
system is cool before you do it.
5-18
' A CAUTION:
I
Steam and scalding liquids from a hot
system can blow out and burnyou badly. They
are underpressure, and if you turn the radiator
pressure cap even a little they can come out
at high speed. Never turn the capwhen the
cooling system, including the radiator pressure
cap, is hot. Wait for thecooling system and
radiator pressure cap tocool if you ever have to
turn the pressurecap.
--
--
5-19
I
I
1.
5-20
2. Then keep turning the pressure cap, but now push
down as you turn it. Remove thepressure cap.
L
3. Fill the radiator with the proper DEX-COOL@
coolant mixture,up to the base of the fillerneck.
(See “EngineCoolant’’ in the Index formore
information aboutthe proper mixture.)
4. Then fill the coolant recovery tank to the COLDmark.
5. Put the cap backon the coolant recoverytank, but
leave the radiator pressure capoff.
5-21
6. Start the engine and let it run until you can feel the
upper radiator hose getting hot. Watch out for the
engine cooling fan(s).
7. By this time, the coolant level insidethe radiator
filler neck may be lower. If the level islower, add
more of the proper DEX-COOL@coolant mixture
through the filler neck until the level reaches the
base of the filler neck.
5-22
8. Then replace the pressure cap. At any time during
this procedure if coolant begins to flow out of the
filler neck, reinstall the pressure cap. Be sure the
arrows on the pressure cap line up like this.
Engine Fan Noise
If a Tire Goes Flat
Your vehicle has a clutched engine cooling fan.When
the clutch is engaged, the fan spins fasterto provide
more air to coolthe engine. In most everyday driving
conditions, the fan is spinning slowerand the clutch is
not fully engaged. This improvesfuel economy and
reduces fan noise. Under heavy vehicle loading, trailer
towing and/or high outside temperatures, thefan speed
increases as the clutchmore fully engages. So you may
hear an increase in fan noise. This is normal and should
not be mistaken as the transmission slipping or making
extra shifts. It is merely the cooling system functioning
properly. The fan will slow down when additional
cooling is not required and the clutch disengages.
It’s unusual for a tireto “blow out” while you’re driving,
especially if you maintain your tires properly. If air goes
out of a tire, it’s much more likely to leak out slowly.
But if you should ever have a “blowout,” here are a
few tips about what to expect and what to do:
You may also hear this fan noise when you start
the engine. It will go away as the fan clutch
partially disengages.
If a front tire fails, the flat tire will create a dragthat
pulls the vehicle toward that side. Take your foot off the
accelerator pedal and grip the steering wheel firmly.
Steer to maintain lane position, and then gently brake to
a stop well out of the traffic lane.
A rear blowout, particularly on a curve, actsmuch like a
skid and may require the samecorrection you’d use in
a skid. In any rear blowout, remove your foot from
the accelerator pedal.Get the vehicle under control by
steering the way you want the vehicle to go. It may be
very bumpy and noisy, but you can still steer. Gently
brake to a stop -- well off the road if possible.
If a tire goes flat, the next part shows how to use your
jacking equipment to change a flat tire safely.
5-23
Changing a Flat Tire
If a tire goes flat, avoid furthertire and wheel damage
by driving slowly to a level place. Turn on your hazard
warning flashers.
I
Changing a tire can cause an injury. The vehicle
can slipoff the jack androll over you or other
people. You and they could be badly injured.
Find a level place to change your tire. To help
prevent the vehicle from moving:
1. Set the parking brake firmly.
2. Put anautomatic transmission shift
lever in PARK (P) or shift a manual
transmission to FIRST(1) or
REVERSE (R).
3. If you have a four-wheel-drive vehicle,
be sure the transfercase is in a drive
gear not in NEUTRAL (N).
4. n r n off the engine.
CAUTION: (Continued)
To be evenmore certain thevehicle won’t move,
you can put blocks at the front and rear
of the
tire farthestaway from the one being changed.
That would be the tireon the otherside of the
vehicle, at the opposite end.
--
5-24
The following steps will tell you how to use the jack and
change a tire.
Removing the Spare Tire
and Tools
I
I
Extended Cab Models
2 and 4-Door Models
The equipmentyou’ll need is behind the passenger’s
seat. Turn the wing nut to the left and remove
the jack
cover, if there is one. Removethe jacking equipment.
If you have a chassis cab,refer to the information from
the body supplier/installer for the location of your
spare tire.
You’ll use the jack handle and the ratchet to remove
the
underbody-mounted spare tire.
5-25
Lower
Raise
1. One sideof the ratchet has an UP marking. The other
side has a DOWN marking. Assemble the ratchet to
the hook near the end of the jack handle (as
illustrated) with the DOWN marking facing you.
Insert the other end through the hole in the rear
bumper and into the hoist shaft.
H
2. Turn the ratchet to lower the spare tireto the ground.
Continue to turn the ratchet until the spare tire can be
pulled out from under the vehicle.
f?
u
A. Hoist Assembly
B. Ratchet
C. Jack Handle
D. Hoist Shaft
E. Valve Stem,
Pointed Down
E Spare Tire
G. Retainer
H. Hoist Cable
5-26
Follow these instructions to lower the spare tire:
3. When the tire has been lowered, tilt the retainer at
the end of the cable so it can be pulled up through
the wheel opening.
4. Put the spare tire near the flat tire.
A
a
The tools you’ll be using include the jack (A), the jack
handle extension (B), the jack handle (C), the wheel
wrench (D) and the ratchet (E).
Attach the jack handle (and jack handle extension,if
needed) to the jack.
If the flat tire is on the rear of the vehicle, you’ll need
the jackhandle extension also.
5-27
If your vehicle has wheel
nut caps, use the wheel
wrench and ratchet to
remove them. Turn the
wheel wrench to the left,
with DOWN facing you, to
remove the wheel nut caps.
Then take off the hub cap.
With the UP marking on the ratchet facingyou, rotate the
ratchet to the right. That will lift the
jack head a little.
If the wheel also has a trim ring, use the wheel wrench
to pry along the edge and remove it.
If the wheel has a smooth center piece, place the wheel
wrench in the slot on the wheel and gently pry out.
5-28
Removing the Flat Tire and Installing the
Spare Tire
1. Use the ratchet and
wheel wrench to loosen
all the wheel nuts. Turn
the wheel wrench to the
left, with DOWN facing
you, to loosen the wheel
nuts. Don't remove the
wheel nuts yet.
2. Position the jack under the vehicle. If the flat tire is
on the front of the vehicle, position the jack on the
frame behind the flat tire. If the flat tire is on the
rear, position the jack on the rear axle between the
spring and the shockabsorber.
1' A CAUTION:
Getting under a vehicle when it is jacked up is
dangerous. If the vehicle slips off the jack,you
could be badly injured or killed. Neverget under
a vehicle whenit is supported only by ajack.
I
Front
Position
Rear
Position
Raising your vehicle with the jack improperly
positioned can damage thevehicle and even make
the vehicle fall. To help avoid personalinjury and
vehicle damage, besure to fit the jack lift head into
the proper location before raising the vehicle.
5-29
4. Remove all the wheel
nuts and take off the
flat tire.
Rear Position
3. With UP on the ratchet facing you, raise the vehicle
by rotating the ratchet and wheel wrench to the right.
Raise the vehicle far enoughoff the ground so there
is enough room for the spare tireto fit.
Front Position
5 . Remove any rust or dirt
from the wheel bolts,
mounting surfaces and
spare wheel.
I
I
5-30
I
I
A CAUTION:
Rust or dirton the wheel, or on the parts to
which it is fastened, can make the wheel nuts
become loose after a time. The wheel could come
off and cause an accident. When you change a
wheel, remove any rust or dirt
from theplaces
where the wheel attaches to thevehicle. In an
emergency, you can use a cloth or a paper towel
to do this;but be sure touse a scraper orwire
brush later, if you need to, to get all the rustor
dirt off.
6. Replace the wheel nuts
with the rounded end of
the nuts toward the
wheel. Tighten each
wheel nut by hand
using the wheel wrench
until the wheel is held
against the hub.
I A CAUTION:
Never useoil or grease on studs ornuts. If you
do, the nutsmight come loose. Your wheelcould
fall off, causing a serious accident.
5-31
8. Tighten the nuts firmly
in a crisscross sequence
as shown by rotating
the wheel wrench to
the right.
e
Front Position
Rear Position
7. Lower the vehicle by rotating the ratchet and wheel
wrench to the left. Lower thejack comdetely.
5-32
,A CAUTION:
Incorrect wheel nuts or improperly tightened
wheel nuts cancause the wheel to become loose
and even comeoff. This could lead to an accident.
Be sure touse the correctwheel nuts. If you have
to replace them, be sure toget new GM original
equipment wheel nuts.
Stop somewhere as soon as you can and have the
nuts tightened with a torque wrench to the
proper torque. See “Capacities and
Specifications” in the Index.
NOTICE:
Improperly tightened wheel nuts can lead to
brake pulsation and rotordamage. To avoid
expensive brake repairs,evenly tighten thewheel
nuts in the propersequence and to the proper
torque specification.
9. Put the wheel trim back on. For vehicles with plastic
wheel nut caps, tighten the caps until they are
finger-tight, then tighten them an additional one-half
of a turn with the ratchet and wheel wrench.
Storing a Flat or SpareTire andTools
I A CAUTION:
Storing a jack, a tireor other equipmentin the
passenger compartment of the vehicle could
cause injury. In a sudden stopor collision, loose
equipment could strike someone. Store all these
in the properplace.
Store the flat tire where the spare tire was stored.
5-33
For an underbody spare tire carrier, store the tire under
the rear of the vehicle in the spare tire carrier. To store
the tire:
Lower
Raise
1 . Put the tire on the ground at the rear of the vehicle
with the valve stem pointed down and to the rear.
2. Tilt the retainer downward and through the wheel
opening. Make surethat the retainer is fully seated
across the underside of the wheel.
H
3. Attach the ratchet, with the UP mark facing you,
near the hook at the end of the jackhandle. Insert the
other end, on an angle, through the hole in the rear
bumper and into the hoist shaft.
4. Raise the tire fully against the underside of the
vehicle. Continue turning the ratchet until there are
two “clicks” or “ratchets.” The spare tire hoist
cannot be over-tightened.
5. Grasp and push against the tire to be sure it is stored
securely and does not move.
A. Hoist Assembly
B. Ratchet
C . Jack Handle
D. Hoist Shaft
E. Valve Stem,
Pointed Down
E Flat or Spare Tire
G. Retainer
H. Hoist Cable
Return thejack, ratchet, wheel wrench and
jack extensions
to their location behind the passenger’s seat. Secure the
items and replace the jack cover, if there is one.
5-34
F
Extended Cab Models
2 and 4-DOOr Models
A. Nut
B. Jack
C. Jack Handle Extension
D. Wheel Wrench
E. Jack and Tool
Storage Box
A. Nut
E Ratchet
B. Jack and Tool Cover
G. Wheel Wrench
E Ratchet
C. Jack Handle Extension
H. Jack
G. Jack Handle
D. Tool Retainer
I. Jack Handle
H. Tool Retainer
E. Jack and Tool
Storage Box
5-35
If You’re Stuck: In Sand, Mud,
Ice or Snow
What you don’t want to do when your vehicle is stuck is
to spin your wheels too fast. The method known as
“rocking” can help you get out when you’re stuck, but
you must use caution.
I
A CAUTION:
-
I - -
Chassis Cab Models
A. Nut
B. Retainer
E Jack and Tool
Storage Box
G. Ratchet
C. Jack Handle
Extension
H. Jack Handle
D. Jack Handle Extension
I. Tool Retainer
E. Wheel Wrench
J. Jack
5-36
If you let your tires spinat high speed, they can
explode, and you or others could be injured. And,
the transmission or other parts of the vehicle can
overheat. That could cause an engine
compartment fireor other damage. When you’re
stuck, spin the wheels as little as possible. Don’t
spin the wheels above 35 mph (55 km/h) as shown
on the speedometer.
NOTICE:
Using the Recovery Hooks
Spinning your wheels can destroy parts of your
vehicle as well as the tires.If you spin the wheels
too fast while shifting your transmission back
and forth, you can destroy your transmission.
For information aboutusing tire chains on your vehicle,
see “Tire Chains” in the Index.
Rocking Your Vehicle To Get It Out
First, turn your steering wheel left and right. That will
clear the area aroundyour front wheels.If you have a
four-wheel drive vehicle, shift into 4HI. Then shift back
and forth between REVERSE(R) and a forward gear
(1) or
(or with a manual transmission, between FIRST
SECOND ( 2 ) and REVERSE (R)), spinning the wheels
as little as possible. Release the accelerator pedal while
you shift, and press lightlyon the accelerator pedal
when the transmission is in
gear. If that doesn’t get
you out after a few tries,
you may need to be towed out.
Or, you can use your recovery hooksif your vehicle has
them. If you do need to be towed out, see
“Towing
Your Vehicle” in the Index.
I
Your vehicle may be equippedwith recovery hooks.
The recovery hooks are provided at the front
of your
vehicle. You may need to use them if you’re stuck
off-road and need to be pulled to some place where
you can continue driving.
5-37
The recovery hooks, when used,are undera lot of
force. Always pull the vehicle straight out. Never
pull on the hooks at a sideways angle. The hooks
could break off and you or others could be
injured from the chain or cable snapping back.
I NOTICE:
I
5-38
Never use the recovery hooks to tow the vehicle.
Your vehicle could bedamaged and it would not
be covered by warranty.
Section 6 Service and Appearance Care
Here you will find information aboutthe care of your vehicle. This section begins with service and fuelinformation,
and then it shows how to check important fluidand lubricant levels. Thereis also technical information about your
vehicle, and a part devotedto its appearance care.
6-2
6- 3
6-5
6-6
6- 8
6-9
6- 13
6- 14
6-18
6-2 1
6-24
6-25
6-26
6-26
6-28
6-32
6-32
Service
Fuel (Gasoline Engine)
Fuels in Foreign Countries (Gasoline Engines)
Filling Your Tank (Gasoline Engine)
Filling a Portable Fuel Container
Checking Things Underthe Hood
Noise Control System
Engine Oil (Gasoline Engine)
Air Cleaner Filter (GasolineEngine)
Automatic Transmission Fluid
Manual Transmission Fluid
Hydraulic Clutch
Rear Axle
Four-wheel Drive
Engine Coolant
Radiator Pressure Cap (Gasoline Engine)
Thermostat
6-33
6-33
6-35
6-39
6-39
6-50
6-5 1
6-6 1
6-62
6-65
6-69
6-70
6-70
6-76
6-77
6-79
Power Steering Fluid
Windshield Washer Fluid
Brakes
Battery
Bulb Replacement
Windshield Wiper Blade Replacement
Tires
Appearance Care
Cleaning the Inside of Your Vehicle
Cleaning the Outside of Your Vehicle
Appearance Care Materials Chart
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
Electrical System
Replacement Bulbs
Capacities and Specifications
Air Conditioning Refrigerants
6-1
Service
Doing Your Own Service Work
Your dealer knowsyour vehicle best and wants you to
be happy with it. We hope you’ll go to your dealer for
all your serviceneeds. You’ll get genuine GM parts and
GM-trained and supported service people.
If you want to do some of your own service work, you’ll
want to use the proper GM Service Manual.It tells you
much more about how to service your vehicle than
this manual can. To order the proper service manual, see
“Service and Owner Publications” in the Index.
We hope you’ll want to keep your GM vehicle all GM.
Genuine GM parts have one of these marks:
Genuine
Parts
6-2
Your vehicle has an air bag system. Before attempting to
do your own service work, see “Servicing Your Air
Bag-Equipped Vehicle” in the Index.
You should keep a record with all parts receipts and list
the mileage and the date of any service work you
perform. See “Maintenance Record”in the Index.
Adding Equipment to the Outside
of
Your Vehicle
You can be injured and yourvehicle couldbe
damaged if you try to do service work on a
vehicle without knowing enough about it.
0 Be sure you have sufficient knowledge,
experience, the proper replacementparts
and tools before youattempt anyvehicle
maintenance task.
Be sure touse the proper nuts, bolts and
other fasteners.“English” and “metric”
fasteners can beeasily confused.If you use
the wrong fasteners, parts can later break
or fall off. You could behurt.
Things you might add to the outside
of your vehiclecan
affect the airflow aroundit. This may cause wind noise
and affect windshield washer performance. Check
with
of
your dealer before adding equipment to the outside
your vehicle.
Fuel (Gasoline Engine)
If your vehicle hasa diesel engine, see “Diesel Fuel
Requirements and Fuel System” in the Diesel Engine
Supplement. For vehicleswith gasoline engines, please
read this.
Use regular unleaded gasoline rated at87 octane or higher.
im
i um, it should meet specifications ASTMD4814
At a mn
in the United States and CGSB 3.5-M93 in Canada.
Improved gasoline specifications have been developed by
the American Automobile Manufacturers Association
(AAMA) for better vehicle performance and engine
protection. Gasolines meeting the f A M A specification
could provide improved driveability and emission control
system protection compared to other gasolines.
6-3
Be sure the posted octane is at least 87. If the octane is
less than 87, you may get a heavy knocking noise when
you drive. If it’s bad enough, it can damage your engine.
If you’re using fuel rated at 87 octane orhigher and you
hear heavy knocking, your engine needs service. But
don’t worry if you hear a littlepinging noise when
you’re accelerating or driving up a hill. That’s normal,
and you don’t have to buy a higher octane fuel to get rid
of pinging. It’s the heavy, constant knock that means
you have a problem.
If your vehicle is certified to meet California Emission
Standards (indicated on the underhood emission control
label), it is designed to operate on fuels that meet
California specifications. If such fuels are not available
in states adopting California emissionsstandards, your
vehicle will operate satisfactorily on fuels meeting
federal specifications, but emission control system
performance may be affected. The malfunction indicator
6-4
lamp on your instrument panel may turn on and/or your
vehicle may fail a smog-check test. If this occurs, return
to your authorized GM dealer fordiagnosis to determine
the cause of failure. In the event it is determined that the
cause of the condition is the type of fuels used, repairs
may not be covered by your warranty.
Some gasolines that are not reformulated for low
emissions contain an octane-enhancing additive called
methylcyclopentadienyl manganese tricarbonyl (MMT);
ask your service station operator whether or not his fuel
contains MMT. General Motors does not recommend the
use of such gasolines. If fuels containing MMT areused,
spark plug life may be reduced and your emission
control system performance may be affected. The
malfunction indicator lampon your instrument panel
may turn on. If this occurs, return to your authorized
GM dealer forservice.
To provide cleaner air, all gasolines in the United States
are now required to contain additivesthat will help
prevent deposits from formingin your engineand fuel
system, allowingyour emission control system to
function properly. Therefore, you should not have to add
anything to the fuel. In addition, gasolines containing
oxygenates, such as ethersand ethanol, and
reformulated gasolines may be available in yourarea to
help clean the air. General Motors recommendsthat you
use these gasolinesif they comply with the
specifications described earlier.
NOTICE:
Your vehicle was not designed for fuel that
contains methanol. Don’t use it. It can corrode
metal parts in your fuel system and also damage
plastic and rubber parts. That damage wouldn’t
be covered under your warranty.
Fuels in Foreign Countries
(Gasoline Engines)
If you plan on driving in another country outside the
United States or Canada, the proper fuel may be hard to
find. Never useleaded gasoline orany other fuel not
recommended in the previous text on fuel. Costly repairs
caused by use of improper fuelwouldn’t be covered by
your warranty.
To check on fuel availability, ask an auto club, or
contact a major oil companythat does business in the
country where you’ll be driving.
You can also write us at the following address for
advice. Just tell us where you’re going and give your
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN).
General Motors Overseas Distribution Corporation
1908 Colonel Sam Drive
Oshawa, OntarioL1H 8P7
6-5
Filling Your Tank (Gasoline Engine)
If your vehicle has a diesel engine, see “Filling Your
Tank (Diesel Engine)” in the Diesel Engine Supplement.
On a chassis-cab model, refuel the front tank first, or in
instances when only a partial fuel fill is desired. An
automatic transfer mechanism will maintain
approximately equal fuel levels in both tanks, so no
switching is required by the operator.
k
-
Gasoline vapor is highly flammable. It burns
violently, and that can cause very bad injuries.
Don’t smoke if you’re near gasoline or refueling
your vehicle. Keep sparks, flames and smoking
materials away from gasoline.
The fuel cap is located on the left side of your vehicle.
6-6
To remove the cap,turn it slowly to the left
(counterclockwise).
CAUTION:
I
While refueling, letthe cap hang by the tether below the
fuel filler neck.
-
If you get gasolineon yourself and then
something ignites it, you could bebadly burned.
Gasoline can spray outon you if youopen the
fuel filler captoo quickly.This spray can happen
if your tank is nearly full, and is more likely in
hot weather. Open thefuel filler cap slowly and
wait for any“hiss” noiseto stop. Then unscrew
the cap all the
way.
6-7
Be careful not to spill gasoline. Clean gasoline from
painted surfaces as soon as possible. See “Cleaning the
Outside of Your Vehicle” in the Index.
When you put the cap backon, turn it to the right
(clockwise) until you hear a clicking sound. Make sure you
fully install the cap. The diagnostic system can determineif
the fuel cap has been leftoff or improperly installed. This
would allow fuel to evaporateinto the atmosphere. See
“Malfunction Indicator Lamp”in the Index.
--
NOTICE:
If you need a new cap, be sure toget the right
type. Your dealer can get one for you. If you get
the wrong type, it may not fit properly. This may
cause your malfunction indicator lamp tolight
and your fuel tank andemissions systemmay be
damaged. See “Malfunction Indicator Lamp” in
the Index.
6-8
Filling a Portable Fuel Container
Never fill a portable fuel container while it is in
your vehicle. Static electricity discharge from the
container can ignite the gasoline vapor. You can
be badly burned and your vehicle damaged if this
occurs. To help avoid injury toyou and others:
0 Dispense gasoline only into
approved containers.
0 Do not fill a container while it is inside a
vehicle, in a vehicle’s trunk, pickup bed or
on any surface other than theground.
0 Bring the fill nozzle in contact with the
inside of the fill opening before operating
the nozzle. Contact should be maintained
until thefilling is complete.
0 Don’t smoke while pumping gasoline.
Checking Things Under the Hood
A CAUTION:
If your vehicle has air conditioning, the auxiliary
engine fan under thehood can start up and
injure you even when the engine is not running.
Keep hands, clothing and tools away from any
underhood electric fan.
A CAUTION:
-
Things that burncan get on hot engine parts and
start a fire. These include liquids like gasoline or
diesel fuel, oil, coolant, brake fluid, windshield
washer and otherfluids, and plastic or rubber.
You or otherscould be burned. Be careful not
to drop orspill things that will burn onto a
hot engine.
6-9
Hood Release
To open the hood, first
pull the handle inside
the vehicle.
Then go to the front of the vehicle and pull up on the
secondary hood release, located just to the passenger’s
side of the center of the grill.
Lift the hood.
Before closing the hood, be sure all filler caps are on
properly. Pull down the hood and close it firmly.
6-10
“VORTEC” 4300,5000,5700 Engine, “VORTEC” 5700 engine shown, locations for other engines similar.
When vou lift LID the hood vou’ll see:
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
E
Battery
Air Cleaner
Radiator Cap
Coolant Recovery Tank
Air Filter Restriction Indicator
Engine Oil Dipstick
G. Automatic Transmission
Dipstick (If Equipped)
H. Fan
I. Power Steering Fluid Reservoir
J. Engine Oil Fill
K. Brake Fluid Reservoir
L. Clutch Fluid Reservoir
(If Equipped)
M. Windshield Washer Fluid
Reservoir
N. Fuse/Relay Center
6-11
VORTEC” 7400 Engine
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
E
Battery
Coolant Recovery Tank
Air Cleaner
Radiator Cap
Air Filter Restriction Indicator
Engine Oil Dipstick
6-12
G. Automatic Transmission
Dipstick (If Equipped)
H. Engine Oil Fill
I. Fan
J. Power Steering Fluid Reservoir
K. Brake Fluid Reservoir
L. Clutch Fluid Reservoir
(If Equipped)
M. Windshield Washer
Fluid Reservoir
N. FuseIRelay Center
Noise Control System
The following information relates to compliance with
Federal noise emission standards forvehicles with a
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) of more than
10,000 lbs. (4 536 kg). The Maintenance Schedule
provides information on maintaining the noise control
system to minimize degradation of the noise emission
control system duringthe life of your vehicle. The
noise control system warranty is given in your
Warranty booklet.
These standards apply only to vehicles sold in the
United States.
Tampering With Noise Control
System Prohibited
Federal law prohibits the following actsor the
causing thereof
1. The removal or rendering inoperative by any person,
other than forpurposes of maintenance, repair or
replacement, of any device or elementof design
incorporated into any new vehicle for the purpose of
noise control, prior to its sale ordelivery to the
ultimate purchaser or while it is in use; or
2. The use of the vehicle after such device or element
of design has been removed or rendered inoperative
by any person.
Among those acts presumed to constitute tampering are
the acts listed below.
Insulation:
Removal of the noise shields or underhooa
insulation.
Engine:
0 Removal or rendering engine speed governor (if
equipped) inoperative so as to allow engine speed to
exceed manufacturerspecifications.
Fan and Drive:
Removal of fan clutch (if equipped) or rendering
clutch inoperative.
Removal of the fan shroud (if equipped).
Air Intake:
0 Removal of the air cleaner silencer.
Reversing the air cleaner cover.
Exhaust:
0 Removal of the muffler and/or resonator.
0 Removal of the exhaust pipes and exhaust
pipe clamps.
6-13
Engine Oil (Gasoline Engine)
If your vehicle has a diesel engine, see “Engine Oil
(Diesel Engine)” in the Diesel Engine Supplement.
It’s a good idea to check your engine oil every time you
get fuel. In order to get an accurate reading, the oil must
be warm and the vehicle must be on level ground.
The engine oil dipstick has a yellow ring handle and is
located on the passenger’s side of the engine.
Turn off the engine and give the oil a few minutes to
drain back into the oil pan. If you don’t, the oil dipstick
might not show the actual level.
Checking EngineOil
Pull out the dipstick and clean it with a paper towel or
cloth, then push it back in all the way. Remove it again,
keeping the tip down, and check the level.
6-14
When to Add Engine Oil
If the oil is at or below the ADD mark, then you’ll need
to add at least one quart of oil. But you must use the
right kind. This part explainswhat kind of oil to use. For
crankcase capacity, see “Capacities and Specifications”
in the Index.
The engine oil fill cap for
the “VORTEC” 4300,5000
and 5700 engines are
located on the driver’s side
engine valvecover.
NOTICE:
Don’t add too much oil.If your engine has so
much oil that the oil level gets above the upper
mark that shows the proper operating range,
your engine couldbe damaged.
The engine oilfill cap for the “VORTEC” 7400 engine
is located at the front of the engine.
Be sure to fill it enough to putthe level somewhere in
the proper operating range. Push the dipstick all the way
back in when you’re through.
6-15
What Kind of Engine Oil to Use
Oils recommended foryour vehicle can be identified by
looking forthe "Starburst" symbol. This symbol
indicates that the oil has been certified by the American
Petroleum Institute (API). Do not use any oil which
does not carry this Starburst symbol.
If you change yourown oil,
be sure you use oil that has
the Starburst symbol on the
front of the oil container.
RECOMMENDED SAE VISCOSITY GRADE ENGINE OILS
FOR BEST FUEL ECONOMY AND COLD STARTING, SELECT THE
LOWEST
SAE VISCOSITY GRADE OIL FOR THE EXPECTED TEMPERATURE RANGE.
HOT
WEATHER
-
"F
"C
1100- - +38
+EO-
- +27
+60--+16
+40-
-
+4
+20- - - 7
0---la
If you have your oil changed foryou, be sure the oil put
into your engine is American Petroleum Institute
certified forgasoline engines.
You should also use the proper viscosity oil for your
vehicle, as shown in the following chart:
I COLD
SA€ 3w-30
PREFERRED
WEATHER
DO NOT USE SAE 2OW-50 OR ANY OTHER
GRADE OIL NOT RECOMMENDED
6-16
As shown in the chart, SAE 5W-30 is best for your
vehicle. However, you can use SAE 1OW-30 if it’s going
to be0°F (-18°C) or above. These numberson an oil
container show itsviscosity, or thickness. Do not use
other viscosity oils, such as SAE 20W-50.
NOTICE:
Use only engine oil with the American Petroleum
Institute Certified For Gasoline Engines
“Starburst” symbol. Failureto use the
recommended oil can result in engine damage not
covered by your warranty.
GM Goodwrench@ oilmeets all the requirements for
your vehicle.
below
If you are in an area where the temperature falls
-20°F (-29”C), consider using either an SAE 5W-30
synthetic oil or an SAE OW-30 oil. Both will provide
easier cold startingand better protection for your engine
at extremely low temperatures.
Engine Oil Additives
Don’t add anything to your oil. Your dealer is ready to
advise if you think something shouldbe added.
When to Change Engine Oil
If any one of these is true for you, use the short
tripkity
maintenance schedule:
Most trips are less than 5 to 10 miles (8 to 16 km).
This is particularly important when outside
temperatures arebelow freezing.
0
Most trips include extensive idling(such as frequent
driving in stop-and-go traffic).
You operate your vehicle in dusty areas or
off-road frequently.
0
You frequently tow a trailer.
0
The vehicle is used for delivery service, police, taxi
or othercommercial application.
Driving under these conditions causes engineoil to
break down sooner. If any one of these is true for your
vehicle, then you need to change your oil and filter
every 3,000 miles ( 5 000 km) or 3 months -- whichever
occurs first.
If none of them is true, use the long trip/highway
maintenance schedule. Changethe oil and filter every
7,500 miles (12 500 km) or 12 months -- whichever
occurs first. Driving a vehicle with a fully warmed
engine under highway conditions causes engine oil to
break down slower.
6-17
What to Do with Used Oil
Air Cleaner (Gasoline F gines)
Did you know that used engine oil contains certain
elements that may be unhealthy for your skin and could
even cause cancer?Don't let used oil stay on your skin
for very long. Clean your skin and nails with soap and
water, or a good hand cleaner. Wash or properly throw
away clothing or rags containingused engine oil.(See
the manufacturer's warnings about the use and disposal
of oil products.)
Used oil can be a real threat to the environment. If you
change your own oil, be sure to drain all free-flowing oil
from the filter before disposal. Don't ever dispose of oil
by putting it in the trash, pouring it on the ground, into
sewers, or into streams or bodies of water. Instead,
recycle it by taking it toa place that collects used oil. If
you have a problem properly disposing of your used oil,
ask your dealer, a service station or a local recycling
center for help.
6-18
Your air cleaneris located between the battery and
coolant recovery tank.
........,.
:
The air cleanerassembly
has an indicator that lets
you know when the air filter
is dirty and needs to be
serviced. The indicator is
located in the air intake tube
between the air cleaner and
the engine.
See “Owner Checks and Services” in the Index to
determine when to check theindicator.
If the area insidethe clear sectionof the indicator is
green, no air filter serviceis required. When the area
inside the indicator is orange and CHANGEAIR
FILTER appears, the filter should be replaced.
To remove the air filter, unhook the retaining clips and
remove the cover. Lift the filter and the connected duct
out of the air cleanerhousing. Hold the duct and remove
the filter by both pulling and twisting the filter away
from the duct. Care should be taken to dislodge aslittle
dirt as possible.
Clean the filter sealing surfaceof the duct and the
filter housing.
6-19
Operating theengine with the air cleaner off can
cause you or others tobe burned. The air cleaner
not only cleans the air, it stopsflame if the engine
backfires. If it isn’t there, and the engine
backfires, you could be burned. Don’t drive with
it off, and be careful working on the engine with
the air cleaner off.
Install thenew filter by pushing it all the way to the stop
on the duct.
NOTICE:
Install the duct and the filter into the air cleaner housing.
Make sure that the duct fits properly into the housing.
If the air cleaner is off, a backfire can cause a
damaging engine fire. And, dirt can easily get
into your engine, whichwill damage it. Always
have the air cleaner in place when you’re driving.
Install the cover and fasten the two retaining clips.
After the air filteris properly serviced, the indicator
should be reset. Push the button on topof the indicator
to reset it to the green (clean) filter zone.
Refer to the Maintenance Schedule to determine when to
replace the air filter. See “Owner Checks and Services”
in the Index
Automatic Transmission Fluid
If your vehicle has a diesel engine, see “Automatic
Transmission Fluid” in the Diesel Supplement.
When to Check and Change
A good time to check your automatic transmission fluid
level is when the engine oil is changed.
Change both the fluid and filter every50,000 miles
(83 000 km) if the vehicle’s GVWR is over 8,600 or
if the vehicle ismainly driven under one ormore of
these conditions:
In heavy city traffic where the outside temperature
regularly reaches 90°F (32°C) or higher.
In hilly or mountainous terrain.
a When doing frequent trailer towing.
Uses such as found in taxi, policeor delivery service.
If your vehicle’s GVWR is not over 8,600 and you do not
use your vehicle under anyof these conditions, change the
fluid and filter every 100,OOO miles (166 OOO km).
See “Scheduled Maintenance Services”in the Index.
How to Check
Because this operation canbe a little difficult,you
may choose to have this doneat your GM dealership
Service Department.
If you do it yourself, be sure to follow all the instructions
here, or you could get a false reading on the dipstick.
I NOTICE:
Too much or too little fluid can damage your
transmission. Too much can mean that some of
the fluid could come out and fall on hot engine
parts or exhaust system parts, starting a fire. Be
sure to get an accurate reading if you check your
transmission fluid.
Wait at least 30 minutes before checkingthe
transmission fluid levelif you have been driving:
When outside temperatures are above 90°F (32°C).
At high speed for quite a while.
In heavy traffic -- especially in hot weather.
a While pulling a trailer.
To get the right reading, the fluid should be at normal
operating temperature, which is 180°F to 200°F (82°C
to 93°C). See “Checking Transmission Fluid Hot” in
the Index.
6-21
three seconds in each range. Then, position the shift
lever in PARK (P).
Checking Transmission FluidHot
Get the vehicle warmed up by driving about 15 miles
(24 km) when outside temperatures are above 50°F
(10°C). If it's colder than 50°F (lO"C), drive the
vehicle in THIRD (3) until the engine temperature gage
moves and then remains steady for 10 minutes. Then
follow the hot check procedures.
Checking Transmission Fluid Cold
A cold check is made after the vehicle has been sitting
for eighthours or morewith the engine off and is used
only as a reference. Let the engine run at idle for five
minutes if outside temperatures are 50°F ( 10°C) or
more. If it's colder than 50°F ( 10°C), you may have
to idle the engine longer. Should the fluid level be low
during a cold check, you must perform a hot check
before adding fluid. This will give you a more accurate
reading of the fluid level.
Checking the Fluid Hot or Cold
Park your vehicle on a level place. Keep the
engine running.
0
0
With the parking brake applied, place the shift lever
in PARK (P).
With your foot on the brake pedal, move the shift
lever through each gear range, pausing for about
6-22
Let the engine run at idle for three minutes or more.
Then, without shutting off the engine, follow these steps:
I
1. The red transmission dipstick handle is located at the
rear of the engine compartment, on the passenger's
side. Flip the handle up and then pull out the dipstick
and wipe it with a clean rag or paper towel.
2. Push it back in all the way, wait three seconds and
then pull it back out again.
Add fluid only after checking the transmission fluid
while it is hot.(A cold check isused only as a
reference.) If the fluid level islow, add only enough of
the proper fluidto bring the levelup to the HOT area for
a hot check. It doesn’t take much fluid, generally less
than one pint(0.5 L). Don’t ovefill.
NOTICE:
We recommend you use only fluid labeled
DEXRON@-111, because fluid with that label
is
made especially for your automatic transmission.
Damage caused by fluid other than DEXRON-I11
is not covered by your new vehicle warranty.
3. Check both sidesof the dipstick, and readthe lower
level. The fluid level must be in the COLD area for a
cold checkor in the HOT area or cross-hatched area
for a hotcheck.
4. If the fluid levelis in the acceptable range,push the
dipstick back inall the way; then flipthe handle
down to lock the dipstick
in place.
How to Add Fluid
Refer to the Maintenance Schedule to determine
what
kind of transmission fluid touse. See “Recommended
Fluids and Lubricants”in the Index.
0
After adding fluid, recheck thefluid level as
described under“How to Check.”
When the correct fluid level isobtained, push the
dipstick back inall the way; then flip the handle
down to lock the dipstickin place.
6-23
Manual Transmission Fluid
When to Check
A good time to have it checked is when the engine oil is
changed. However, the fluid in your manual
transmission doesn’t require changing.
Check the fluid level only when your engine is off, the
vehicle is parked on a level place and the transmission is
cool enough for you to rest your fingers onthe
transmission case.
Then, follow these steps:
How to Check
Because thisoperation can be a little difficult, you
may choose to have this done at your GM dealership
Service Department.
If you do it yourself, be sure to followall the
instructions here, or you could get a falsereading.
~
NOTICE:
Too much or too little fluid can damage your
transmission. Too much can mean that some of
the fluid could come out and fall on hot engine
parts or exhaust system parts, starting a fire. Be
sure to get an accurate reading you
if check your
transmission fluid.
6-24
I . Remove the filler plug.
2. Check that the lubricant level is up to the bottom of
the filler plug hole.
3. If the fluid level is good, install the plug and be sure
it is fully seated. If the fluid level is low, add more
fluid as described in the next steps.
How to Add Fluid
When to Check and What to Use
Here’s how to add fluid. Refer to the Maintenance
Schedule to determine what kind of fluid to use. See
“Recommended Fluids and Lubricants”in the Index.
Refer to the Maintenance
Schedule, Owner Checks
and Services, to determine
how often you should check
the fluid level in your clutch
master cylinder reservoir
and for theproper fluid. See
“Owner Checks and
Services’’ and
“Recommended Fluids and
Lubricants” in the Index.
1. Remove the filler plug.
2. Add fluid at the filler plug hole. Add only enough
fluid to bring the fluid level up to the bottom of the
filler plug hole.
3. Install the filler plug. Be sure the plug is fully seated.
Hydraulic Clutch
The hydraulic clutch systemin your vehicle is
self-adjusting. A slight amount of play (1/4 inch to
1/2 inch or 6 mm to 12 mm) in the pedal is normal.
How to Check
It isn’t a good idea to “top off’ your clutch fluid. Adding
fluid won’t correct a leak. A fluid loss in this system could
indicate a problem. Have the system inspected and repaired.
The proper fluid should be added if the level does not
reach the bottom of the diaphragm when it’s in place in
the reservoir. See the instructions on the reservoir cap.
6-25
Rear Axle
What to Use
When to Check and Change Lubricant
Refer to the Maintenance Schedule todetermine what
kind of lubricant to use. See “Recommended Fluids and
Lubricants” in the Index.
Refer to the Maintenance Schedule todetermine how
often to check the lubricant and when to change it. See
“Scheduled Maintenance Services” in the Index.
How to Check Lubricant
C3 (3500 HD) Trucks Equipped with Dana
Rear Axle
Additional rear axle scheduled maintenance is required
on 3500 HD models equipped with Dana rear axles
when they are driven under the followingconditions:
Extreme loading (at or near GVWR) or trailer
towing, and:
Operation above 45 mph (70 k d h ) for extended
periods of time.
Vehicles used in any of these conditions require the
rear axle lubricant be changed every 30,000 miles
(50 000 km). Fluid capacity is 4.12 quarts (3.9 L).
Four-wheel Drive
If the level is below the bottom of the filler plug hole,
you’ll need to add some lubricant. Add enough lubricant
to raisethe level to the bottom of the filler plug hole.
6-26
Most lubricant checks in this section also apply to
four-wheel-drive vehicles. However, they have two
additional systems that need lubrication.
Transfer Case
When to Check Lubricant
Refer to the Maintenance Schedule to determine how
often to check the lubricant. See “Periodic Maintenance
Inspections” in the Index.
How to Check Lubricant
If the level is below the bottom of the filler plug hole,
you’ll need to add some lubricant. Add enough lubricant
to raise the level to the bottom of the filler plug hole.
What to Use
Refer to the Maintenance Scheduleto determine what
kind of lubricant to use. See “Recommended Fluids and
Lubricants” in the Index.
Front Axle
When to Check and Change Lubricant
Refer to the Maintenance Scheduleto determine how
often to check thelubricant and when to change it. See
“Scheduled MaintenanceServices” in the Index.
6-27
How to Check Lubricant
What to Use
Refer to the Maintenance Schedule to determine what
kind of lubricant to use. See “Recawended Fluids and
Lubricants’’ in the Index.
Engine Coolant
The cooling s stem in your vehicle is filled with
DEX-COOL J engine coolant. This coolant is designed
to remain in your vehicle for 5 years or 150,000 miles
(240 000 km), whichever occurs first,if you add only
DEX-COOL@extended life coolant.
The following explains your cooling system and how
to add coolant when it is low. If you have a problem
with engine overheating, see “EngineOverheating” in
the Index.
If the level is below the bottom of the filler plug hole,
you may need to add some lubricant.
When the differential is cold, add enough lubricant to
raise the level to 1/2 inch (12 mm) below the filler
plug hole.
When the differential is at operating temperature
(warm), add enough lubricant to raise the level to the
bottom of the filler plug hole.
6-28
A 50/50 mixture of water andDEX-COOL@ coolant will:
Give freezing protection down to -34°F (-37°C).
0
Give boiling protection up to 265 “F (129°C).
Protect against rust and corrosion.
0
Help keep the proper engine temperature.
Let the warning gages work as they should.
What to Use
NOTICE:
When addingcoolant, it is important thatyou use
only DEX-COOL@(silicate-free) coolant.
If coolant other thanDEX-COOL is added to the
system, premature engine, heater core or
radiator corrosion may result. In addition, the
engine coolant will require changesooner at
30,000 miles (50 000 km)or 24 months,
whichever occurs first.Damage caused by the use
of coolant other than DEX-COOL@
is not
covered byyour new vehicle warranty.
Use a mixtureof one-half clean water(preferably
distilled) and one-half DEX-COOL@coolant which
won’t damage aluminum parts.If you use this mixture,
you don’t need toadd anything else.
--
Adding only plain water to your
cooling system
can bedangerous. Plain water, or some other
liquid like alcohol, can boil before the proper
coolant mixture will. Your vehicle’s coolant
warning system is set for the proper
coolant
mixture. With plain water or the wrong mixture,
your engine could get toohot but you wouldn’t
get the overheatwarning. Your engine could
catch fireand you or otherscould be burned.
Use a 50/50 mixture of clean water and
DEX-COOL@coolant.
6-29
NOTICE:
If you usean improper coolant mixture, your
engine could overheat and be badly damaged.
The repair cost wouldn’tbe covered by your
warranty. Too much water in themixture can
freeze and crack theengine, radiator, heatercore
and other parts.
Checking Coolant
If your vehicle has a diesel engine, see “Checking
Coolant” in the Diesel Engine Supplement.
If you have to add coolant more than four times a year,
have your dealer check your cooling system.
NOTICE:
If you use the propercoolant, you don’t have to
add extra inhibitorsor additives which claim to
improve the system. These can be harmful.
The coolant recovery tank is located on the passenger’s
side at the rear corner of the engine compartment.
When your engine is cold, the coolant level should be at
the COLD mark, or a little higher. When your engine is
warm, the level should be up to the HOT mark, or a
little higher.
6-30
Adding Coolant
If you need more coolant, addthe proper DEX-COOL@
coolant mixtureat the coolant recovery tank.
r A CAUTION:
You can be burned if you spill coolan
engine parts. Coolant contains ethylene glycol,
and itwill burn if the engine parts are hot
enough. Don’t spill coolant on a hot engine.
A CAUTION:
Turning theradiator pressure cap when the
engine and radiator arehot can allow steam
and scalding liquids to blow out and burnyou
badly. With the coolant recovery tank, you will
almost never have to add coolant at the radiator.
Never turn the radiator pressure cap even a
little when the engine and radiator arehot.
--
--
Add coolant mixtureat the recovery tank. but be careful
not to spill it.
6-31
Radiator Pressure Cap
(Gasoline Engine)
NOTICE:
Your radiator cap is a15 psi (105 kPa)
pressure-type cap and must be tightly installed
to
prevent coolant loss and possible engine damage
from overheating. Be sure the arrows on the cap
line up with the overflow tube on the radiator
filler neck.
Thermostat
Engine coolant temperature 1s controlled by a thermostat
in the engine coolant system. The thermostat stops the
flow of coolant through the radiator until the coolant
reaches a preset temperature.
The radiator pressure cap must be tightly installed with
the arrows onthe cap lined up with the overflow tube on
the radiator filler neck.
6-32
When you replace your thermostat, an AC@thermostat
is recommended.
Power Steering Fluid
I
How To Check Power Steering Fluid
When the engine compartment is cool,wipe the cap and
the topof the reservoir clean, thenunscrew the cap and
wipe the dipstickwith a clean rag. Replacethe cap and
completely tighten it. Then removethe cap again and
look at the fluid level on the dipstick.
The level should be at the FULL COLD mark. If
necessary, add only enough fluid tobring the level up to
the mark.
What to Use
To determine what kind of fluid to use, see
“Recommended Fluids and Lubricants” in the Index.
Always use the proper fluid. Failure to use the proper
fluid can causeleaks and damage hoses and seals.
When to Check Power Steering Fluid
Windshield Washer Fluid
It is not necessary to regularly check power steering fluid
unless you suspect there is a leak in the system or you hear
an unusual noise. A fluid loss in this system could indicate
a problem. Have the system inspected and repaired.
What to Use
When you need windshield washer fluid, be sure to read
the manufacturer’s instructions before use. If you will be
operating your vehicle in an area where the temperature
may fall below freezing, use a fluid that has sufficient
protection against freezing.
6-33
Adding Washer Fluid
NOTICE:
0
0
Open the caplabeled WASHER FLUID ONLY. Add
washer fluid until the tank is full.
6-34
0
When using concentrated washer fluid,
follow the manufacturer’s instructions for
adding water.
Don’t mix water with ready-to-use washer
fluid. Water can cause the solution to freeze
and damage your washer fluid tank and
other parts of the washer system. Also,
water doesn’t clean as well as washer fluid.
Fill your washer fluid tank only
three-quarters full when it’s very cold.This
allows for expansion if freezing occurs,
which could damage the tankif it is
completely full.
Don’t use engine coolant (antifreeze) in
your windshield washer.It can damage
your washer system and paint.
Brakes
Brake Fluid
Your brake master cylinder
reservoir is here. It is filled
with DOT-3 brake fluid.
So, it isn’t a good idea to “top off’ your brake fluid.
Adding brake fluid won’t correct a leak. If you add fluid
when your linings are worn, then you’ll have too much
fluid when you get new brake linings. You should add
(or remove) brake fluid, as necessary, only when work is
done on thebrake hydraulic system.
If you have too much brake fluid, it can spill on the
engine. The fluidwill burn if the engine is hot
enough. You or others could be burned, and your
vehicle could be damaged. Add brake fluid only
when work is done on the brake hydraulic system.
There are only two reasons why the brake fluid level in the
reservoir might go down. The first is that the brake fluid
goes down to an acceptable level during normal brake
lining wear. When new linings are put in, the fluid level
goes back up. The other reason is that fluid is leaking out
of the brake system.If it is, you should have your brake
system fixed, sincea leak means that sooneror later your
brakes won’t work well, or won’t work at all.
Refer to the Maintenance Schedule to determinewhen to
check your brake fluid. See “Periodic Maintenance
Inspections’’ in the Index.
6-35
Checking Brake Fluid
What to Add
When you do need brake fluid, useonly DOT-3 brake
fluid -- such as Delco Supreme 11 (GM Part
No. 12377967). Use new brake fluid from a sealed
container only.
@
Always clean the brake fluid reservoir cap and the area
around the cap before removing it. Thiswill help keep
dirt from entering the reservoir.
You can check thebrake fluid without taking off the cap.
Just look atthe brake fluid reservoir. The fluid level
should be above MIN.If it isn’t, have yourbrake system
checked to seeif there is a leak.
After work is done on the brake hydraulic system,
make sure the level
is above the MIN butnot over the
MAX markor the top of the window on the side of
the reservoir.
6-36
With the wrong kindof fluid in your brake
system, your brakes may not work well, or they
may not even workat all. This could cause a
crash. Always use the proper brake fluid.
NOTICE:
0
0
Using the wrong fluid can badly damage
brake system parts. Forexample, just a few
drops of mineral-based oil, such as engine
oil, in yourbrake system can damagebrake
system parts so badly that they’ll have to be
replaced. Don’t let someone put inthe
wrong kind of fluid.
If’you spill brake fluid on your vehicle’s
painted surfaces, the paintfinish can be
damaged. Be careful not to spill brake fluid
on your vehicle. If you do, washit off
immediately. See“Appearance Care” in
the Index.
Brake Wear
If you have a C 3500 HD model, it has four-wheel disc
brakes without wear indicators.
If you ever heara brake
rubbing noise, have the brake linings inspected.
Disc brake pads (exceptC 3500 HD models) have
built-in wear indicators that make
a high-pitched
warning sound when the brake pads are
worn and new
pads are needed.The sound may come and go or be
heard all the timeyour vehicle is moving (except when
you are pushing on the brake pedal firmly).
r
The brake wear warning sound means that soon
your brakeswon’t work well. That could lead to
an accident. When you hear the brakewear
warning sound,have your vehicle serviced.
NOTICE:
Continuing to drivewith worn-out brake pads
could result incostly brake repair.
If your pickupis not a C 3500 HD model, it has front
disc brakes and rear drum brakes.
6-37
Some driving conditionsor climates may cause a brake
squeal when the brakes are first applied or lightly
applied. This does not mean something is wrong with
your brakes.
Brake Adjustment
Every time you make a brake stop, your discbrakes
adjust for wear.
Properly torqued wheel nuts arenecessary to help
prevent brake pulsation. When tires are rotated, inspect
brake pads for wear and evenly torque wheel nuts in the
proper sequence to GM specifications.
If your brake pedal goes down fartherthan normal, your
rear drum brakes may need adjustment. Adjust them by
backing up and firmly applying the brakes a few times.
If you have rear drum brakes, they don’t have wear
indicators, but if you ever heara rear brake rubbing
noise, have the rear brake linings inspected immediately.
Also, the rear brake drums should be removed and
inspected each time the tires are removed for rotation or
changing. Whenyou have the frontbrake pads replaced,
have the rear brakes inspected, too.
Brake linings should always be replaced as complete
axle sets.
The braking system on a modern vehicle is complex. Its
many parts have to be of top quality and work well
together if the vehicle is to havereally good braking.
Your vehicle was designed and tested with top-quality
GM brake parts. When you replace parts of your braking
system -- for example,when your brake linings wear
down and you have tohave new ones put in -- be sure
you get new approved GM replacement parts. If you
don’t, your brakesmay no longer work properly. For
example, if someone puts in brake linings that are wrong
for your vehicle, the balance between your front and
rear brakes can change-- for the worse. The braking
performance you’ve come to expect can changein many
other ways if someone puts in thewrong replacement
brake parts.
See “Brake System Inspection” in Section 7 of this manual
under Part C “Periodic Maintenance Inspections.”
Brake Pedal Travel
See yourdealer if the brake pedal does not return to
normal height, or if there is a rapid increase in pedal
travel. This couldbe a sign of brake trouble.
6-38
Replacing Brake System Parts
Battery
Every new vehicle has an ACDelco Freedom’ battery.
You never have to add water to one of these. When it’s
time for a new battery, we recommend an ACDelco
Freedom battery. Get one that has the replacement
number shown on the original battery’s label.
Vehicle Storage
If you’re not going to drive your vehicle for25 days
or more, remove the black, negative (-) cable from
the battery. This will help keep your battery from
running down.
’A
Contact your dealerto learn how to prepare your vehicle
for longer storage periods.
Also, for your audio system, see“Theft-Deterrent
Feature” in the Index.
Bulb Replacement
Before you replace any bulbs, be sure that all the lamps
are off and the engine isn’t running. See “Replacement
Bulbs” in the Index for theproper types of bulbs to use.
Halogen Bulbs
CAUIION:
Batteries have acid that can burn you and gas
that can explode. You can be badly hurt if you
aren’t careful. See “Jump Starting” in the Index
for tips on working around a battery without
getting hurt.
Halogen bulbs have pressurized gas inside and
can burst if you drop or scratch thebulb. You or
others could be injured. Be sure to read and
follow the instructionson the bulbpackage.
6-39
Headlamps
3. Unplug and remove
the headlamp.
Sealed Beam Lamps
1. Remove the four
screws from the
headlamp retainer.
4. Plug in the new headlamp and put it in place.
5. Install the retainer to the headlamp and tighten
the screws.
2. Pull the headlamp out and remove the retainer.
6-40
Composite Headlamps
5. Put the new bulb into thelens assembly and turn it to
the right until it is tight.
6. Plug in the electrical connector.
1. Remove the twohex head pins at the location shown.
2. Pull the headlamp lens assembly out.
7. Put the headlamp lens assembly back intothe
vehicle. Install andtighten the two hex head pins.
3. Unplug the electrical connector.
6-41
Front 'hrn Signal Lamps
(Sealed Beam Headlamps)
1. Remove the two screws
at the inside edge
of the
parking/turn signal
lamp assembly.
2. Remove the lampassembly by swinging it out from
the inside edge and sliding it out at the outside edge.
3. Squeeze the tab on the side of the lamp socket while
turning the socket to the left.
6-42
5. Push in gently on the bulb, turn it to the left and
remove it from the socket.
6. Put the new bulb into the socket, gently press in on
the bulb and turn it to the right until it is tight.
7. Put the socket back into the lamp assembly and turn
it to the right until it locks.
8. Put the parkingkurn signal lamp assembly back into
the vehicle and tighten the screws.
Front Turn Signal Lamps
(Composite Headlamps)
3. Pull the socket out of the
lamp assembly.
1. Remove the four screws
and take out the
parkingkurn signal
lamp assembly.
4. Push in gently on the bulb, turn it to the left and
remove it from the socket.
2. Squeeze the tab onthe side of the lamp socket while
turning the socket to the left.
5. Put the new bulb into the socket, gently press in on
the bulb and turn itto the right until it is tight.
6. Put the socket back into the lamp assembly and turn
it to the right until it locks.
7. Put the parkingkurn signal lamp assembly back into
the vehicle and tighten the four screws.
6-43
Front Sidemarker Lamps
(Composite Headlamps)
3. Pull the bulb straight out
of the socket.
1. Remove the four screws
and pull out the
parkingkurn signal
lamp assembly.
4. Put a new bulb into the socketand push it in until it
is tight.
2. Reach through the opening and turn the sidemarker
bulb socketto the left and remove it.
6-44
5. Put the socket back into the sidemarker assembly
and turn it to the right to tighten it.
6. Replace the parkingkurn signal lampassembly and
tighten the screws.
Fender Marker Lamps
(Dual Rear Wheel Pickup Models)
2. Turn the bulb socketto
the left and remove
it
from thelens assembly.
1. Remove the screws
and take the fender
marker assembly out
of the fender.
3. Pull the bulb straight outof the socket.
4. Put a new bulb into the socket and push
it in until it
is tight.
5. Put the socket back into the lens assembly and turn
it
to the rightto tighten it.
6. Replace the lens and tighten the screws.
1
6-45
Center High-Mounted Stoplamp (CHMSL)
1. Remove the screws and
lift off the lens.
4. Replace the lens and tighterrthescrews.
2. Pull the old bulb straight
out of the socket.
6-46
Roof Marker Lamps
1. Remove the screws and liftoff the lens.
Pickup Box Identification Lamps
(Dual Rear Wheel Pickup Models)
2. Pull the bulb straight outof the socket.
3. Put a new bulb into the socket and push it in until it
is tight.
4. Replace the lens and tighten the screws.
1. Remove the screws and lampassembly.
2. Unplug the lamp assembly harness.
3. Use a screwdriver to gentlypry the individual lamp
from the lamp housing.
6-47
Taillamps (PickupModels)
1. Open the tailgate.
2. Remove the two
rear lamp assembly
screws near the tailgate
latch and pull out the
lamp assembly.
4. Unplug the lamp at the connector.
5. Plug in a new lamp and snap it into the housing.
6. Reinstall the lamp housing.
6-48
3. Remove the screws
from the bulb retainer
and take it off the
lamp assembly.
4. Pull the old bulb straight
out of the socket.
Taillamps (Chassis Cab Models)
1. Using your hands, peel the rubber seal away from
the lens.
2. Lift the lens off the
lamp assembly.
5. Put in a new bulb and pushit straight in until it
is tight.
6. Replace the bulb retainer.
7. Replace the rear lamp assembly and tighten
the screws.
3. Slide the socket out of the lamp assembly.
8. Close the tailgate.
6-49
4. Push in gently on the
bulb, turn it to the
left and remove it from
the socket.
Windshield Wiper Blade
Replacement
For proper type and length, see “Normal Maintenance
Replacement Parts” in the Index.
5. Put in a new bulb and, pushing in gently, turn it to
the right until it is tight.
6. Put the socket back in the lamp assembly and replace
the lens and lens seal.
To replace the windshield wiper blade assembly:
1. Lift the wiper arm and rotate the blade until it is
facing away from the windshield.
2. Push the release lever and slide the wiper assembly
toward the driver’s side of the vehicle.
3. Install a new blade by reversing Steps 1 and 2.
6-50
Tires
Your new vehicle comes with high-quality tires maae~y
a leading tiremanufacturer. If you ever have questions
about your tire warranty and whereobtain
to service, see
your GM Warranty booklet for details.
CAUTION:
Poorly maintained and improperly used tires
are dangerous.
0 Overloading your tirescan cause
overheating as a result of too much friction.
You could have an air-out and a serious
accident. See “Loading Your Vehicle” in
the Index.
0 Underinflated tires pose the same danger as
overloaded tires. The resulting accident
could cause serious injury. Check all tires
frequently to maintain therecommended
pressure. Tire pressureshould be checked
when your tiresare cold.
0 Overinflated tires are more likely to be cut,
punctured or broken by a sudden impact
such as when youhit a pothole. Keep tires
at the recommended pressure.
0 Worn, old tires cancause accidents. If your
tread is badly worn, or if your tires have
been damaged, replace them.
--
6-51
Inflation
-- Tire Pressure
The Certificationflire label,which is on the rear edge of
the driver’s door, or on the incomplete vehicle document
in the cab, showsthe correct inflationpressures for your
tires when they’re cold. “Cold” means your vehicle has
been sitting for at least three hours or driven no more
than 1 mile (1.6 km).
6-52
NOTICE:
Don’t let anyone tell you that underinflation or
overinflation is all right. It’s not. If your tires
don’t have enough air (underinflation), you can
get the following:
0 Too much flexing
0 Too much heat
0 Tire overloading
Bad wear
0 Bad handling
Bad fuel economy.
If your tires have toomuch air (overinflation),
you can get the following:
0 Unusual wear
0 Bad handling
Rough ride
0 Needless damage from road hazards.
When to Check
Check your tires once a month or more. Also, check the
tire pressure of the spare tire.
How to Check
Use a good quality pocket-type gage to check tire
pressure. You can’t tell if your tires are properly inflated
simply by looking at them.Radial tires may look
properly inflated even when they’re underinflated.
The purpose of regular rotation is to achieve more
uniform wear for all tires on the vehicle. The first
rotation is the most important. See “Scheduled
Maintenance Services” in the Index for scheduled
rotation intervals.
FRT
UI
Be sure to put the valve caps back on the valve stems.
They help prevent leaksby keeping out dirt and moisture.
FRT
I1 II
Tire Inspection and Rotation
Tires should berotated every 6,000 to 8,000 miles
(10 000 to 13 000 km). Any time you notice unusual
wear, rotate your tires as soon as possible and check
wheel alignment. Also check for damaged tires
or
wheels. See “When It’s Time for New Tires’’ and
“Wheel Replacement” later in this section for more
information. If your vehicle has dual rear wheels, also
see “Dual Tire Operation” later in this section.
I
If your vehicle has single rear wheels, always use one of
the correctrotation patterns shown here when rotating
your tires.
If your vehicle has front tires with different load ranges
or tread designs (such as all season vs. on/off road) than
the rear tires, don’t rotate your tires front to rear.
6-53
w v u
-u
U
If your vehicle has dual rearwheels and the load range
and tread design for your front tires is the same as your
rear tires, always use one of the correctrotation patterns
shown here when rotating your tires.
If your vehicle has dual rearwheels and the load range
or tread design for your front tires is different from your
rear tires, always usethe correct rotation pattern shown
here when rotating your tires. The dual tires arerotated
as a pair, and the inside rear tires become the outside
rear tires.
When you install dual wheels, be sure the vent holes in
the inner and outer wheels on each side are
lined up.
After the tires have been rotated, adjust the front and
rear inflation pressures as shown on the
CertificationEire label. Make certain that all wheel nuts
are properly tightened. See “Wheel Nut Torque” in
the Index.
6-54
When It’s Timefor New Tires
Rust or dirton awheel, or on the parts to which
it is fastened, can makewheel nuts become loose
after a time. The wheel could comeoff and cause
an accident. When you change a wheel, remove
any rust or dirt
from places where the wheel
attaches to the vehicle. In anemergency, you can
use a cloth or a paper towel to do this; but be
sure touse a scraper orwire brush later, if you
need to, to get all therust or dirtoff. (See
“Changing a Flat Tire”in the Index.)
One way to tell when it’s
time for new tires is to
check the treadwear
indicators, which will
appear when your tires have
only 1/16 inch (1.6 mm) or
less of tread remaining.
Some commercialtruck
tires may not have
treadwear indicators.
6-55
You need a new tire if any of the following statements
are true:
0
You can see the indicators at three or more places
around the tire.
0
You can see cord or fabric showing through the
tire’s rubber.
0
The tread or sidewall is cracked, cut orsnagged deep
enough to show cord or fabric.
The outer tire ona dual wheel setup generally wears
faster than the inner tire. Your tires will wear more
evenly and last longer if you rotate the tires periodically.
If you’re going to be doinga lot of driving on
high-crown roads, you can reduce tirewear by adding
5 psi (35 kPa) to the tire pressure in the outer tires. Be
sure to return to the recommended pressures when no
longer drivingunder those conditions.See “Changing a
Flat Tire” in the Index for more information.
The tire has a bump, bulge or split.
0
The tire has a puncture, cut or other damage that
can’t be repaired well because of the size or location
of the damage.
Dual Tire Operation
When the vehicle is new, or whenever a wheel, wheel
bolt or wheel nut is replaced, check the wheel nut
torque after 100, 1,000 and 6,000 miles (160, 1 600 and
10 000 km) of driving. For proper torque, see “Wheel
Nut Torque” in the Index.
If you operate your vehicle with
a tire that is badly
underinflated, the tire can overheat. An overheated
tire can lose air suddenly or catch fire.
You or
others could be injured. Be sure all tires (including
the spare, if any) are properly inflated.
Buying New Tires
To find out what kind and size of tires you need, look at
the CertificationRire label.
6-56
The tires installed on your vehicle when it was new had
a Tire Performance Criteria Specification (TPC Spec)
number on each tire’s sidewall. When you get new tires,
get ones with that same TPC Spec number. That way
your vehicle will continue to havetires that are designed
to give proper endurance, handling, speed rating,
traction, ride and other things during
normal service on
your vehicle. If your tires have an all-season tread
design, the TPC number will be followed by an “MS”
(for mud and snow).
If you ever replace your tires with those not having a
TPC Spec number, make sure they are the same size,
load range, speed rating and construction type (bias,
bias-belted or radial) as your original tires.
A CAUTION:
Mixing tires could cause you to lose control while
driving. If you mixtires of different sizes or types
(radial andbias-belted tires), the vehicle may not
handle properly, and you could have a crash.
Using tires of different sizes may also cause
damage toyour vehicle. Be sure to use the same
size and type tires on all wheels.
A CAUTION:
If you usebias-ply tires on your vehicle, the
wheel rim flanges could develop cracks after
many miles of driving. A tire and/or wheel could
fail suddenly, causing a crash. Use only radial-ply
tires with the wheels on your vehicle.
Uniform Tire Quality Grading
The following informationrelates to the system
developed by the United States National Highway
Traffic Safety Administration, which grades tires by
treadwear, traction and temperature performance. (This
applies only to vehicles sold in the United States.) The
grades are molded on the sidewalls of most passenger
car tires. The Uniform Tire Quality Grading system does
not apply to deep tread, winter-type snow tires,
space-saver or temporary use spare tires, tires with
nominal rim diameters of 10 to 12 inches (25 to 30 cm),
or to some limited-production tires.
6-57
While the tires availableon General Motors passenger
cars and light trucks may vary with respect to these
grades, they must also conformto Federal safety
requirements and additional General MotorsTire
Performance Criteria (TPC) standards.
Treadwear
The treadwear grade is a comparative
rating based on
the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled
conditions on a specified government test course. For
example, a tiregraded 150 would wear one and a half
(1 1/2) times as well on the government courseas a tire
graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends
upon the actual conditions of their use, however, and
may depart significantly from thenorm due to variations
in driving habits, service practices and differences in
road characteristics and climate.
Traction
-- A, B, C
The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are
A, B, and
C, and they represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet
pavement as measured under controlled conditions on
specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete.
A tire marked C may have poor traction performance.
6-58
Warning: The traction grade assigned to this tire isbased
on braking (straight ahead)traction tests and doesnot
include cornering (turning) traction.
Temperature
-- A, B, C
The temperaturegrades are A (the highest), B, and C,
representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of
heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under
controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory
test wheel. Sustained high temperature can causethe
material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and
excessive temperature canlead to sudden tire failure.
The grade C correspondsto a level of performance
which all passenger cartires must meet under the
Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109.
Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance
on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required
by law.
Warning: The temperature grade forthis tire is
established for atire that is properly inflated and not
overloaded. Excessive speed,underinflation, or
excessive loading, either separately or in combination,
can cause heat buildup and possible tire failure.
Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance
The wheels on your vehicle were aligned and balanced
carefully at the factory to give you the longest tire life
and best overall performance.
Scheduled wheel alignmentand wheel balancing arenot
needed. However,if you notice unusual tire wear or
your vehicle pulling one way or the other, the alignment
may need to be reset. If you notice your vehicle
vibrating when driving on a smooth road, your wheels
may need to be rebalanced.
Wheel Replacement
Replace any wheel that is bent, cracked,or badly rusted
or corroded. If wheel nuts keep coming loose,the wheel,
wheel bolts and wheelnuts should be replaced.If the
wheel leaks air, replace it (except some aluminum
wheels, which can sometimes be repaired). See your
dealer if any of these conditions exist.
Your dealer will know the kind of wheel you need.
Each new wheel should havethe same load-carrying
capacity, diameter, width, offset and be mounted the
same way as the one it replaces.
If you need to replace any of your wheels, wheel bolts
or wheel nuts, replace them onlywith new GM original
equipment parts. This way, you will be sure to have the
right wheel, wheel bolts and wheel nuts for your vehicle.
CAUTION:
Using the wrong replacement whgls, wheel bolts
or wheel nuts on your vehicle can be dangerous.
It could affect the braking and handling
of your
vehicle, make your tireslose air andmake you
lose control. You could have a collision in which
you or others could be injured. Always use
the correctwheel, wheelbolts and wheel nuts
for replacement.
I NOTICE:
The wrong wheel can also cause problems with
bearing life, brake cooling, speedometer or
odometer calibration, headlampaim, bumper
height, vehicle ground clearance and tire
or tire
chain clearanceto the body and chassis.
6-59
Whenever a wheel, wheel bolt or wheel nut is replaced
on a dual wheel setup, check the wheel nut torque after
100, 1,000 and 6,000 miles (160, 1 600 and 10 000 km)
of driving. For proper torque, see “Wheel Nut Torque”
in the Index.
See “Changing a Flat Tire” in the Index for
more information.
Used Replacement Wheels
1A
CAUTION:
Tire Chains
NOTICE:
If your vehicle has dual wheels, P265/75R16or
LT265/75R16 sizetires, don’t use tire chains.
They can damage your vehicle because there’s
not enough clearance.
Use another type of traction device onlyif its
manufacturer recommends it for use on your
vehicle and tiresize combination and road
conditions. Followthat manufacturer’s
instructions. To help avoid damage to your
vehicle, drive slowly, readjust or remove the
device if it’s contacting your vehicle, and don’t
spin your wheels.
If you do find tractiondevices that will fit, install
them on the rear tires.
NOTICE: (Continued)
I
Putting a used wheel on your vehicle is
dangerous. You can’t know how it’s been used or
how far it’s been driven. It could fail suddenly
and cause an accident. If you have to replace a
wheel, use a new GM original equipment wheel.
6-60
NOTICE: (Continued)
If you don’t have dual wheels or if you have a tire
size other thanP265/75Rl6 or LT26975R16, use
tire chainsonly where legal and only whenyou
must. Use chains that are the proper
size for your
tires. Install them on the tires
of the rearaxle.
Don’t use chains on the tiresof the frontaxle.
Tighten them as tightly as possible with the ends
securely fastened. Drive slowlyand follow the chain
manufacturer’s instructions.If you can hear the
chains contacting yourvehicle, stop and retighten
them. If the contact continues, slow down untilit
stops. Driving toofast or spinning the wheels with
chains onwill damage yourvehicle.
Appearance Care
Remember, cleaning products can be hazardous. Some
are toxic. Others can burst into flame
if you strike a
match or get them on a hot part
of the vehicle. Someare
dangerous if you breathe their fumes in a closed space.
When you use anything from a container to clean your
vehicle, be sure to follow the manufacturer’s warnings
and instructions. And always open your doors or
windows when you’re cleaning the inside.
Never use these to clean
your vehicle:
Gasoline
Benzene
Naphtha
CarbonTetrachloride
Acetone
PaintThinner
Turpentine
LacquerThinner
Nail Polish Remover
They can all be hazardous-- some more than others-and they can all damage your vehicle, too.
Don’t use any of these unless this manual says
you can.
In many uses, these will damage your vehicle:
Alcohol
Laundry Soap
Bleach
ReducingAgents
6-61
Cleaning the Insideof Your Vehicle
Use a vacuum cleaner often to get rid of dust and loose
dirt. Wipe vinyl, leather, plastic and painted surfaces
with a clean, damp cloth.
Your dealer has two cleaners, Multi-Purpose Interior
Cleaner and Capture Non-Solvent Dry Spot and Soil
Remover for cleaning fabric and carpet. They will
clean normal spots and stains very well. You can get
GM-approved cleaning products from your dealer. (See
“Appearance Care and Materials” in the Index.)
Here are somecleaning tips:
Using Multi-Purpose Interior Cleaner
on Fabric
1 . Vacuum and brush the area to remove any loose dirt.
2. Always clean a whole trim panel or section.Mask
surrounding trim along stitch or welt lines.
3. Mix powdered cleaner following the directions on
the container label to form thick suds.
4. Use suds only and apply with a clean sponge. Don’t
saturate the material and don’t rub it roughly.
0
Always f&d the instructions on the cleaner label.
5. As soon as you’ve cleaned the section, use a sponge
to remove the suds.
0
Clean up stains as soon as you can -- before they set.
6. Wipe cleaned area with a clean, damp towel or cloth.
Carefully scrape off any excess stain.
7. Wipe with a clean cloth and let dry.
Use a clean cloth or sponge, and change to a
clean area often. A soft brush may be used if
stains are stubborn.
If a ring forms after spot cleaning, clean the entire
area immediately or it will set.
6-62
Special Fabric Cleaning Problems
Fabric Protection
Stains caused by catsup, coffee (black), egg, fruit, fruit
juice, milk, soft drinks, wine, vomit, urine and blood can
be removed as follows:
1. Carefully scrape off excess stain, then sponge the
soiled area with cool water.
Your vehicle has upholstery and carpet that has been
treated with Scotchgard Fabric Protector, a 3M
product. It protects fabrics by repelling oil and water,
which are the carriers of most stains. Even with this
protection, you still need to clean your upholstery and
carpet often to keep it looking new.
2. If a stain remains, follow the multi-purpose interior
cleaner instructions describedearlier.
3. If an odor lingers after cleaning vomit or urine, treat
the area with a watedbaking soda solution:
I teaspoon ( 5 ml) of baking soda to 1 cup (250 ml)
of lukewarm water.
4. Let dry.
Stains caused by candy, ice cream, mayonnaise, chili
sauce and unknown stains can be removed as follows:
1. Carefully scrape off excess stain.
2. First, clean with cool water and allow to
dry completely.
Further information on cleaning is available by calling
1-800-433-3296 (in Minnesota, 1-800-642-6167).
Cleaning Vinyl
Use warm water and a clean cloth.
Rub with a clean, damp cloth to remove dirt. You
may have to do it more than once.
Things like tar, asphalt and shoe polish will stain if you
don’t get themoff quickly. Use a clean cloth anda
vinyueather cleaner. See your dealer for this product.
3. If a stain remains, follow instructions for
Multi-Purpose Interior Cleaner.
6-63
Cleaning Leather
Cleaning Interior Plastic Components
Use a soft cloth with lukewarm water and a mild soap or
saddle soapand wipe dry with a soft cloth. Then,let the
leather dry naturally. Do not use heat to dry.
Use only a mild soap and water solution on a soft
cloth or sponge.Commercial cleaners may affect the
surface finish.
For stubborn stains, use a leather cleaner. See your
dealer for this product.
Never use oils, varnishes, solvent-based or abrasive
cleaners, furniture polish or shoe polish on leather.
0
Soiled or stained leather should be cleaned
immediately. If dirt is allowed to work into the
finish, it can harm the leather.
Cleaning theTop of the Instrument Panel
Use only mild soap and water to clean thetop surfaces
of the instrument panel. Sprays containingsilicones or
waxes may cause annoyingreflections in the windshield
and even make it difficult to see through the windshield
under certain conditions.
6-64
Care of Safety Belts
Keep belts clean and dry.
I A CAUTION:
Do not bleachor dye safety belts. If you do, it
may severely weaken them. In a crash, they
might not be able to provide adequate protection.
Clean safety belts only with mild soap and
lukewarm water.
Cleaning Glass Surfaces
Glass should be cleaned often.GM Glass Cleaner (GM
Part No. 1050427) or a liquid household glass cleaner
will remove normal tobacco smoke and dust filmson
interior glass.
Don’t use abrasive cleaners on glass, because they may
cause scratches. Avoid placing decals on the inside rear
window, since they may have to be scrapedoff later. If
abrasive cleaners are used on the inside of the rear
window, an electric defogger elementmay be damaged.
Any temporary license shouldnot be attached across the
defogger grid.
Cleaning the Outsideof the
Windshield and Wiper Blades
If the windshield is not clear after using the windshield
washer, or if the wiper blade chatters when running,
wax, sap or othermaterial may be on the blade
or windshield.
Clean the outside of the windshield with GM
Windshield Cleaner, Bon Ami@ Powder (non-scratching
glass cleaning powder),GM Part No. 1050011. The
windshield is clean if beads do not form when you rinse
it with water.
Grime from the windshield will stick tothe wiper blades
and affect their performance. Clean the blade by wiping
vigorously with a cloth soakedin full-strength
windshield washer solvent. Thenrinse the blade
with water.
Check the wiper blades and clean them as necessary;
replace blades that look worn.
Weatherstrips
Silicone grease onweatherstrips will make them last
longer, seal better, and not stick or squeak. Apply
silicone grease with a clean cloth at least every six
months. During very cold, damp weathermore frequent
application may be required. (See “Recommended
Fluids and Lubricants” in the Index.)
Cleaning the Outside ofYour Vehicle
The paint finish on your vehicle provides beauty, depth
of color, gloss retentionand durability.
Washing Your Vehicle
The best way to preserve your vehicle’s finish isto keep it
clean by washing it often with lukewarm or cold water.
6-65
Don’t wash your vehicle in the direct raysof the sun.
Don’t use strong soaps or chemical detergents. Use
liquid hand,dish or carwashing (mild detergent)soaps.
You can get GM-approved cleaning products from
your
dealer. (See “Appearance Care and Materials” in the
Index.) Don’t use cleaning agents that are petroleum
based, or that contain acid or abrasives.
All cleaning
agents should be flushed promptly and not allowed to
dry on the surface, orthey could stain. Dry the finish
with a soft, clean chamois or
an all-cotton towel to
avoid surface scratches and water spotting.
High pressurecar washes may cause water to enter
your vehicle.
Cleaning ExteriorLampsLenses
Use lukewarm or coldwater, a soft cloth anda liquid
hand, dish or carwashing (mild detergent) soap to clean
exterior lampsand lenses. Follow instructionsunder
“Washing Your Vehicle.”
Finish Care
Occasional waxing ormild polishing of your vehicle by
hand may be necessary to remove residue from paint
the
finish. You can get GM-approved cleaning products
from yourdealer. (See “Appearance Care and Materials”
in theIndex.)
Your vehicle may have a “basecoatklearcoat” paint
finish. The clearcoat gives more depth and gloss to the
colored basecoat.Always use waxes and polishesthat
are non-abrasive and made for
a basecoat/clearcoat
paint finish.
NOTICE:
Machine compounding or aggressive polishing on
a basecoatlclearcoat paint finish may
dull the
finish or leave swirl marks.
Foreign materials such as calcium chloride
and other
salts, ice melting agents, road oil and
tar, tree sap,bird
droppings, chemicals from industrial chimneys, etc.,
can
damage yourvehicle’s finish if they remain on painted
surfaces. Wash the vehicleas soon as possible. If
necessary, use non-abrasive cleanersthat are marked
safe for painted surfaces to remove foreign
matter.
Exterior painted surfaces are subject
to aging, weather
and chemical falloutthat can taketheir toll overa period
of years. You can help to keep the paint finish looking
new by keeping your vehicle garagedor covered
whenever possible.
Protecting Exterior Bright Metal Parts
Bright metal parts should be cleaned regularly to keep
their luster. Washing with water is all that is usually
needed. However, you may use chrome polish on
chrome or stainlesssteel trim, if necessary.
Use special care with aluminum trim. To avoid
damaging protective trim, never use auto or chrome
polish, steam or caustic soapto clean aluminum. A
coating of wax, rubbed to high polish, is recommended
for all bright metal parts.
Cleaning Aluminum or Chrome
Whec 1.3 (If Equipped)
Keep your wheels clean using a soft clean cloth with
mild soap and water. Rinse with clean water. After
rinsing thoroughly, dry with a soft clean towel. A wax
may then be applied.
The surface of these wheels is similar to the painted
surface of your vehicle. Don't use strong soaps,
chemicals, abrasive polishes, abrasive cleaners or
abrasive cleaning brushes on them because you could
damage the surface. You may use chrome polish on
chrome wheels, but avoid any painted surface of the
wheel, and buff off immediately after application.
Don't take your vehicle through an automatic carwash
that has silicon carbide tire cleaning brushes. These
brushes can also damage the surface of these wheels.
Cleaning Tires
To clean your tires, use a stiff brush with a tire cleaner.
I NOTICE:
When applying a tire dressing always take care to
wipe off any overspray or splash from all painted
surfaces on the body or wheelsof the vehicle.
Petroleum-based products may damage the
paint finish.
Sheet Metal Damage
If your vehicle is damaged and requires sheet metal
repair or replacement, make sure
the body repair shop
applies anti-corrosion material to the parts repaired or
replaced to restore corrosion protection.
6-67
Finish Damage
Chemical Paint Spotting
Any stone chips, fractures or deep
scratches in the finish
should be repaired right away. Bare metal will corrode
quickly and may develop into a major repair expense.
Some weather and atmospheric conditions can createa
chemical fallout. Airborne pollutants can fall upon and
attack painted surfaces on your vehicle. This damage
can take two forms: blotchy, ringlet-shaped
discolorations, and small irregular dark spots etched into
the paint surface.
Minor chips and scratches can be repaired with touch-up
materials available from your dealer orother service
outlets. Larger areas of finish damagecan be corrected
in your dealer’s body and paint shop.
Underbody Maintenance
Chemicals used for ice and snow removal and dust control
can collect on the underbody. If these are not removed,
accelerated corrosion (rust)can occur on the underbody
parts such as fuel lines, frame, floor pan and exhaust
system even though they have corrosion protection.
At least e----~~ spring, flush these materials from the
underbody with plain water. Clean any areas where mud
and other debris can collect. Dirt packed in closed areas
of the frame should be loosened before being flushed.
Your dealer or an underbody car washing system can do
this for you.
6-68
Although no defect in the paint job causes this, GM will
repair, at no charge to the owner, the surfaces of new
vehicles damaged by this fallout condition within
12 months or 12,000 miles (20 000 km) of purchase,
whichever occurs first.
This applies only to materials manufactured and sold by
General Motors. Bodies, body conversions or equipment
not made or sold by General Motors are not covered.
Appearance Care Materials Chart
6-69
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
111111111 IIII 11111111111111 A
I clhl I SAMPLE4UXWM072675 I
0
the model designation,
0
paint information and
0
a list of all production options and special
equipment.
r
ENGINE/&
CODE
I
f1
ASSEMBLY
MODEL YEAR
PLANT
This is the legal
identifier for your vehicle. It appears 011
a plate in the front cornerof the instrument panel, on the
driver’s side. You can seeit if you look through the
windshield from outsideyour vehicle. The VIN also
appears on the Vehicle Certification and Service Parts
labels andthe certificates of title and registration.
Engine Identification
The 8thcharacter in your VIN is the engine code. This
code will help you identify your engine,specifications
and replacement parts.
Be sure that this label is not removed from the vehicle.
Electrical System
Add-on Electrical Equipment
NOTICE:
Don’t add anything electrical to your vehicle
unless you check with your dealer first. Some
electrical equipment can damage your vehicle
and the damage wouldn’t be covered by your
warranty. Some add-on electrical equipment
can keep other components from working
as
they should.
Service Parts Identification Label
You’ll find this label on the inside of the glove box.It’s
very helpful if you ever need to orderparts. On this
label is:
0
your VIN,
6-70
Your vehicle has an air bagsystem. Before attempting to
add anything electrical to your vehicle, see “Servicing
Your Air Bag-Equipped Vehicle” in the Index.
Headlamps
Fuses and Circuit Breakers
The headlamp wiring is protected by an internal circuit
breaker. An electrical overloadwill cause the lamps
to go on and off, or in some cases to remainoff. If
this happens, haveyour headlamp wiring checked
right away.
The wiring circuitsin your vehicle are protected from
short circuitsby a combinationof fuses, circuit breakers
and fusible thermallinks. This greatly reduces the
chance of fires causedby electrical problems.
Windshield Wipers
The windshield wiper motor isprotected by a circuit
breaker and a fuse.If the motor overheats dueto heavy
snow, etc., the wiper will stopuntil the motor cools. If
the overload is caused
by some electrical problemand
not snow, etc., be sure toget it fixed.
Power Windows and Other Power Options
Circuit breakers protect the power windows and
other
power accessories. When the current load
is too heavy,
the circuit breaker opensand closes, protecting the
circuit until the problem is fixed
or goes away.
If the
Look atthe silver-colored band inside the fuse.
band is broken or melted, replace
the fuse. Be sure you
replace a bad fuse with new
a one of the identical size
and rating.
If you ever have a problem on
the road and don’t have a
spare fuse,you can “borrow” onethat has the same
amperage. Just pick some feature
of your vehicle that
you can get along without-- like the radioor cigarette
lighter -- and use its fuse,if it is the correct amperage.
Replace it as soon asyou can.
6-71
Instrument Panel FuseBlock
The fuse block access door
is on the driver’s side edge
of the instrument panel. Pull
off the cover to access the
fuse block.
You can remove fuses with a fuseextractor. The fuse
extractor ismounted to the fuseblock access door. To
remove fusesif you don’t have a fuseextractor, hold the
end of the fuse between your thumb and index finger
and pull straight out.
You may have spare fuses located behind the fuse block
access door. These can be used to replace a bad fuse.
However, make sure it is of the correct amperage.
Fuse/Circuit
Usage
Breaker
1
2
6-72
02
0 3
08
0 9
0 4
0 5
0.7
Stop/TCC
Switch,
Buzzer,
CHMSL, Hazard Lamps,
Stoplamps
Transfer Case
FuseKircuit
Breaker
3
4
Usage
Courtesy Lamps, Cargo Lamp,
Glove Box Lamp, DomeIReading
Lamps, Vanity Mirrors,
Power Mirrors
Instrument Cluster, DRLRelay,
Lamp Switch, KeylessEntry,
Low Coolant Module,
Illuminated Entry Module,
DRAC (Diesel Engine)
Fuse/Circuit
Breaker
10
Air Bag System
11
Wiper Motor, Washer Pump
12
A/C, A/C Blower,
High Blower Relay
13
Power Amp, Cigarette Lighter,
Door LockRelay,
Power Lumbar Seat
14
4WD Indicator, Cluster, Comfort
Controls, Instrument Switches,
Radio Illumination,
Chime Module
15
DRL Relay, Fog Lamp Relay
16
Front and Rear Turn Signals,
Back-up Lamps, BTSI Solenoid
17
Radio (Ignition)
18
4WAL/VCM, ABS,
Cruise Control
19
Radio (Battery)
Not Used
Cruise Control
Auxiliary Power Outlet
Crank
License Lamp, Parking Lamps,
Taillamps, Roof Marker Lamps,
Tailgate Lamps, Front
Sidemarkers, Fog LampRelay,
Door Switch Illumination,
Fender Lamps, Headlamp
Switch Illumination
Usage
6-73
Fuse/Circuit
Breaker
Underhood Fusemelay Center
Usage
20
PRNDL, Automatic Transmission,
Speedometer, Check Gages
Warning Light
21
SecurityISteering
22
Not Used
23
Not Used
24
Front Axle, 4WD Indicator Lamp,
TP2 Relay (Gasoline Engine)
A
Power Door Lock, Six-Way Power
Seat, Keyless Entry Module
B
Power Windows
The underhood fusehelay center is located in the rear of
the engine compartment near the brake fluid reservoir.
Move the retainer clips for the cover to access the
fuse block.
You can remove fuseswith a fuse extractor. The fuse
extractor is mounted to the interior fuse block. To
remove fuses if you don’t have a fuse extractor, hold the
end of the fuse between your thumb and index finger
and pull straight out.
6-74
Name
HORN
AUX FAN
ECM- 1
HTD ST-FR
AIC
HTD MIR
ENG- 1
HTD ST-RR
LIGHTING
Name
ECM-B
RR DEFOG
IGN-E
FUEL SOL
GLOW PLUG
Usage
BATT
Fuel Pump,PCMNCM
Switch
Ignition
IGN-A
Rear Window Defogger
Ignition
IGN-B
Auxiliary Fan Relay Coil, A/C Switch
Compressor Relay, Hot Fuel
ABS
Module, Dual Tanks
BLOWER
Fuel Solenoid (Diesel Engine)
STOP/HAZ
Glow Plugs (Diesel Engine)
HEATED SEATS
Usage
Horn, Underhood Lamps
Auxiliary Fan
Injectors, PCMNCM
Not Used
Air Conditioning
Not Used
Ignition Switch, EGR, Canister
Purge, EVRV Idle Coast Solenoid,
Heated 0 2 , Fuel Heater
(Diesel Engine),Water Sensor
(Diesel Engine)
Not Used
Headlamp and Panel Dimmer
Switch, Fog and Courtesy Fuses
Battery,Block
Fuse
Busbar
Anti-Lock Brake Module
High Blower Relay
Stoplamps
Not Used
6-75
Replacement Bulbs
Number
Quantity
Exterior
Lamps
Sealed Beam Headlamps
Composite Low-Beam
Headlamps
Composite High-Beam
Headlamps
Front Marker Lamp
Front Parking and
Turn Lamp
Rear Parking Lamp
Rear Stop and
Turn Lamp
Back-up Lamp
Fender Marker Lamp
Roof Marker Lamp
License Plate Lamp
Center High-Mounted
Stoplamp
Underhood Lamp
Pickup Box
Identification Lamp
6-76
2
H6054
2
9006
2
2
9005
194
4
2
2357NA
3057
3057
3 156
194
194
194
4
1
92 1
93
3
153R"
Interior Lamps
Dome Lamps
Reading Lamps
Door Courtesy Lamps
Four-Wheel-Drive
Indicator" *
Four-Wheel-Drive
Shift Lever**
Instrument Panel
Compartment Lamp
Ashtray Lamp
Sunshade Vanity Mirror
* Peterson Manufacturing
** Manual Transfer Case
Quantity
Number
2
2
2
21 1-2
21 1-2
194
1
194
1
194
194
194
74
Capacities and Specifications
Please refer to “Recommended Fluids and Lubricants”in the Index for more information.
VIN Code
Spark Plug Gap
“VORTEC” 4300
Type
V6
W
0.060 inches (1.52 mm)
“VORTEC” 5000
V8
“VORTEC” 5700
V8
M
R
“VORTEC” 7400
V8
J
0.060 inches (1.52 mm)
0.060 inches (1.52 mm)
0.060 inches (1.52 mm)
Engine
Wheels and Tires
Model
Description
Torque
C 1500
5 bolts (14mm)
140 lb-ft (190 Nam)
K 1500 and C/K 2500
6 bolts (14mm)
140 lb-ft (190 N-m)
C/K 2500(w/C6P)
8 bolts (14mm)
8 bolts ( 1 4mm)
140 lb-ft (190 N-m)
8 bolts (14mm)
5 bolts (5/8 in.)
140 lb-ft (190 N-m)
C/K 3500 (Single Rear Wheels)
C/K 3500 (Dual Rear Wheels)
C 3500 HD Front
C 3500 HD Rear
Tire Pressure
140 lb-ft (190 N-m)
175 lb-ft (240 N-m)
10 bolts (518 in.)
175 lb-ft (240 N.m)
See the CertificationITire label on the rear edgeof the driver’s door
or the incomplete vehicle document
in the cab.
6-77
Normal Maintenance Replacement Parts
Replacement part numbers listed in this section are based on the latest information available at the time of printing,
and are subject to change. If a part listed in this manual is not the same as the part used in your vehicle when it was
built, or if you have any questions,please contact your GM truck dealer.
These specifications are for information only. If you have any questions, see the service manual for the chassis or
refer to the body manufacturer's publications.
VIN Code
Oil Filter*
Air Cleaner Filter*
PCV Valve"
Spark Plugs*
Fuel Filter"
Wiper Blades * *
Wiper Blade Type
Wiper Blade Length
w
M
R
J
PF52
A 1300C??
CV746C
4 1-932
GF626
22154886
Trico
18 inches (45.0 cm)
PF1218T
A 1300C-f?
CV796C
4 1-932
GF626
221 54886
Trico
18 inches (45.0 cm)
PF1218T
A 1300C?-f
CV796C
4 1-932
GF626
221 54886
Trico
18 inches (45.0 cm)
PF1218
A 1300CfT
cv774c
41-932
GF626
22154886
Trico
18 inches (45.0 cm)
*AC partnumber
**GM part number
?Use a PF52 oil filter if your vehicle has four-wheel drive.
"fA 1301C high-capacity air cleanerfilter.
6-78
Cooling System Capacity (Approximate)
After refill, the level must
be rechecked. See “Cooling
System” in the Index.
Engine
“VORTEC” 4300
“VORTEC” 5000
“VORTEC” 5700
“VORTEC” 7400
“VORTEC”
7400 w/3500HD
VIN
W
M
R
J
J
Quantity
13 quarts(12.3 L)
17.5 quarts (16.6 L)
17.5 quarts (16.6 L)
25 quarts (23.5 L)
28.5 quarts (27 L)
Fuel Tank Capacity (Approximate)
WPe
Quantity
Short Bed
26 gallons (98 L)
Long Bed
34 gallons (128 L)
Standard Crew Cab
34 gallons (128L)
Chassis-Cab FrontTank
21 gallons (79 L)
Chassis-Cab RearTank
18 gallons (68 L)
3500 HD Models FrontTank
21 gallons (79L)
3500 HD Models RearTank
18 gallons (68 L)
Crankcase Capacity (Approximate)
Air Conditioning Refrigerants
After refill, the level must
be rechecked. Add enough
engine oil so that the fluidis within the proper operating
range. See “Engine Oil”in the Index.
Not all air conditioning refrigerants are the same.
If the air conditioning system in your
vehicle needs
refrigerant, be sure the proper refrigerant is
used. If
you’re not sure, ask yourdealer.
Engine
“VORTEC” 4300
“VORTEC” 5000
“VORTEC” 5700
“VORTEC” 7400
VIN QuantitywithFilter?
w
4.5 quarts (4.3 L)
M
5 quarts (4.8 L)
R
5 quarts (4.8 L)
J
6.6 quarts (6.3 L)
See the refrigerant charge label under the hood
for
information regarding refrigerant capacity.
?Oil filter shouldbe changed at every oil change.
6-79
fi
6-80
NOTES
Section 7 Maintenance Schedule
This section coversthe maintenance required foryour vehicle. Your vehicle needs these services to retain its safety,
dependability and emission control performance.
7-2
7-4
7-5
7-5
7-6
7-7
Introduction
Part A: Scheduled Maintenance Services
Short Trip/City Definition
Short Trip/City Intervals
Long Trip/Highway Definition
Long Trip/Highway Intervals
7-8
7-28
7-40
7-44
7-46
7-49
Short Trip/City Maintenance Schedule
Long Trip/Highway Maintenance Schedule
Part B: Owner Checks and Services
Part C: Periodic Maintenance Inspections
Part D: Recommended Fluids and Lubricants
Part E: Maintenance Record
7-1
Introduction
IMPORTANT.
Your Vehicle and the Environment
KEEP ENGINE OIL
AT THE PROPER
LEVEL AND CHANGE AS
RECOMMENDED
~
I
.
protection
Plan
I
Have you purchased the GM Protection Plan ? The Plan
supplements your new vehicle warranties. See your
Warranty and Owner Assistance booklet,or your GM
dealer for details.
7-2
Proper vehicle maintenance not only helps to keep your
vehicle in good working condition, but also helps the
environment. All recommended maintenance procedures
are important. Improper vehicle maintenance can even
affect the quality of the air we breathe. Improper fluid
levels or the wrong tire inflation can increase the level
of emissions fromyour vehicle. To help protect our
environment, and to keep your vehicle in good
condition, please maintain your vehicle properly.
How This Section is Organized
The remainder of this section is divided into five parts:
“Part A: Scheduled Maintenance Services”shows
what to have done and how often. Someof these
services can be complex, so unless you are technically
qualified and have the necessary equipment, you should
let your dealer’s service department or another qualified
service center do these jobs.
I /A
CAUTlJN:
Performing maintenance work on a vehicle can
be dangerous. In trying to dosome jobs, you can
be seriously injured. Do your own maintenance
work only if you have the requiredknow-how
and the propertools and equipment for thejob.
If you have any doubt, have a qualified
technician do the work.
If you are skilled enough to do somework on your
vehicle, you will probably want to get the service
information. See “Service and OwnerPublications” in
the Index.
“Part C: Periodic Maintenance Inspections” explains
important inspections that your dealer’s service department
or another qualified service center should perform.
“Part D: Recommended Fluids and Lubricants” lists
some recommended products to help keepyour vehicle
properly maintained. These products, or their
equivalents, should be used whether you do the work
yourself or have it done.
“Part E: Maintenance Record” provides a place for
you to record the maintenance performed on your
vehicle. Whenever any maintenance is performed, be
sure to write it down in this part. This will help you
determine when your next maintenance should be done.
In addition, it is a good idea to keep your maintenance
receipts. They may be needed to qualify your vehicle for
warranty repairs.
“Part B: Owner Checks and Services” tells you wmt
should be checked and when. It also explains whatyou
can easily do to help keep your vehicle in good condition.
7-3
r
~
1
~
Part A: Scheduled Maintenance
Services
Using Your Maintenance Schedule
We at General Motors want to help
you keep your
vehicle in good working condition. But we
don’t know
exactly how you’ll driveit. You may drive very short
distances only a few times a week. Or you may drive
long distances all the time very
in hot, dustyweather.
You may use your vehicle in making deliveries.
Or you may drive it to work, todo errands or in
many other ways.
Because of all the differentways people use their
vehicles, maintenance needsvary. You may even need
more frequent checks and replacements
than you’ll find
in the schedules in this section.
So please read this
section and notehow you drive. If you have any
questions onhow to keep your vehicle in good
condition, seeyour dealer.
This part tellsyou the maintenance servicesyou should
have done andwhen you should schedulethem. If you
go to your dealer for
your service needs,you’ll know
that GM-trained and supported service peoplewill
perform thework using genuine parts.
7-4
The proper fluids and lubricants to useare listed in Part D.
Make sure whoever services your vehicle uses these. All
parts should be replaced and all necessary repairs done
before you or anyone else drives the vehicle.
These schedules are for vehicles that:
carry passengers and cargo within recommended
limits. You will find these limits on your
vehicle’s
Certificationmire label. See “LoadingYour Vehicle”
in the Index.
0 are driven on reasonable road surfaces
within legal
driving limits.
0 are driven off-road in the recommended
manner. See
“Off-Road DrivingWith Your Four-Wheel-Drive
Vehicle” in the Index.
use the recommended fuel. See“Fuel” in the Index.
Selecting the Right Schedule
First you’llneed to decidewhich of the two schedules is
right foryour vehicle. Here’s how to decide which
schedule to follow:
Gasoline engine vehicles and diesel engine
vehicles
have different maintenance requirements.
If you have a
diesel engine, followa schedule designated for diesel
engine vehiclesonly.
See the Diesel Engine Supplement for diesel engine
maintenance schedules.
Maintenance Schedule
Short Trip/City Definition -- Gasoline Engines
Follow the Short TripKity Maintenance Schedule if any
one of these conditions is true for your vehicle:
0
Most trips are less than 5 to 10 miles (8 to 16 km).
This is particularly important when outside
temperatures arebelow freezing.
0
Most trips include extensive idling (such as frequent
driving in stop-and-go traffic).
0
0
Short TripKity Intervals-- Gasoline Engines
Every 3,000 Miles (5 000 km): Engine Oil and Filter
Change (or 3 months, whichever occurs first). Chassis
Lubrication (or 3 months, whichever occurs first).
Drive Axle Service (or 3 months, whichever
occurs first).
Every 6,000 Miles (10 000 km): Tire Rotation.
You frequently tow a trailer.
Every 15,000 Miles (25 000 km): Shields and
Underhood Insulation Inspection (GVWR above
8,500 lbs. only). Front Wheel Bearing Repack
(2WD only) (or at each brake relining, whichever
occurs first).
If the vehicle is used for delivery service, police, taxi
or other commercial application.
Every 30,000 Miles (50 000 km): Fuel Filter
Replacement.
You operate your vehicle in dusty areas or
off-road frequently.
One of the reasons you should follow this schedule if
you operate your vehicle under any of these conditions
is that these conditions cause engineoil to break
down soone'Y:
Every 50,000 Miles (83 000 km): Automatic
Transmission Service (vehicles over 8600 GVWR or
driven under severe conditions only).
Every 60,000 Miles (100 000 km): Engine Accessory
Drive Belt Inspection. Fuel Tank, Cap and Lines
Inspection. Exhaust GasRecirculation System
Inspection. Evaporative Control System Inspection.
Maintenance Schedule
I ShortTripKityIntervals -- Gasoline Engines I
Every 100,000 Miles (166 000 km): Spark Plug Wire
Inspection. Spark Plug Replacement. Automatic
Transmission Service (normal conditions). Positive
Crankcase Ventilation (PCV) Valve Inspection.
Every 150,000 Miles (240 000 km): Cooling System
Service (or every 60 months, whichever occurs first).
These intervals onlysummarize maintenance services.
Be sure to followthe completemaintenance schedule on
the followingpages.
7-6
Long TripBghway Definition -- GasolineEngines
Follow this maintenance schedule only if none of the
conditions from the Short Trip/City Maintenance
Schedule is true. Do not use this schedule if the vehicle
is used for trailer towing, driven in a dusty area or used
off paved roads. Use the Short Trip/City schedule for
these conditions.
Driving a vehicle with amfullywarmed engine under
h.ighway conditions causes engine oil to
break
down slower:
I
Maintenance Schedule
Long Tripmighway Intervals -- Gasoline Engines
I
Long Tripmighway Intervals -- Gasoline Engines
Every 7,500 Miles (12500 km): Engine Oil andFilter
Change (or every12 months, whichever occurs first).
Chassis Lubrication (or every12 months, whichever
occurs first). Drive Axle Service.Tire Rotation.
Every 60,000 Miles (100 000 km): Engine Accessory
Drive Belt Inspection. Fuel Tank, Cap and Lines
Inspection. Exhaust Gas Recirculation System
Inspection. Evaporative Control System Inspection.
Every 15,000 Miles (25000 km): Shields and
Underhood Insulation Inspection (GVWR above
8,500 lbs. only).
Every 100,000 Miles (166 000 km): Spark Plug Wire
Inspection. Spark Plug Replacement. Automatic
Transmission Service (normal conditions). Positive
Crankcase Ventilation (PCV) Valve Inspection.
Every 30,000 Miles (50 000 km): Fuel Filter
Replacement. Front Wheel Bearing Repack
(2WD only) (or at each brake relining, whichever
occurs first).
Every 50,000 Miles (83 000 km): Automatic
Transmission Service (vehicles over8600 GVWR
or driven under severe conditionsonly).
I
Every 150,000 Miles (240 000 km): Cooling System
Service (or every 60 months, whichever occurs first).
These intervalsonly sumrnnrize rnaintenance services.
Be sure to follow the complete maintenance scheduleon
the following pages.
7-7
I Short TriplCity Maintenance Schedule -- Gasoline Engines I
The services shown in this schedule up to100,000miles
(166 000 km) should be performed after 100,000 miles
(166 000 km) at the same intervals. The services shown
at 150,000 miles (240 000 km) should be performed at
the same interval after 150,000 miles (240 000 km).
See “Owner Checksand Services” and “Periodic
Maintenance Inspections” following.
Footnotes
-f The U.S. Environmental Protection Agency or the
California Air Resources Board has determined that the
failure to perform this maintenance item will not nullify
the emission warranty or limitrecall liability prior to the
completion of the vehicle’s useful life. We, however,
urge that all recommended maintenance services be
performed at the indicated intervals and the maintenance
be recorded.
7-8
# Lubricate the front suspension, kingpin bushings,
steering linkage, transmission shift linkage, transfer case
shift linkage, parking brake cable guides,rear driveline
center splines, front axlepropshaft spline and brake
pedal springs. Ball joints and kingpin bushings should
not be lubricated unless their temperature is 10°F
(- 12”C) or higher, or they could be damaged.
+ A good time to check your brakes
isduring tire
rotation. See “Brake System Inspection’’ under “Periodic
Maintenance Inspections” in Part C of this schedule.
I
Short TripKity Maintenance Schedule -- Gasoline Engines I
** Drive axle service (see “Recommended Fluids and
Lubricants” in the Index for properlubricant to use):
0
0
Locking Differential -- Drain fluid and refill at first
engine oil change.At subsequent oil changes, check
fluid level and add fluid as needed.If driving in
dusty areas or towing a trailer, drain fluid and refill
every 15,000 miles (25 000 km).
Standard Differential -- Check fluid level and add
fluid as needed at every oil change.If driving in
dusty areas or towing a trailer, drain fluid and refill
every 15,000 miles (25 000 km).
0
More frequent lubrication may be required for
heavy-duty or off-road use.
3500 HD Models with applications requiring
extreme overload/trailer towing conditionsand
high-speed (above 45 mph or 70 k d h ) conditions
for extendedperiods of time must have the drive axle
fluid changed every 30,000 miles (50 000 km).
See “Recommended Fluids and Lubricants” in
this section.
7-9
Short Trip/City Maintenance Schedule-- Gasoline Engines
3,000 Miles (5 000 km)
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
MILEAGE
0 Lubricate chassis components (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote #.)
0 Check readfront axle fluid level and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking. (See footnote **.)
6,000 Miles (10 000 km)
0 Change engine oiland filter (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
0 Check readfront axle fluid level and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking. (See footnote **.)
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote +.)
9,000 Miles (15 000 km)
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
7-10
DATE
MILEAGE
DATE
I
I
Short Trip/City Maintenance Schedule -- Gasoline Engines I
0 Lubricate chassis components (orevery 3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
0 Check readfront axle fluidlevel and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals forleaking. (See footnote **.)
DATE
I
15,000 Miles (25 000 km)
I DATE
I
0 Change engine oiland filter (or every3 months, whichever occurs first).
I
12,000 Miles (20 000 km)
0 Change engine oil and filter (orevery 3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control!Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
0 Check readfront axle fluidlevel and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking. (See footnote*‘k.)
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote+.)
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (orevery 3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
ACTUAL
MILEAGE
I
SERVICEDBY:
I
(Continued)
7-11
Short TripKity Maintenance Schedule -- Gasoline Engines
15,000 Miles (25 000 km) (Continued)
0 Check readfront axlefluid level and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals forleaking. (See footnote **.)
0 For Two-Wheel-Drive vehicles only: Clean and repack the front wheel
bearings (or at each brake relining, whichever occurs first).
0 Vehicles With GVWR Above 8,500 lbs. Only: Inspect shields and underhood
insulation for damageor looseness. Adjust or replace as required.
This is a Noise Emission Control Service. Applicable only to vehicles
sold in the United States.
18,000 Miles (30 000 km)
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
Lubricate chassis components (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
Check readfront axle fluid level and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals forleaking. (See footnote **.)
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote+.)
21,000 Miles (35 000 km)
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
7-12
MILEAGE
I
~
I
I
I
Short Trip/City Maintenance Schedule
-- Gasoline Engines I
Lubricate chassis components (or every3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
17 Check readfront axle fluid level and add fluid
as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking. (See footnote
**.)
24,000 Miles (40 000 km)
DATE
1
DATE
I
3 months, whichever occurs first).
t u Change engine oil and filter (or every
An Emission Control Service.
17 Lubricate chassis components (or every3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
0 Check readfront axle fluid level and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking. (See footnote
**.)
Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote
+.)
lI 27,000
o Miles (45 000 km)
Change engine oil and filter (or every
3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (or every3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
0 Check readfront axle fluid level and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking. (See footnote
**.)
7-13
I
Short TripKity Maintenance Schedule -- Gasoline Engines
30,000 Miles (50 000 km)
I
DATE
I
DATE
I
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
Lubricate chassis components (orevery 3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote #.)
0 Check readfront axle fluidlevel and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals forleaking. (See footnote **.)
0 For Two-Wheel-Drive vehicles only: Clean and repack the front wheel
bearings (or at each brake relining, whichever occurs first).
0 Replace fuel filter.
An Emission Control Service. (See footnote?.)
0 Vehicles With GVWR Above 8,500 lbs. Only: Inspect shields and underhood
insulation for damage orlooseness. Adjust or replace as required.
This is a Noise Emission Control Service. Applicable only to vehicles
sold in the United States.
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation’’ in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote +.)
33,000 Miles (55000 km)
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
7-14
I
Short Trip/City Maintenance Schedule
-- Gasoline Engines I
0 Lubricate chassis components(or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
0 Check readfront axle fluid level and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals forleaking. (See footnote **.)
36,000 Miles (60 000 km)
DATE
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (or every3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote +.)
0 Check readfront axle fluid level and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking. (See footnote
**.)
39,000 Miles (65 000 km)
0 Change engine oiland filter (or every3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Enaission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (orevery 3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote #.)
0 Check readfront axle fluidlevel and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking. (See footnote
**,)
7-15
I
Short TriplCity Maintenance Schedule
-- Gasoline Engines I
42,000 Miles (70 000 km)
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (orevery 3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote #.)
0 Check readfront axle fluid level
and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints andaxle seals forleaking. (See footnote **.)
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote +.)
I
DATE
ACTUl
MILEAGE
45,000 Miles (75 000 km)
I DATE
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
I
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (orevery 3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote #.)
0 Check readfront axle fluidlevel and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking. (See footnote**.)
0 For Two-Wheel-Drive vehicles only: Clean and repack the front wheel
bearings (or at each brake relining, whichever occurs first).
Vehicles With GVWR Above 8,500 lbs. Only: Inspect shields and underhood
insulation for damage or looseness. Adjust or replace as required.
This is a Noise Emission Control Service. Applicable only to vehicles
sold in the United States.
7-16
ACTUAL
MILEAGE
I
I
SERVICEDBY
I
1
I
SERVICEDBX
I
I
Short TripKity Maintenance Schedule -- Gasoline Engines I
I DATE
48,000 Miles (80 000 km)
Change engine oil andfilter (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
A n Emission Control Service.
Lubricate chassis components(or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
0 Check readfront axlefluid level and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking. (See footnote
** .)
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote +.)
I
1
ACTUAL
MILEAGE
SERVICED BY:
50,000 Miles (83 000 km)
0 Change automatic transmission fluid and filterif the vehicle’s GVWR is over
8600 lbs. or if the vehicle is mainly driven under
one or more of these conditions:
MILEAGE
In heavy city traffic where the outside temperature regularly reaches
90°F (32°C) or higher.
- In hilly or mountainous terrain.
- When doing frequent trailer towing.
- Uses such as found in taxi, police or delivery service.
If you do not use pour vehicle under any of these conditions,change the fluid
and filter at 100,000 miles ( I 66 000 km).
Manual transmission fluid doesn’t require change.
-
7-17
I
Short TripKity Maintenance Schedule-- Gasoline Engines I
51,000 Miles (85 000 km)
DATE
I
I DATE
I
Change engineoil and filter (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
Lubricate chassis components (orevery 3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote #.)
Check readfront axle fluid
level and add fluid asneeded. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals forleaking. (See footnote **.)
54,000 Miles (90 000 km)
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (orevery 3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.>
0 Check readfront axle fluidlevel and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking. (See footnote **.)
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation’’ in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote+.)
57,000 Miles (95000 km)
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
7-18
MILEAGE
DATE
MILEAGE
I
Short Trip/City Maintenance Schedule-- Gasoline Engines
El Lubricate chassis components (or every3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
0 Check readfront axle fluidlevel and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking. (See footnote
*;$.)
60,000 Miles (100 000 km)
DATE
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
0 Check readfront axle fluidlevel and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking. (See footnote
*;c.)
0 For Two-Wheel-Drive vehicles only: Clean and repack the front wheel
bearings (or at each brake relining, whichever occurs first).
0 Vehicles With GVWR Above 8,500 lbs. Only: Inspect shieldsand underhood
insulation for damage or looseness. Adjust or replace as required.
This is a Noise Emission Control Service. Applicable only ro vehicles
sold in the United States.
0 Inspect engine accessory drive belt.
An Emission Control Service.
ACTUAL
MILEAGE
I
I
SERVICED B Y
(Continued)
7-19
I
Short Trip/City Maintenance Schedule -- Gasoline Engines
1
60,000 Miles (100 000 km) (Continued)
Replace fuel filter.
An Emission Control Service. (See footnote?.)
Conduct Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) system inspection as described in
the servicemanual.
An Em.ission Control Service. (See footnote?.)
0 Conduct evaporative control system inspection. Check all fuel and vapor lines
and hoses for proper hook-up, routing and condition. Check that the purge
valve works properly (if equipped). Replace as needed.
An Emission Control Service. (See footnote?.)
Inspect fuel tank, capand lines for damage orleaks. Inspect fuel cap gasket
for any damage. Replace parts as needed.
An Emission Control Service. (See footnoteJf.)
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote+.)
63,000 Miles (105 000 km)
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote #.)
0 Check readfront axlefluid level and add fluid asneeded. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking. (Seefootnote **.)
7-20
DATE
ACTUAL
MILEAGE
SERVICED B Y
I
Short TripKity Maintenance Schedule -- Gasoline Engines I
66,000 Miles (110 000 km)
0 Change
DATE
ACTUAL
MILEAGE
69,000 Miles (115 000 km)
DATE
I
I DATE
I
engine oil and filter (or
every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
An EmissionControl Service.
El Lubricate chassis components (orevery 3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
0 Check readfront axle fluid level and
add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking.(See footnote **.)
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote+.)
0 Change
engine oil and filter (or every
3 months, whichever occursfirst).
An EmissionControl Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (or every3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
0 Check readfront axlefluid level and add fluid as needed. Checkconstant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking. (See footnote
**.)
72,000 Miles (120 000 km)
SERVICED BY:
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
Lubricate chassis components (or every3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
(Continued)
7-21
Short TripKity Maintenance Schedule -- Gasoline Engines
72,000 Miles (120 000 km) (Continued)
0 Check readfront axle fluid level and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals forleaking. (See footnote**.)
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote +.)
75,000 Miles (I25 000 km)
I DATE
Change engineoil and filter (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (orevery 3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote #.)
0 For Two-Wheel-Drive vehicles only: Clean and repack the front wheel
bearings (or at eachbrake relining, whichever occurs first).
0 Check readfront axlefluid level and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals forleaking. (See footnote **.)
0 Vehicles With GVWR Above 8,500 lbs. Only: Inspect shields and underhood
insulation for damage or looseness. Adjust or replace as required.
This isn Noise Emission Control Service. Applicable only to vehicles sold in
the United States.
MILEAGE
78,000 Miles (130 000 km)
I DATE
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
I
An Emission Control Service.
7-22
I
ACTUAL
MILEAGE
I
1
SERVICEDBY:
I
I
Short TripKity Maintenance Schedule -- Gasoline Engines I
0 Lubricate chassis components (or every3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
0 Check readfront axle fluidlevel and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking. (See footnote
**.)
17 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote+.)
I
81,000 Miles (135 000 km)
DATE
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (or every3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
0 Check readfront axlefluid level and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking. (See footnote**.)
84,000 Miles (140 000 km)
ACTUAL
MILEAGE
DATE
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
I
I SERVICEDBY I
I
MILEAGE
(Continued)
7-23
Short Trip/City Maintenance Schedule -- Gasoline Engines
84,000 Miles (140 000 km) (Continued)
Check readfront axlefluid level and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals forleaking. (See footnote **.)
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote +.)
87,000 Miles (145 000 km)
Change engineoil and filter (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first),
An Emission Control Service.
Lubricate chassis components(or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote #.)
Check readfront axle fluid
level and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals forleaking. (See footnote **.)
90,000 Miles (150 000 km)
0 Change engine oiland filter (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
0 Check readfront axle fluidlevel and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking. (See footnote *$.)
0 For Two-Wheel-Drive vehicles only: Clean and repack the front wheel
bearings (or at each brake relining, whichever occurs first).
7-24
I DATE
I
MILEAGE
DATE
MILEAGE
I
I
Short Trip/City Maintenance Schedule -- Gasoline Engines
0 Replace fuel filter. An Emission Control Service. (See footnote?.)
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation”in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote+.)
0 Vehicles With GVWR Above 8,500 lbs. Only: Inspect shields andunderhood
insulation for damage or looseness. Adjust or replace as required.
This is a Noise Em.ission Control Service. Applicableonly to vehicles
sold in the United States.
93,000 Miles (155 000 km)
0 Change engineoil and filter (or every3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Enfission Control!Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote #.)
0 Check readfront axlefluid level and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking.(See footnote **.)
96,000 Miles (160 000 km)
DATE
ACTUAL
MILEAGE
DATE
SERVICED BY:
I
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (or every3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote #.)
(Continued)
7-25
Short TripKity Maintenance Schedule -- Gasoline Engines I
96,000 Miles (160 000 km) (Continued)
0 Check readfront axle fluidlevel and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals forleaking. (See footnote **.)
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote+.)
99,000 Miles (165 000 km)
DATE
I
DATE
I
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (or every 3 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote #.)
0 Check readfront axle fluid level and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals forleaking. (See footnote **.)
100,000 Miles (166 000 km)
Inspect spark plug wires.
An Emission Control Service.
0 Replace spark plugs.
An Emission Control Service.
0 Change automatic transmission fluid and filterif the vehicle’s GVWR is over
8600 lbs. or if the vehicle is mainly driven under one or more of these conditions:
- In heavy city traffic where the outside temperature regularly reaches
90°F (32°C) or higher.
7-26
I
Short TripKity Maintenance Schedule -- Gasoline Engines
1
- In hilly or mountainous terrain.
- When doing frequent trailer towing.
- Uses such as found in taxi, police or delivery service.
Manual transmission fluid doesn’t require change.
If you haven’t used your vehicle under severe service conditionslisted
previously and, therefore, haven’t changed your automatictransmission fluid,
change both the fluid and filter.
Manual transmission fluid doesn’t require change.
0 Inspect Positive Crankcase Ventilation (PCV) valve.
An Emission Control Service.
150,000 Miles (240 000 km)
DATE
0 Drain, flush and refill cooling system (or every 60 months since last service,
whichever occurs first).See “Engine Coolant’’ in the Index for what to use.
Inspect hoses. Clean radiator, condenser, pressure cap and neck. Pressure test
cooling system and pressure cap.
An Emission Control Service.
7-27
Long Trip/Highway Maintenance Schedule -- Gasoline Engines
The services shown in this schedule up to 100,000 miles
(166 000 km) should be performed after 100,000 miles
(166 000 km) at the same intervals. The services shown
at 150,000 miles (240 000 km) should be performed at
the same interval after 150,000 miles (240 000 km).
See “Owner Checksand Services” and “Periodic
Maintenance Inspections” following.
Footnotes
3- The U.S. Environmental Protection Agency or the
California Air Resources Board has determined that the
failure to perform this maintenance item will not nullify
the emission warranty or limit recall liability prior to the
completion of the vehicle’s useful life. We, however,
urge that all recommended maintenance services be
performed at the indicated intervals and the maintenance
be recorded.
7-28
## Lubricate the front suspension, kingpin bushings,
steering linkage, transmission shift linkage, transfer case
shift linkage, parking brake cable guides, rear driveline
center splines,front axle propshaft spline and brake
pedal springs. Ball joints and kingpin bushings should
not be lubricated unless their temperature is 10°F
(- 12°C) orhigher, or they could be damaged.
+ A good time to check your brakes is during tire
rotation. See “Brake System Inspection”under “Periodic
Maintenance Inspections’’ in Part C of this schedule.
** Drive axle service (see “Recommended Fluids and
Lubricants” in the Index for proper lubricant to use):
Locking Differential -- Drain fluid and refill at first
engine oil change. At subsequent oil changes, check
fluid level and add fluid as needed.
Standard Differential -- Check fluid level and add
fluid as needed at every engine oil change.
3500 HD Models with applications requiring
high-speed (above 45 mph or 70 k d h ) operation for
extended periods of time must have the drive axle
fluid changed every 30,000 miles (50 000 km).
Long Tripmighway Maintenance Schedule -- Gasoline Engines
7,500 Miles ( I 2 500 km)
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every 12 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (orevery 12 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
0 Check readfront axle fluidlevel and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals forleaking. (See footnote **.)
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation’’ in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (Seefootnote +.)
15,000 Miles (25 000 km)
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every 12 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (orevery 12 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
0 Check readfront axlefluid level and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals forleaking. (See footnote **.)
0 Vehicles With GVWR Above 8,500 lbs. Only: Inspect shieldsand underhood
insulation for damageor looseness. Adjust or replace as required.
This is a Noise Emission Control Service. Applicable onlyto vehicles
sold in the United States.
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote+.)
I
I DATE
1
ACTUAL
MILEAGE
SERVICED B Y
I
DATE
SERVICED B Y
7-29
Long Trip/Highway Maintenance Schedule-- Gasoline Engines
22,500 Miles (37 500 km)
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every 12 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (orevery 12 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote #.)
0 Check readfront axlefluid level and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals forleaking. (See footnote **.)
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote +.)
30,000 Miles (50 000 km)
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every 12 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (or every 12 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
0 Check readfront axle fluid level and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for
leaking. (See footnote **.)
0 For Two-Wheel-Drive vehicles only: Clean and repack the front wheel
bearings (or ateach brake relining, whichever occurs first).
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote +.)
0 Replace fuel filter.
An Emission Control Service. (See footnote?.)
7-30
I
DATE
SERVICED B Y
MILEAGE
I DATE
ACTUAL
MILEAGE
I
I
SERVICEDBY:
I Long Trip/Highway Maintenance Schedule
-- Gasoline Engines
0 Vehicles With GVWR Above 8,500 lbs. Only: Inspect shields and underhood
insulation for damage or looseness. Adjust or replace as required.
This is aNoise Emission Control Service. Applicable only to vehicles
sold in the United States.
37,500 Miles (62 500 km)
DATE
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every 12 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
Lubricate chassis components (or every12 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
0 Check readfront axle fluidlevel and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking. (See footnote
**.)
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote+.)
45,000 Miles (75 000 km)
I
ACTUAL
MILEAGE
DATE
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every12 months, whichever occurs first).
I
I
SERVICEDBY
I
I
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (or every 12 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
(Continued)
7-31
ILong Trip/Highway Maintenance Schedule -- Gasoline Engines 1
7-p~
45,000 Miles (75 000 km) (Continued)
Check readfront axle fluid level
and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals forleaking. (See footnote **.)
Vehicles With GVWR Above 8,500 lbs. Only: Inspect shields and underhood
insulation for damageor looseness. Adjust or replace as required.
This is a Noise EmissionControl Service. Applicable onlyto vehicles
sold in the United States.
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote +.)
50,000 Miles (83 000 km)
0 Change automatic transmission fluid and filterif the vehicle’s GVWR is over
8600 lbs. or if the vehicle is mainly driven underone or more of these conditions:
- In heavy city traffic where the outside temperature regularly reaches
90°F (32°C) orhigher.
- In hilly or mountainous terrain.
- When doing frequent trailer towing.
- Uses such as found in taxi, police or delivery service.
I f you do not use your vehicle underany of these conditions,
change thefluid nndfilter at 100,000miles ( I 66 000 km).
Manual transmission fluid doesn’t require change.
7-32
I Long Tripmighway Maintenance Schedule -- Gasoline Engines
52,500 Miles (87 500 km)
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every 12 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (or every 12 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
0 Check readfront axle fluid level and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals forleaking. (See footnote **.)
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote +.)
MILEAGE
+
I DATE
60,000 Miles (100 000 km)
0 Change engine oiland filter (or every 12 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (or every 12 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
0 Check readfront axle fluid level and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals forleaking. (See footnote **.)
0 For Two-Wheel-Drive vehicles only: Clean and repack the front wheel
bearings (or at each brake relining,whichever occurs first).
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote+.)
ACTUAL
MILEAGE
I
SERVICED B Y
(Continued)
7-33
Long Tripmighway Maintenance Schedule-- Gasoline Engines
60,000 Miles (100 000 km) (Continued)
0 Inspect engine accessory drive belt.
An Emission Control Service.
Replace fuel filter. An Emission Control Service. (See footnote?.)
Inspect fuel tank, cap and lines for damage or leaks. Inspect fuel cap gasket
for any damage. Replace parts as needed.
An Emission Control Service. (See footnote?.)
Vehicles With GVWR Above 8,500 lbs. Only: Inspect shields and underhood
insulation for damage orlooseness. Adjust or replace as required.
This is aNoise Emission Control Service. Applicable only to vehicles
sold in the United States.
0 Conduct Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) system inspection as described in
the service manual.
An Emission Control Service. (See footnote?.)
0 Conduct evaporative control system inspection. Check all fuel and vapor lines
and hoses for proper hook-up, routing and condition. Check that the purge
valve works properly, if equipped. Replace as needed.
An Emission Control Service. (See footnote?.)
7-34
Long Trip/Highway Maintenance Schedule -- Gasoline Engines
67,500Miles (112 500 km)
DATE
ACTUAL
MILEAGE
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every 12 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (or every 12 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
0 Check readfront axle fluidlevel and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking. (See footnote **.)
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote +.)
75,000 Miles (125 000 km)
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every 12 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (orevery 12 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote#.)
0 Check readfront axle fluidlevel and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking. (See footnote
**.)
0 Vehicles With GVWR Above 8,500 lbs. Only: Inspect shields and underhoou
insulation for damage or looseness. Adjust or replace as required.
This isa Noise Emission Control Service. Applicable onlyto vehicles
sold in the United States.
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (Seefootnote +.)
I
DATE
ACTUAL
MILEAGE
SERVICED BY:
I
I
SERVICEDBY
I
--
Long Tripmighway Maintenance Schedule Gasoline Engines
82,500 Miles (137 500 km)
0 Change engineoil and filter (or every I2 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emissiorz Cor7trol Service.
Lubricate chassis components (or every 12 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote #.)
0 Check rear/fl-ont axle fluid level and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking. (See footnote
Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote +.)
90,000 Miles (150 000 km)
0 Change engine oil and filter (or every 12 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
Lubricate chassis components (or every 12 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote #.)
0 Check readfront axle fluid level and add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking. (See footnote **.)
0 For Two-Wheel-Drive vehicles only: Clean and repack the front wheel
bearings (or at each brake relining, whichever occurs first).
0 Replace fuel filter. An Emissiolz Control Service. (See footnote?.)
7-36
DATE
MILEAGE
DATE
MILEAGE
I
Long Tripmighway Maintenance Schedule-- Gasoline Engines
0 Vehicles With GVWR Above 8,500 Ibs. Only: Inspect shields and underhood
insulation for damageor looseness. Adjust or replace as required.
This is a Noise Emission Control Service. Applicable only to velzicles
sold in the United States.
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote+.)
97,500 Miles (162 500 km)
0 Change
engine oiland filter (or every 12 months, whichever occurs first).
An Emission Control Service.
0 Lubricate chassis components (orevery 12 months, whichever occurs first).
(See footnote #.)
0 Check readfrontaxle fluid leveland add fluid as needed. Check constant
velocity joints and axle seals for leaking.
(See footnote **.)
0 Rotate tires. See “Tire Inspection and Rotation” in the Index for proper
rotation pattern and additional information. (See footnote+.)
I DATE
I
MILEAGE
7-37
Long Tripmighway Maintenance Schedule-- Gasoline Engines
100,000 Miles ( I 66 000 km)
0 Inspect spark plug wires.
An Emision Control Service.
0 Replace spark plugs.
An Emission Control Service.
0 Change automatic transmission fluid and filter if the vehicle’s GVWR is over
8600 Ibs. or if the vehicle is mainly driven under one or more of these conditions:
- In heavy city traffic where the outside temperature regularly reaches
90°F (32°C) or higher.
- In hilly or mountainous terrain.
- When doing frequent trailer towing.
- Uses such as found in taxi, police or delivery service.
Manual transmission fluid doesn’t require change.
0 If you haven’t used your vehicle under severe service conditions listed
previously and, therefore, haven’t changed your automatic transmission fluid,
change both the fluid and filter.
Manual transmission fluid doesn’t require change.
0 Inspect Positive Crankcase Ventilation (PCV) valve.
A12 Emissiorl Control Service.
7-38
I DATE
MILEAGE
I
1 Long TripMighway Maintenance Schedule -- Gasoline Engines 1
150,000 Miles (240 000 km)
0 Drain, flush and refill cooling system (or every 40 months since last service,
whichever occurs first). See"Engine Coolant" in the Index for what to use.
Inspect hoses. Clean radiator, condenser, pressure cap and neck. Pressure test
the cooling system and pressure cap.
An Emission Control Service.
I DATE
I
1
ACTUAL
MILEAGE
SERVICED B Y
7-39
Part B: Owner Checks and Services
Engine Coolant Level Check
Listed below are owner checks and services which
should be performed at the intervals specified to help
ensure the safety, dependability and emission control
performance of your vehicle.
Check the engine coolant level and add DEX-COOL@
coolant mixture if necessary. See “Engine Coolant” in
the Index for further details.
Be sure any necessary repairs arecompleted at once.
Whenever any fluids or lubricants are added to your
vehicle, make sure they are the proper ones, as shown in
Part D.
Windshield Washer Fluid Level Check
Check the windshield washer fluid level in the
windshield washer tank and add the proper fluid if
necessary. See “Windshield Washer Fluid” in the Index
for further details,
At the First100, 1,000 and 6,000 Miles
(160,1600 and 10 000 km)
At Least Once a Month
For vehicles with dual wheels, check dual wheel nut
torque. For proper torque, see “Wheel Nut Torque” in
the Index.
Tire Inflation Check
Make sure tires are inflated to the correct pressures.
See “Tires” in the Index for further details.
At Each Fuel Fill
Cassette Deck Service
Clean cassette deck. Cleaning should be done every
50 hours of tape play. See “AudioSystems” in the
Index for further details.
It is importunt for you or n service station atterzdant to
perform these underhood checks at each fuel fill.
Engine Oil Level Check
Check the engine oil level and add the proper oil if
necessary. See “Engine Oil” in the Index for
further details.
7-40
At Least Twicea Year
Restraint System Check
Make sure the safety belt reminderlight and all your
belts, buckles, latch plates, retractorsand anchorages are
working properly. Look for any other loose or damaged
safety belt system parts.If you see anything that might
keep a safety belt system from doing its
job, have it
repaired. Have anytorn or frayed safety belts replaced.
Also look for any opened or broken air bag coverings,
and have them repaired or replaced. (The air bag system
does not need regular maintenance.)
Wiper Blade Check
Manual Transmission Check
Check the transmission fluid level; add if needed. See.
“Manual Transmission”in the Index. Check for leaks.
A fluid loss may indicate a problem. Have the system
inspected and repaired if needed.
.
.
atic Transmission Check
~ - -
Lneck the transmission fluid level; add if needed. See
“Automatic Transmission“ in the Index. A fluid loss may
indicate a problem. Check the system and repair if needed
Hydraulic Clutch System Check
Check the fluid levelin the clutch reservoir. See
“Hydraulic Clutch Fluid’’ in the Index. A fluid loss in
this system could indicate a problem. Have the system
inspected and repaired at once.
Inspect wiper blades forwear or cracking. Replace blade
inserts that appear worn or damaged orthat streak or
miss areas of the windshield. Also see “Wiper Blades,
Cleaning” in the Index.
At Least Oncea Year
Air Cleaner Filter Restriction Indicator Check
Key Lock Cylinders Service
Your vehicle has an indicator onthe engine that lets you
know when the air cleaner filteris dirty and needs to be
changed. Check indicatorat least twice a year or when
your oil is changed. See “Air Cleaner” in the Index for
more information. Inspectyour air cleaner filter
restriction indicator more often if the vehicle is used in
dusty areas or under off road conditions.
Lubricate the key lock cylinders with the lubricant
specified inPart D.
7-41
Body Lubrication Service
Lubricate all fuel doors, body hood, body door hinges,
body door hinge pins, hood latch assembly, pivots,
spring anchor, release pawl, tailgate hinges, and tailgate
handle pivot points, latch bolt, locks and folding seat
hardware. Part D tells you what to use. More frequent
lubrication may be required when exposed to a corrosive
environment.
Starter Switch Check
’ ,A
CAUTION:
When you are doing this check, the vehicle could
move suddenly.If it does, you or others could
be
injured. Follow the steps below.
1. Before you start, be sure you have enough room
around the vehicle.
2. Firmly apply both the parking brake (see “Parking
Brake” in the Index if necessary) and the
regular brake.
NOTE: Do not use the accelerator pedal, and be
ready to turn off the engine immediately if it starts.
7-42
3. On automatic transmission vehicles, try to start the
engine in each gear. The starter should work only in
PARK (P) or NEUTRAL (N). If the starter works in
any other position, your vehicle needs service.
On manual transmission vehicles, put the shift lever
in NEUTRAL (N), push the clutch down halfway
and try to start the engine. The starter should work
only when the clutch is pushed down all the way to
the floor. If the starter works when the clutch isn’t
pushed all the way down, your vehicle needs service.
Brake-Transmission Shift Interlock (BTSI) Check
(Automatic Transmission)
venlcle could
When you areaoing this check, tne
move suddenly. Ifit does, youor others could be
injured. Follow the steps below.
1. Before you start, be sure you have enough room
around the vehicle. It should be parked on a
level surface.
2. Firmly apply the parking brake (see “Parking Brake”
in the Index if necessary).
Parking Brake and Automatic Transmission
PARK (P) Mechanism Check
NOTE: Be ready to apply the regular brake
immediately if the vehicle beginsto move.
3. With the engineoff, turn the key to the RUN
position, but don’t start the engine.Without applying
the regular brake,try to move the shift lever out
of
PARK (P) with normal effort. If the shift lever
moves out of PARK (P), your vehicle’s BTSI
needs service.
When yo^ dre doing clllJ chec,, .,ur vehicle
could beginto move. You or others could be
injured and property could be damaged. Make
sure there is room in front of your vehicle in case
it begins to roll. Be ready to apply the regular
brake at once should the vehicle begin move.
to
Ignition Transmission Lock Check
While parked, and with the parking brake set, try to turn
the ignition key to LOCK in each shiftlever position.
0
With an automatic transmission, the key should turn
to LOCK only when the shift lever is in PARK (P).
0
With a manual transmission, the key should
turn to LOCK only when the shift lever isin
REVERSE (R).
On vehicles with a key release button, try to turn the key
to LOCK without pressing thebutton. The key should
turn to LOCK only when you press the key button.
On all vehicles, the key should come out only in LOCK.
Park on a fairly steep hill, with the vehicle facing
downhill. Keeping your foot on the regular brake, set the
parking brake.
0
To check the parking brake’s holding ability:
With the engine running and transmission in
NEUTRAL (N), slowly remove footpressure from
the regular brake pedal. Do this until the vehicle is
held by the parking brake only.
0
To check the PARK (P) mechanism’s holding ability:
With the engine running, shift to PARK (P). Then
release all brakes.
7-43
Part C: Periodic
Maintenance Inspections
Listed below are inspections andservices which should
be performed at least twice a year (for instance,each
spring and fall). You should let your dealer’s service
department or other qualified service center do these
jobs. Make sureany necessary repairs are completed
at once.
Proper procedures to perform theseservices may be
found in a service manual. See “Service and Owner
Publications” in the Index.
-ing and Suspension Inspection
inspect tne front and rear suspension andsteering
system for damaged, loose or missing parts, signs of
wear or lack of lubrication. Inspect the power steering
lines and hoses for proper hook-up, binding, leaks,
cracks, chafing, etc.
Exhaust System Inspection
Inspect the complete exhaust system. Inspect the body
near the exhaust system. Look for broken, damaged,
missing or out-of-position parts as well as open seams,
holes, loose connections or other conditionswhich could
cause a heat build-up in the floor pan or could let
exhaust fumes into the vehicle. See “Engine Exhaust” in
the Index.
Engine Cooling System Inspection
Inspect the hoses and have them replaced if they are
cracked, swollen or deteriorated. Inspect all pipes,
fittings and clamps; replace as needed. Clean the outside
of the radiator and air conditioning condenser. To help
ensure proper operation, apressure test of the cooling
system and pressure cap isrecommended at least once
a year.
Throttle System Inspection
Inspect the throttle system for interference or binding,
and for damaged or missing parts. Replace parts as
needed. Replace any components that have high effort
or excessivewear. Do not lubricate accelerator and
cruise control cables.
7-44
Drive Axle Service
Brake System Inspection
Check readfront axle fluidlevel and add as needed.
Check constant velocity joints and axle seals for leaking.
Inspect the complete system. Inspect brake lines and
hoses for proper hook-up, binding, leaks, cracks,
chafing, etc. Inspect disc brake pads for wear and rotors
for surface condition.For vehicles with rear drum
brakes, also inspect drum brake linings for wear and
cracks. Inspect otherbrake parts, including drums,
wheel cylinders, calipers, parking brake, etc. Check
parking brake adjustment. You may need to have your
brakes inspected more often if your driving habits or
conditions result in frequent braking.
Transfer Case (Four-wheel Drive)
Inspection
Every 12 months or at oil change intervals, check front
axle and transfer case
and add lubricant when necessary.
On manual shift transfer case, oil the control leverpivot
point and all exposed control linkage. Check vent hose
at transfer case forkinks and proper installation. More
frequent lubrication may be required on off-road use.
7-45
Part D: Recommended Fluids
and Lubricants
USAGE
NOTE: Fluids and lubricants identified below by name,
part number or specification may be obtained from
your dealer.
USAGE
Engine Oil
(Gasoline
FLUIDLUBRICANT
~-
50/50 mixture of clean water
(preferably distilled) and use only
GM Goodwrench@ DEX-COOL@
or Havoline@ DEX-COOL@
Coolant. See “Engine Coolant” in
the Index.
Hydraulic Brake
System
7-46
Delco Supreme 11 Brake Fluid
(GM Part No. 12377967 or
equivalent DOT-3 Brake Fluid).
@
Hydraulic Clutch Hydraulic Clutch Fluid (GM Part
System
No. 12345347 or equivalent
DOT-3 Brake Fluid).
Parking Brake
Cable Guides
Chassis Lubricant (GM Part
No. 12377985 or equivalent) or
lubricant meeting requirements of
NLGI ## 2, Category LB or
GC-LB.
Power Steering
System
GM Power Steering Fluid (GM
Part No. 1052884 - 1 pint,
1050017 - 1 quart, orequivalent).
Manual
Transmission
(5-Speed with
Low Gear, RPO
MW3)
GM Goodwrench Synthetic
Manual Transmission Gear Oil
(GM Part No. 12346190 - 1 st.) or
equivalent SAE 75W-90 GL-4
Gear Oil.
~
Engine Oil with the American
Petroleum Institute Certified For
Gasoline Engines“Starburst”
symbol of the proper viscosity. To
determine the preferred viscosity
for your vehicle’s engine, see
“Engine Oil”in the Index.
FLUIDLUBRICANT
Synchromesh Transmission Fluid
Manual
Transmission
(GM Part No. 12345349 or
(5-Speed without equivalent).
Low Gear, RPO
MGS)
USAGE
FLUIDLUBRICANT
USAGE
FLUID/LUBRICANT
Automatic
Transmission
DEXRON@-I11 Automatic
Transmission Fluid.
Key Lock
Cylinders
Multi-PuoseLubricant,
Superlube% (GM Part
No. 12346241 or equivalent).
Differential, C3
(HD3500)
Trucks With
Dana Rear Axle
SAE 75W- 140 Synthetic Gear
Lubricant (GM Part
No. 12346140) or equivalent.
Transfer Case
DEXRON@-111 Automatic
Transmission Fluid.
Windshield
Washer Solvent
GM Optikleen@ Washer Solvent
(GM Part No. 1051515)
or equivalent.
Front Axle
Propshaft Spline,
Rear Driveline
Center Splines
and Universal
Joints
Chassis Lubricant (GM Part
No. 12377985 or equivalent) or
lubricant meeting requirements of
NLGI # 2, Category LB or
GC-LB.
One-Piece
Propshaft Spline
(Two-Wheel
Drive with Auto.
Trans.)
Spline Lubricant, Special
Lubricant (GM Part
No. 12345879) or lubricant
meeting requirementsof
GM 998530.
Floor Shift
Linkage
Lubriplate' Lubricant Aerosol
(GM Part No. 12346293 or
equivalent) or lubricant meeting
requirements of NLGI # 2
Category LB or GC-LB.
Chassis
Lubrication
Chassis Lubricant(GM Part
No. 12377985 or equivalent) or
lubricant meeting requirements of
NLGI # 2, Category LB or
GC-LB.
Front Wheel
Bearings
Wheel Bearing Lubricant meeting
requirements of NLGI # 2,
Category GC or GC-LB (GM Part
No. 105 1344 or equivalent).
Differential,
Front and Rear
Axle
Axle Lubricant (GM Part
No. 1052271) or SAE 80W-90
GL-5 Gear Lubricant.
7-47
USAGE
FLUIDLUBRICANT
USAGE
Hood Latch
Assembly,
Pivots, Spring
Anchor and
Release Pawl
Lubriplate' Lubricant Aerosol
(GM Part No. 12346293 or
equivalent) or lubricant meeting
requirements of NLGI # 2,
Category LB or GC-LB.
Tailgate Handle
Multi-Pu ose Lubricant,
%
Pivot Points,
Superlube (GM Part
Hinges, Latch
No. 1234624 1 or equivalent).
Bolt and Linkage
Hood and Door
Hinges
Body Door
Hinge Pins,
Tailgate Hinge
and Linkage,
Folding Seat and
Fuel Door Hinge
7-48
Multi-Pu ose Lubricant,
Superlube% (GM Part
No. 1234624 1 or equivalent).
Multi-Pu ose Lubricant,
Superlube% (GM Part
No. 12346241 or equivalent).
FLUIDLUBRICANT
Weatherstrip
Conditioning
Dielectric Silicone Grease (GM
Part No. 12345579 or equivalent).
Weatherstrip
Squeaks
Multi-Pu ose Lubricant,
Superlube% (GM Part
No. 12346241 or equivalent).
Part E: Maintenance Record
After the scheduled services are performed,record the
date, odometer readingand who performed the service
in the boxes provided after the maintenance interval.
Any additional information from “Owner Checks and
Services” or “Periodic Maintenance” can be added on
the following record pages. Also, you should retain all
maintenance receipts. Your owner information portfolio
is a convenient place to storethem.
Maintenance Record
7-49
Maintenance Record
DATE
7-50
ODOMETER
READING
BY
MAINTENANCE PERFORMED SERVICED
Section 8 Customer Assistance Information
Here you will find out how to contact Chevroletif you need assistance. Thissection also tells you how to obtain
service publicationsand how to report any safety defects.
8-2
8-4
8-5
8-7
8-8
8-9
Customer Satisfaction Procedure
Customer Assistance for Text Telephone
(TTY) Users
Chevrolet Roadside AssistanceProgram
Canadian Roadside Assistance
Courtesy Transportation
GM Participation in an Alternative Dispute
Resolution Program
8- 10
8- 10
8-1 1
8-1 1
8-11
Warranty Information
Reporting Safety Defectsto the United
States Government
Reporting Safety Defects to the
Canadian Government
Reporting Safety Defects to General Motors
Ordering Serviceand Owner Publications
in Canada
8-1
Customer Satisfaction Procedure
Chevrolet dealers have the facilities, trained technicians
and up-to-date information to promptly address any
concerns you may have. However, if a concern has not
been resolved to your complete satisfaction, take the
following steps:
STEP ONE -- Discuss your concern with a member
of dealership management. Normally, concerns can
be quickly resolved at that level. If the matter has
already been reviewed with the sales, service or parts
manager, contact the owner of the dealership or the
general manager.
8-2
STEP TWO -- If after contacting a memberof
dealership management, it appears your concern
cannot be resolved by the dealership without further
help, contact the Chevrolet Customer Assistance
Center by calling 1-800-222- 1020. In Canada,
contact GM of Canada Customer Communication
Centre in Oshawa by calling 1-800-263-3777
(English) or 1-800-263-7854 (French).
For help outsideof the United States and Canada, call
the following numbers as appropriate:
In Mexico: (525) 625-3256
In Puerto Rico: 1-800-496-9992 (English) or
1-800-496-9993 (Spanish)
In the U.S. Virgin Islands: 1-800-496-9994
0
In the Dominican Republic: 1-800-75 1-4135
(English) or 1-800-751-4136 (Spanish)
0
In the Bahamas: 1-800-389-0009
In Bermuda, Barbados, Antigua and the British
Virgin Islands: 1-800-534-0 122
0
In all other Caribbean countries: (809) 7631315
In other overseas locations, call GM Overseas
Distribution Corporationin Canada at:
(905) 644-41 12.
For prompt assistance, please have the following
information available to givethe Customer
Assistance Representative:
0
Your name, address, home and business
telephone numbers
Vehicle Identification Number (This is available
from the vehicle registration or title, or the plate at
the top left of the instrument panel and visible
through the windshield.)
Dealership name and location
Vehicle delivery date and present mileage
0
Nature of concern
0
0
0
We encourage you to call us so we can give your inquiry
prompt attention. However, if you wish to write
Chevrolet, address your inquiry to:
Chevrolet Motor Division
Chevrolet CustomerAssistance Center
P.O. Box 7047
Troy, MI 48007-7047
In Canada, write to:
General Motors of Canada Limited
Customer Communication Centre, 163-005
1908 Colonel Sam Drive
Oshawa, Ontario L l H 8P7
8-4
Refer to your Warranty and Owner Assistance
Information booklet for addresses of
GM Overseas offices.
When contacting Chevrolet,please remember that
your concern will likely be resolved in the dealership,
using the dealer’s facilities, equipment and personnel.
That is why we suggest you follow Step Onefirst if
you have a concern.
Customer Assistancefor Text
Telephone (TTY) Users
To assist customers who are deaf,hard of hearing, or
speech-impaired and who use Text Telephones (TTYs),
Chevrolet has TTY equipment availableat its Customer
Assistance Center. Any TTY user can communicate with
Chevrolet by dialing: 1-800-833-CHEV. (TTY users in
Canada can dial 1-800-263-3830.)
Chevrolet Roadside
Assistance Program
I
n
Roadside Assistance is available24 hours a day,
365 days a year, by calling 1-800-CHEV-USA
(1-800-243-8872). This toll-free number will provide
you over-the-phone roadside assistance with minor
mechanical problems. If your problem cannot be
resolved over the phone, our advisors haveaccess to a
nationwide network of dealer recommended service
providers. Roadside membership is free, however some
services may incur costs.
Roadside offers two levels of service to the customer,
Basic Care and Courtesy" Care:
Toll-free number, 1-800-CHEV-USA
0
Free towing for warranty repairs
Basic over-the-phone technical advice
Available dealer services at reasonable costs (i.e.,
wrecker services, locksmith/key service, glass
repair, etc.)
To enhance Chevrolet's strong commitmentto customer
satisfaction, Chevrolet is excited to announcethe
establishment of the Chevrolet RoadsideAssistance
Center. As the owner of a 1998 Chevrolet, membership
in Roadside Assistance is free.
8-5
ROADSIDE Courtesy TM Care PROVIDES:
0
Roadside Basic Care services (as outlined previously)
Plus:
0
FREE Non-Warranty Towing (to the closest dealer
from a legal roadway)
0
FREE LocksmithKey Service (whenkeys are lost
on the road or locked inside)
0
FREE Flat Tire Service (spare installed on the road)
0
FREE Jump Start (at home or on the road)
0
FREE Fuel Delivery ($5 of fuel delivered on
the road)
Chevrolet offers Courtesy Transportation for customers
needing warranty service. Courtesy Transportation will
be offered in conjunction with the coverage provided by
the Bumper to Bumper New Vehicle Limited Warranty
to eligible purchasersof 1998 Chevrolet passenger car
and light duty trucks. (Please see your selling dealer
for details.)
Note: Courtesy Care is available to retail and retail lease
customers operating 1998 and newer Chevrolet vehicles
for a periodof 3 years/36,000 miles (60000 km),
whichever occurs first. All
Courtesy Care services must
be pre-arranged by Chevrolet Roadside or dealer
Service Management.
Basic Care and Courtesy Care are not part of or
included in the coverage provided by the New Vehicle
Limited Warranty. Chevrolet reserves the right to
modify or discontinueBasic Care and Courtesy Care
at any time.
8-6
For complete program details, see your Chevrolet dealer
to obtain a Roadside Assistance Center brochure.
The Roadside Assistance Centeruses companies that
will provide you with quality and priority service. When
roadside services are required, our advisorswill explain
any payment obligationsthat may be incurred for
utilizing outside services.
For prompt assistance when calling, please have the
following available to give to the advisor:
Please refer to the Roadside Assistance brochure
inside your owner information portfolio for full
program details.
Canadian Roadside Assistance
Vehicles purchased in Canada have an extensive
Roadside Assistance program accessible from anywhere
in Canada or the United States. Please refer to the
separate brochure provided by the dealer or call
1-800-268-6800 for emergency services.
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
License plate number
0
Vehicle color
0
Vehicle location
Telephone number where you can be reached
0
Vehicle mileage
0
Description of problem
8-7
Courtesy Transportation
Chevrolet offers Courtesy Transportation for customers
needing warranty service. Courtesy Transportation will
be offered in conjunction with the coverageprovided by
the Bumper to Bumper New Vehicle Limited Warranty
to retail purchasers of 1998 Chevrolet passenger cars
and light duty trucks (please see your selling dealer
for details).
Courtesy Transportation includes:
0 One way shuttle ride for any warranty repair
completed during the sameday.
0
0
0
Up to $30 maximum daily vehicle rental allowance
for any overnight warranty repair up to five days, OR
Up to $30 maximum daily cab, bus or other
transportation allowance in lieu of rental for any
overnight warranty repair up to fivedays, OR
Up to $10 daily fuel allowance for rides provided by
another person (i.e., friend, neighbor, etc.) in lieu
of
rental for any overnight warranty repair up
to five days.
Note: All Courtesy Transportation arrangements
will be administered by your Chevrolet dealer
service management. Claim amounts should
reflect all actual costs.
8-8
Chevrolet Courtesy Transportation is not part of the
Bumper to BumperNew Vehicle Limited Warranty.
Chevrolet reserves the right to makeany changes or
discontinue Courtesy Transportation at any time
without notification.
For additional program details, contact your
Chevrolet dealer.
Some state insuranceregulations make it impractical to
rent vehicles to people under 21 years of age. If you are
under 21 and have difficulty renting a vehicle, Chevrolet
will reimburse up to $30/day for documented
transportation you receive.
For warranty repairs during the Complete Vehicle
Coverage period in the New Vehicle Limited Warranty,
interim transportation may be available under the
Courtesy Transportation Program. Please consult your
dealer for details. The RoadsideAssistance program is
available only in the United States and Canada.
0
In Canada, please consult your GM dealer for
information on Courtesy Transportation.
GM Participation in an Alternative
Dispute Resolution Program
This program is available in all 50 states and the District
of Columbia. Canadian owners refer to your
Warranty
and Owner Assistance Informationbooklet for
information on the Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration
Plan (CAMVAP). General Motors reserves the right to
change eligibility limitations and/or to discontinue its
participation in this program.
Both Chevrolet and your Chevrolet dealerare committed
to making sure you are completely satisfied with your new
vehicle. Our experience has shown that, if a situation
arises where you feel your concern has not been
adequately addressed, theCustomer Satisfaction Procedure
described earlier in this section is very successful.
There may be instances where an impartial third party
can assist in arriving at a solution to a disagreement
regarding vehicle repairsor interpretation of the New
Vehicle Limited Warranty. To assist in resolving these
disagreements, Chevroletvoluntarily participates in
BBB AUTO LINE.
BBB AUTO LINE is an out-of-court program
administered by the Better Business Bureau system to
settle automotive disputes. Thisprogram is available
free of charge to customers whocurrently own or leasea
GM vehicle.
If you are not satisfied after following the Customer
Satisfaction Procedure,you may contact the BBB using
the toll-free telephone number, or write them at the
following address:
BBB AUTO LINE
Council of Better Business Bureaus, Inc.
4200 Wilson Boulevard
Suite 800
Arlington, VA 22203- 1804
Telephone: 1-800-955-5 100
To file a claim, you will be asked to provide your name
and address, your Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
and a statement of the nature of your complaint.
Eligibility is limited by vehicle age and mileage, and
other factors.
8-9
We prefer you utilize the Customer Satisfaction
Procedure before you resort to AUTO LINE, but you
may contact the BBB at any time. The BBB will attempt
to resolve the complaint servingas an intermediary. If
this mediation is unsuccessful, an informal hearing will
be scheduled where eligible customersmay present their
case to an impartial third-party arbitrator.
The arbitrator will make a decision which you may
accept or reject. If you accept the decision, GM will be
bound by that decision. The entire disputeresolution
procedure should ordinarily take about 40 days fromthe
time you file a claim until a decision is made.
Some statelaws may require you to use this program
before filing a claim with a state-run arbitration program
or in the courts. For further information,contact the
BBB at 1-800-955-5100 or the Chevrolet Customer
Assistance Center at 1-800-222- 1020.
Warranty Information
Your vehicle comes with a separatewarranty booklet
that contains detailed warranty information.
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS
TO THE UNITED STATES
GOVERNMENT
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could
cause a crash or could causeinjury or death, you should
immediately inform the National Highway Traffic
Safety Administration (NHTSA), in addition to
notifying General Motors.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, itmay open an
investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in
a groupof vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy
campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved
in individual problems between you, your dealer or
General Motors.
To contact NHTSA, you may either call the Auto Safety
Hotline toll-free at 1-800-424-9393 (or 366-0123 in the
Washington, D.C. area) or write to:
NHTSA, U.S. Department of Transportation
Washington, D.C. 20590
You can also obtain other information about motor
vehicle safety from the Hotline.
8-10
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS TO
THE CANADIAN GOVERNMENT
If you live in Canada, and you believe that your vehicle
has a safety defect,you should immediately notify
Transport Canada, in addition to notifying General
Motors of Canada Limited. You may write to:
Transport Canada
Box 8880
Ottawa, OntarioK 1G 352
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS
TO GENERAL MOTORS
In addition to notifyingNHTSA (or Transport Canada)
in a situation like this,we certainly hope you’llnotify
us. Please callus at 1-800-222- 1020 or write:
In Canada, please callus at 1-800-263-3777 (English)
or 1-800-263-7854 (French). Or, write:
General Motorsof Canada Limited
Customer Communication Centre, 163-005
1908 Colonel Sam Drive
Oshawa, Ontario LlH 8P7
Ordering Service and Owner
Publications in Canada
Service manuals, service bulletins, owner’s manuals
and
other service literature are available for purchase for
all
current and past model General Motors vehicles.
The toll-free telephone number for ordering information
in Canada is 1-800-668-5539,
Chevrolet Motor Division
Chevrolet Customer Assistance Center
P.O. Box 7047
Troy, MI 48007-7047
8-11
1998 CHEVROLET SERVICE PUBLICATIONS ORDERING INFORMATION
The following publications covering the operation and servicing
of your vehiclecan be purchased by filling out
the Service Publication Order Form in this book and mailing it in with your check, money order,
or credit card information to Helm, lncorpora fed (address below.)
CURRENT PUBLICATIONS FOR 1998 CHEVROLET
SERVICE MANUALS
Service Manuals have the diagnosis
and repair information
on engines, transmission, axle, suspension, brakes,
electrical, steering, body, etc.
RETAIL SELL PRICE: $90.00
OWNER’S INFORMATION
Owner publications are written directly
for Owners and
intended to provide basic operational information about the
vehicle. The owner’s manual will include the Maintenance
Schedule for all models.
TRANSMISSION, TRANSAXLE, TRANSFER CASE
UNIT REPAIR MANUAL
This manual provides informationon unit repair service
procedures, adjustmentsand specifications for the
1998 GM transmissions, transaxles and transfer cases.
RETAIL SELL PRICE:$40.00
In-Portfolio: Includesa Portfolio, Owner’s Manual and
Warranty Booklet.
RETAIL SELL PRICE:$1 5.00
Without Portfolio: Owner’s Manualonly.
RETAIL SELL PRICE:$10.00
CURRENT & PAST MODEL ORDER FORMS
SERVICE BULLETINS
Service Publications are available for current
and past
Service Bulletins give technical service information needed model GM vehicles. To request an order form, please
to knowledgeably serviceGeneral Motors cars and trucks. specify yearand model nameof the vehicle.
Each bulletin contains instructions to assist
in the
diagnosis and service of your vehicle.
PLEASE COMPLETE THE ORDERFORM SHOWN ON
THE FOLLOWING
PAGE ANDMAIL TO:
..
.
: Helm,’ Incorporated
0 P.O. Box 07130
Detroit, MI 48207
. ..
OR ORDER TOLL FREE: 1-800-782-4356
Monday-Friday 8:OO AM - 6:OO PM Eastern Time
For Credit Card Orders Only(VISA-MasterCarMiscover)
-
S
H
I
P
T
0
NOTE: Dealers and Companies please provide dealer or company name, and also the
name of the person to whose attention the shipment should be sent.
Mail completed order form to:
HELM, INCORPORATED P.O. Box 07130 Detroit, MI 48207
For purchases outside U.S.A. please write to the above address for quotation.
(CUSTOMER’S NAME)
(STREET ADDRESS-NO P.O.
(CITY)
(ATTENTION)
BOX NUMBERS)
(STATE)
DAYTIME TELEPHONE NO.
(ZIP CODE)
0
AREA CODE
GM-CHE-OR098
*(Prices are subject to change without notice and without incurring
obligation. Allow ample time for delivery.)
P
A
Y
M
E
N
T
Note to Canadian Customers: All listed prices are quoted in US. funds. Canadian residents
are to make checks payable in US. funds. To cover Canadian postage, add $11.50 plus the
U.S. order processing.
fi
8-14
NOTES
Section 9 Index
Accessory Power Outlet .........................
2-59
Adding Equipment to the Outside of Your Vehicle . . . . . . 6-3
AirBag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23
1-3 1
Adding Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
How Does it Restrain ..........................
1-28
How it Works . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1-26
1-26
Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1-25. 2-65
Readiness Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Servicing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-30
What Makes it Inflate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1-27
What Will You See After it Inflates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-28
1-27
When Should it Inflate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.58, 2.65
Air Bag Off Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Aircleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-18
Air Cleaner Filter Restriction Indicator Check . . . . . . . . 7-41
3.3.3.4
Air Conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Air Conditioning Refrigerants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-79
6-59
Alignment and Balance. Tire ......................
Aluminum Wheels. Cleaning ......................
6-67
3-26
Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.28.6.79.7.46
Antifreeze . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Anti-Lock
Brake System Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.68. 4.7
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7
Appearance Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-6 I
Appearance Care and Materials ....................
6-69
Arbitration Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
8-9
Armrest Storage Compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-56
2-58
Ashtrays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3-24
Audio Equipment. Adding ........................
Audio Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3-7
Automatic Transmission
7-41
Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.21. 7.47
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-15
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7-43
Park Mechanism Check ........................
2-12
Starting Your Engine ..........................
Axle. Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.27.7.47
2-32
Axle. Locking Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Axle.Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.26.7.47
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-39
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
5-3
Replacement.KeylessEntry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8
Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.3. 5.5
BBBAuto Line . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
8-9
Better Business Bureau Mediation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9
Blizzard. Driving In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-38
9-1
Brake
Adjustment ..................................
6-38
6.35.7.46
Fluid ..................................
6-35
Master Cylinder ..............................
2-2 5
Parking .....................................
PedalTravel .................................
6-38
Replacing System Parts ........................
6-38
2-67
System Warning Light .........................
Trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-56
Transmission Shift Interlock Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-42
Wear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-37
Brakes. Anti-Lock ...............................
4-7
4-6
Braking ........................................
Braking in Emergencies ...........................
4-8
2-10
Break-In. NewVehicle ..........................
BTSICheck ...................................
7-42
Bulb Replacement ..............................
6-39
2-48
Camper Type Mirror ...........................
Camper Wiring Harness ..........................
4-48
Canadian Roadside Assistance ......................
8-7
Capacities and Specifications ......................
6-77
Carbon Monoxide ....................
2.30.2.31. 4.40
Care of Your Cassette Tape Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25
CargOLamp ...................................
2-45
Cassette Deck Service ...........................
7-40
Cassette Tape Player ........................
3-9, 3-12
Cassette Tape Player Care ........................
3-25
CassetteKompact Disc Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-55. 2-56
Center Overhead Console ........................
2-5 1
Center Passenger Position ........................
1-32
Certification Label ..............................
4-43
9-2
4-43
Certificatioflire Label ..........................
Chains.Safety ................................. 4-56
6-60
Chains.Tire ...................................
Changing a Flat Tire .............................
5-23
2-66
Charging System Light ..........................
2-74
Check Gages Light ..............................
Checking Transmission Fluid Hot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-22
Checking Your Restraint Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-70
6-68
Chemical Paint Spotting ..........................
1-45
ChildRestraints ................................
Securing in a Rear Outside Seat Position . . . . . . 1-52. 1-54
Securing in the Center Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-57
Securing in the Right Front Seat Position . . . . . 1-60. 1-62
TopStrap ...................................
1-51
1-49. 1-50
WheretoPut ...........................
Chrome Wheels. Cleaning ........................
6-67
2-58
CigaretteLighter ...............................
6-71
Circuit Breakers and Fuses .......................
6-18
Cleaner.Air ...................................
Cleaning
Aluminurnwheels ............................
6-67
Exterior LampsLenses ........................
6-66
Fabric ......................................
6-62
6-65
Glass .......................................
Inside of Your Vehicle .........................
6-62
6-64
InstrumentPanel .............................
Interior Plastic Components .....................
6-64
Leather .....................................
6-64
Outside of Your Vehicle ........................
6-65
6-63
SpecialProblems .............................
6-63
Stains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tires .......................................
6-67
Vinyl . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-63
6-67
Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Windshield and Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-65
3.2.3.3
Climate Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3-7
Clock. Setting the . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.25. 7-46
Clutch Fluid. Hydraulic .....................
7-41
Clutch. System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3-2
Comfort Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
1-40
Comfort Guides. Rear
3-26
Compact Disc Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Compact Disc Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.16.3.20
3-26
Compact Disc Player Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Compass. Rearview Mirror with . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-46
2-54
Console Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-5
Control of a Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Convex Outside Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-50
6.28.6.79.7.46
Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Heater. Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2- 14
5-15
RecoveryTank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
5-15
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Courtesy Transportation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
8-8
2-38
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.54.2.55.2.56
Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Customer Assistance for Text Telephone Users . . . . . . . . . 8-4
Customer Assistance Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8- 1
Customer Satisfaction Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
8-2
Damage. Finish . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-68
Damage. Sheet Metal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-67
Daytime Running Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-42
Daytime Running Lamps Indicator Light . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-74
5-3
DeadBattery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Defects.ReportingSafety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
8-10
Defensive Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2
Defogger.RearWindow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6
3-6
Defogbing and Defrosting .........................
Dolby B NoiseReduction .......................
3-15
DomeLamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-44
Door
Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-5
StoragePocket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-51
Third . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4
2-20
Downshifting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Driver Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14
Driving
4-31
City . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-2
Defensive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-3
Drunken . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Freeway . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32
4-38
InaBlizzard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-28
IntheRain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-27
Night . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Off-Road . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14
4-9
OnCurves . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
On Grades While Towing a Trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-58
On Hill and Mountain Roads ....................
4-34
OnSnowandIce . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-37
4-30
Through Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-28
WetRoads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Winter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-36
4-56
With a Trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
DrunkenDriving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
Dual Tire Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-56
9-3
E a s y Entry Seat ................................
1-6
Electrical Equipment. Adding . . . . . . . . . . . 2- 13. 3.24. 6-70
ElectricalSystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-70
Electrochromic Day/Night Rearview Mirror . . . . . . . . . . 2-46
Engine ..................................
6-11, 6-12
Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-28,6-79. 7-46
Coolant Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2- I4
Coolant Level Check ..........................
7-40
Coolant Temperature Gage .....................
2-69
Cooling System Capacity .......................
6-79
Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-30
FuseBlocks ............................
6-71, 6-74
6-70
Identification ................................
7-40
OilLevelCheck ..............................
Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
5-13
2-3 1
Running While Parked .........................
Specifications ................................
6-77
StartingYour ................................
2-12
Underhood Fuse/Relay Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-74
Engine Oil ...............................
6- 14. 7-46
6-15
Adding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-17
Additives ...................................
6- 14
Checking ...................................
Pressure Gage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-72
6-18
Used . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-17
Whentochange ..............................
Exhaust. Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-30
Fabric Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-62
Fan Control. Climate Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2. 3-3
Fender Marker Lamp Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-45
9-4
Filling a Portable Fuel Container ....................
6-8
6-6
FillingYourTank ................................
6-1 8. 6-78
Filter. Air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-66
Finish Care ....................................
6-68
Finish Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Flashers.HazardWarning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-2
5-23
FlatTire. Changing .............................
6-79
Fluid Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7-46
Fluids and Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-43
FogLamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-5
Foreign Countries, Fuel ...........................
2-21. 6-26..
Four-wheel Drive .........................
11
French Language Manual ...........................
Front Axle ...............................
6-26. 7-47
2-21
Front Axle Locking Feature .......................
FrontTowing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
5-10
Front Turn Signal Lamp Bulb Replacement . . . . . 6-42, 6-43
6-3
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Filling a Portable Container ......................
6-8
Filling Your Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-6
Gage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-75
InForeign Countries ...........................
6-5
6-79
Tankcapacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Fuses and Circuit Breakers
....................... 6-71
Fusible Links . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-71
Gages
2-69
Engine Coolant Temperature ....................
Engine Oil Pressure ...........................
2-72
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-75
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-63
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-63
Voltmeter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-67
2-5 1
Garage Door Opener . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
GAWR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-43
Gear Positions. Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2- 15
Gear Positions. Manual Transmission . . . . . . . . . . 2- 18. 2- 19
2-51
GloveBox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-43
Gross Axle Weight Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-43..
II
Guide en Frangais . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
GVWR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-43
H a l o g e n Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-39
Hazard Warning Flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5
2-41
Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.40.6.41
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-36
HighLow Beam Changer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-42
OnReminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-71
Hearing Impaired. Customer Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-4
Heating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5
High-Beam Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-36
Highway Hypnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-33
Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-34
Hitches. Trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-55
Hood
6-9
Checking Things Under . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-10
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-34
Hydraulic Clutch Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.25.7.46
Hydraulic Clutch System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-41
Hydroplaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-30
2-11
Ignition Positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Ignition Transmission Lock Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-43
Illuminated Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-43
6-52
Inflation. Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Inside Day/Night Rearview Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-45
Inspections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7-44
7-45
Brakesystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7-45
Drive Axle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Engine Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-44
Exhaust Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-44
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7-44
7-44
Suspension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7-44
Throttle Linkage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Transfer Case (Four-wheel Drive) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-45
InstrumentPanel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-60
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-64
Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-62
FuseBlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-72
2-43
Intensity Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-43
Interior Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
5-25
Jack.Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
K e y Lock Cylinders Service .....................
Key Release Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
KeylessEntry System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7-41
2-12
2-6
2-2
Labels
Certification .................................
4-43
4-43
Certification/Tire .............................
Service Parts Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-70
Vehicle Identification Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-70
Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-41
2-45
Cargo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-66
Dome . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-44
Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-4 1
Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-43
OnReminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-42
1-5
Latches. Seatback ................................
Leaving Your Vehicle .............................
2-6
Leaving Your Vehicle with the Engine Running . . . . . . . 2-28
Lighter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-58
Lights
AirBagOff . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1-58.2-65
Air Bag Readiness .......................
1-25. 2-65
Anti-Lock Brake System Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-68. 4-7
Brake System Warning .........................
2-67
2-66
ChargingSystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
CheckGages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-74
Daytime Running Lamps Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-74
Safety Belt Reminder ......................
1-9, 2-64
2-73
Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Service Engine Soon . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-69
Shift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-20.2-73
Loading Information, Truck-Camper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-45
4-43
Loading YourVehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9-6
Loading Your Vehicle for Off-Road Driving . . . . . . . . . . 4-14
2-33
LockoutSwitch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Locks
Cylinders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-41
2-5
Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7-43
Ignition Transmission Check ....................
.................... 7-41
Key Lock Cylinders Service
PowerDoor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6
Lubricants and Fluids . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-46
7-42
Lubrication Service, Body ........................
1-3
LumbarControls ................................
Maintenance. Normal Replacement Parts . . . . . . . . . . . 6-78
MaintenanceRecord . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7-49
7-1
Maintenance Schedule ............................
LongTrip/HighwayDefinition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6
7-7
Long Trip/Highway Intervals .....................
Owner Checks and Services .....................
7-40
Periodic Maintenance Inspections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-44
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-46
Scheduled Maintenance Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
Short Trip/City Definition .......................
7-5
Short Trip/City Intervals ........................
7-5
Maintenance. Underbody .........................
6-68
Maintenance When Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-59
2-69
Malfunction Indicator Lamp ......................
1-2
ManualFrontSeat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ManualMirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-48
Manual Transmission
Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-41
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.24.7.46
2- 18. 2. 19
Shifting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Starting Your Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2- 13
Manualwindows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-32
2.55.2.57
Memo Pad Holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-5
Methanol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-45
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
CamperType . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-48
2-50
Convex Outside . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Electrochromic Daymight Rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-46
Inside Daymight Rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-45
2-48
Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-50
Power Remote Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
West Coast Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-50
6-4
MMT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Model Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
vi
MountainRoads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-34
2-10
N e w Vehicle Break-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-27
Nightvision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Noise Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6- 13
Normal Maintenance. Normal Replacement Parts . . . . . . 6-78
Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-63
Odometer. Trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-63
4- 14
Off-Road Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Off-Road Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4- I 1
Oil. Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-14. 7-46
2-5 1
Opener. Garage Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Overheating Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5- I3
Owner Checks and Services .......................
7-40
Owner Publications. Ordering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8- 1 1. 8- 12
6-68
P a i n t Spotting. Chemical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Park. Shifting Into . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-26
2-29
Park. Shifting Out of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Parking
AtNight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
2-25
Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Brake Mechanism Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-43
2-9
Lots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Over Things That Burn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-30
With a Trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-58
Your Vehicle. Manual Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-29
Passenger Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1-23
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11
Passing
Passlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2- IO, 2-73
Periodic Maintenance Inspections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-44
Pickup Box Identification Lamp Bulb Replacement . . . . 6-47
Pickup Conversion to Chassis Cab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-48
Power
2-59
AccessoryOutlet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
DoorLocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6
Driver’sSeat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1-3
Option Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-71
Remote Control Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-50
4-8
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-33. 7-46
Steering Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Take-Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-61
Winches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-61
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-32
Pregnancy. Use of Safety Belts .................... 1-22
Problems on the Road ............................ 5-1
Protecting;
Metal Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-67
.Exterior Bright
PTO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-61
Publications. Service and Owner .............. 8-1 1. 8-12
5-20
Radiator .....................................
Radiator Pressure Cap ...........................
6-32
3-23
Radio Reception ................................
Radios ........................................
3-7
Rain, Driving In ................................
4-28
2-44
Reading Lamps ................................
Rear
Axle ..................................
6.26.7.47
Outside Seat Position .....................
1.34. 1-38
1-40
Safetv Belt Comfort Guides .....................
1-34
SeatPassengers ..............................
Towing .....................................
5-12
Window Defogger .............................
3-6
RearSeat ..................................
1-7, 1-8
Rearview Mirror ................................
2-45
2-46
Electrochromic Daymight ......................
Inside Daymight .............................
2-45
Reclining Seatbacks ..............................
1-4
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-46
5-37
Recovery Hooks ................................
Recovery Tank, Coolant ..........................
5- 15
Recreational Vehicle Towing ......................
4-41
Refrigerants, Air Conditioning ....................
6-79
9-8
Replacement
-.
Bulbs ................................. 6-39. .6-76
Parts .......................................6-78
Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-59
Replacing Safety Belts ...........................
1-70
8-10
Reporting Safety Defects .........................
Restraints
Checking ...................................
1-70
Child .......................................
1-45
Head ........................................1-5
Replacing Parts After a Crash ................... 1-70
System Check ................................7-41
Right Front Passenger Position .................... 1-23
Roadside Assistance ...............................8-5
Roadside Assistance. Canadian .....................
8-7
5-37
Rocking YourVehicle ...........................
Roof Marker Lamp Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-47
Rotation. Tires ............................
6-53, 6-54
s a f e t y Belt Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-70
1-9
SafetyBelts ....................................
Adults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-14
Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-64
Center Passenger Position ...................... 1-32
Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-42
Driver Position ...............................1-14
Extender ....................................
1-70
How to Wear Properly ......................... 1-14
IncorrectUsage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17.1-68, 1-69
.
LapBelt ....................................
1-32
1.14.
1.35.
1-38
Lap-Shoulder ......................
1-67
Larger Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1-23
Passenger Position ............................
Questions and Answers ........................
1.13
1-40
Rear Comfort Guides ..........................
Rear Seat Outside Passenger Positions . . . . . . . 1.34. 1-38
1-34
Rear Seat Passengers ..........................
1.9.2.64
Reminder Light ..........................
1-70
Replacing After a Crash ........................
Right Front Passenger Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23
Shoulder Belt Height Adjuster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.16
1-43
Smaller Children and Babies ....................
1-22
Use During Pregnancy .........................
1-10
WhyTheyWork ..............................
4-56
Safety Chains ..................................
Safety Defects. Reporting ........................
8- 10
Safetyand
Warnings
Symbols .......................
111
...
7-4
Scheduled Maintenance Services ....................
1-5
Seatback. Latches ................................
1-4
Seatbacks. Reclining . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Seats
Easy Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1-6
ManualFront . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1-2
Power Driver’s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1-3
1-3
Power Lumbar Control ..........................
Rear ....................................
1.7.
1.8
Restraint Systems ..............................
1.1
Seat Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1-2
1-62
Securing a Child Restraint . . 1.52.1.54.1.57.1.60.
Securing a Child Restraint in the
Right Front Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.60. 1-62
SecurityLight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-73
Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-2
Bulletins, Ordering .......................
8- 11, 8-12
2-69
EngineSoonLight ............................
8- 11, 8- 12
Manuals, Ordering .......................
6-70
Parts Identification Label .......................
Publications, Ordering ....................
8- 11, 8- 12
6-2
Work, Doing Your Own .........................
6-1
Service and Appearance Care ......................
Service and Owner Fkblications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8- 11, 8- 12
8- 11, 8- 12
Service Publications ........................
Servicing Your Air Bag-Equipped Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . 1-30
6-67
Sheet Metal Damage ............................
2-15,2-18, 2-19
Shift Lever ..........................
2-20, 2-73
Shift Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-20
Shiftspeeds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Shifting Into Park (P) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-26
Shifting, Manual Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2- 18, 2- 19
2-29
Shifting Out of Park (P) ..........................
1-16
Shoulder Belt Height Adjuster .....................
Sidemarker Lamp Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-44
2-35
Signaling Turns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-13
Skidding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3-24
Sound Equipment, Adding ........................
6-77
Specifications and Capacities ......................
Specifications, Engine ............................
6-77
Speech Impaired, Customer Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-4
Speedometer ...................................
2-63
Stains, Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-63
Starter Switch Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7-42
Starting Your Engine ............................
2-12
Steam . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13
9-9
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-8
In Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4- 10
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-8
4-9
Speedsensitive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9
2-34
Wheel, Tilt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Step-Bumper Pad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-63
StorageAreas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-51
2-51
Storage, Overhead . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Storage, Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-39
Stuck: In Sand, Mud, Ice or Snow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-36
Sunvisors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-59
2-53
Sunglasses Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
v
Symbols, Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-63
Tailgate Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3
Taillamp Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-48, 6-49
3-25
TapePlayerCare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Temperature Control. Climate Control System . . . . . 3.2. 3-3
Theft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-9
Theft-Deterrent Feature ..........................
3-21
THEFTLOCK" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-21
6-32
Thermostat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ThirdDoor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4
2-34
TiltSteeringWheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3-7
Time, Setting the . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tirechains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-60
4-43
TireLoading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9-10
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-51
Alignment and Balance ........................
6-59
6-56
BuyingNew . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-60
Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
5-23
ChangingaFlat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-67
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Dual Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-56
6-52
Inflation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Inflation Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7-40
6-53
Inspection and Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-43
6-52
Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-58
Traction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-58
6-58
Treadwear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Uniform Quality Grading .......................
6-57
Wear Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-55
Wheel Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-59
When It's Time for New .......................
6-55
TopStrap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1-50
TorqueLock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28
Torque, Wheel Nut . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
5-32, 6-77
4-49
Towing a Trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-41
Towing,RecreationalVehicle .....................
Towing Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
5-8
Trailer
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-56
4-58
Driving on Grades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Driving with . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-56
Hitches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-55
Maintenance When Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-59
4-58
Parking on Hills . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-56
Safety Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-54
Tongueweight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Total Weight on Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-55
4-49
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Turn Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-57
4-50
Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-60
Wiring Harness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-23
Transfer Case. Electronic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Transfer Case Lubricant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.26. 7.47
2-21
Transfer Case. Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Transmission Fluid
6.21.7.47
Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.24.7.46
Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-6
Transmitters. Keyless Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Transportation.Courtesy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8
2-63
Trip Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
8-4
TTYUsers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Turn Signal and Lane Change Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35
Turn SignalNultifunction Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35
Turn Signals When Towing a Trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-57
Underbody Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Underhood Fuse/Relay Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-68
6-74
Vehicle
Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5
DamageWarnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iv
IdentificationNumber . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-70
Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-43
6-39
Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
VentilationSystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5
Visors. Sun . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-59
Voltmeter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-67
w a r n i n g Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
Warning Lights. Gages and Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-64
8- I O
Warranty Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Washer Fluid. Windshield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.33. 7-47
6-65
WashingYourVehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-65
Weatherstrips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
West Coast Type Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-50
Wheel
Alignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-59
Nut Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5.32.6.77
6-59
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Wrench . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-25
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-32
LockoutSwitch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-33
Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-32
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-32
Sliding Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2-34
Swing-Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34
9-11
WindshieldWasher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-37
Fluid .............................
2.37.6-33. 7.47
7-40
Fluid Level Check ............................
2-36
Windshield Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-50. 6-78
Blade Replacement ......................
Cleaning the Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-65
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-71
9-12
Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
i . . 4-36
Wiper Blades. Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6-65
Wiring. Headlamp ..............................
6-71
Wrench. Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
5-25
ClFlCATIONS
f
I